1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.94"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
166 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
168 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
169 .cindex "header lines" $1
171 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
175 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
181 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
182 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
186 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
187 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
188 <revhistory><revision>
190 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
191 </revision></revhistory>
194 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
199 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
200 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
201 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
202 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
204 . These do not turn up in the HTML output, unfortunately. The PDF does get them.
205 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
207 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
210 <indexterm role="variable">
211 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>address</primary>
216 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
217 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
219 <indexterm role="concept">
220 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
221 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
223 <indexterm role="concept">
224 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
225 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
227 <indexterm role="concept">
228 <primary>CR character</primary>
229 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>CRL</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>delivery</primary>
237 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
238 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
240 <indexterm role="concept">
241 <primary>dialup</primary>
242 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
244 <indexterm role="concept">
245 <primary>exiscan</primary>
246 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
248 <indexterm role="concept">
249 <primary>failover</primary>
250 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>fallover</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>filter</primary>
258 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
259 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
261 <indexterm role="concept">
262 <primary>ident</primary>
263 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
265 <indexterm role="concept">
266 <primary>LF character</primary>
267 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
269 <indexterm role="concept">
270 <primary>maximum</primary>
271 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
273 <indexterm role="concept">
274 <primary>monitor</primary>
275 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
277 <indexterm role="concept">
278 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
279 <see>entry for xxx</see>
281 <indexterm role="concept">
282 <primary>NUL</primary>
283 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
285 <indexterm role="concept">
286 <primary>passwd file</primary>
287 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
289 <indexterm role="concept">
290 <primary>process id</primary>
291 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
293 <indexterm role="concept">
294 <primary>RBL</primary>
295 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
297 <indexterm role="concept">
298 <primary>redirection</primary>
299 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
301 <indexterm role="concept">
302 <primary>return path</primary>
303 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
305 <indexterm role="concept">
306 <primary>scanning</primary>
307 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>SSL</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>string</primary>
315 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
316 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
318 <indexterm role="concept">
319 <primary>top bit</primary>
320 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
322 <indexterm role="concept">
323 <primary>variables</primary>
324 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
326 <indexterm role="concept">
327 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
328 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
330 <indexterm role="concept">
331 <primary>headers</primary>
332 <see><emphasis>header lines</emphasis></see>
338 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
339 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
340 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
341 . chapter "Introduction"
342 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
344 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
345 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
346 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
347 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
349 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
350 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
351 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
352 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
353 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
354 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
355 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
357 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
358 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
359 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
361 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
362 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
363 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
365 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
366 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
367 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
368 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
369 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
371 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
372 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
373 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
374 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
375 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
377 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
378 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
379 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
380 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
384 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
385 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
388 .cindex "documentation"
389 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
390 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
391 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
392 capable of showing a change indicator.
395 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
396 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
397 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
398 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
399 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
400 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
401 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
404 .cindex "books about Exim"
405 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
406 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
407 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
408 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
410 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
411 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
412 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
413 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
415 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
416 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
417 Debian-specific features in the file
418 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
419 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
422 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
423 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
425 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
426 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
427 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
428 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
429 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
431 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
432 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
433 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
434 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
436 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
437 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
439 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
440 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
441 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
445 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
446 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
447 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
448 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
449 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
450 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
451 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
452 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
455 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
456 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
457 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
461 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
464 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
465 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
466 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
470 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
471 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
472 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
473 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
474 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
475 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
476 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
479 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
480 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
481 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
482 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
485 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
486 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
487 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
490 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
491 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
492 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
493 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
496 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
497 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
498 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
499 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
500 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
503 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
505 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
508 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
509 .cindex "bug reports"
510 .cindex "reporting bugs"
511 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
512 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
513 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
514 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
518 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
520 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
521 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
522 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
523 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
525 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
527 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
528 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
530 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
531 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
532 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
534 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
535 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
536 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
537 here are top-level directories.
539 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
540 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
542 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
543 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
544 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
545 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
549 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
551 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
552 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
553 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
554 most portable to old systems.
556 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
557 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
558 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
559 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
560 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
561 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
562 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
563 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
564 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
565 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
566 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
568 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
569 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
570 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
571 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
573 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
575 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
576 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
577 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
579 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
580 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
581 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
583 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
584 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
585 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
586 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
588 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
589 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
590 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
591 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
593 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
594 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
597 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
599 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
600 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
601 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
602 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
603 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
604 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
605 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
607 .cindex "domainless addresses"
608 .cindex "address" "without domain"
609 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
610 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
611 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
612 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
615 .cindex "transport" "external"
616 .cindex "external transports"
617 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
618 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
619 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
620 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
621 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
622 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
624 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
625 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
626 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
629 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
630 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
631 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
632 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
633 a number of common scanners are provided.
637 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
638 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
639 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
640 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
641 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
642 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
645 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
646 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
647 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
648 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
649 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
650 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
651 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
652 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
653 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
654 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
655 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
656 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
658 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
659 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
660 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
661 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
665 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
666 .cindex "terminology definitions"
667 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
668 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
669 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
670 below) by a blank line.
672 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
673 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
674 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
675 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
676 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
677 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
678 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
679 rise to further bounce messages.
681 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
682 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
683 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
686 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
687 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
688 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
691 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
692 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
693 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
695 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
696 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
697 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
698 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
699 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
700 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
701 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
702 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
704 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
705 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
706 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
707 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
708 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
709 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
712 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
713 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
714 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
715 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
716 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
718 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
719 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
720 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
721 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
722 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
723 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
725 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
726 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
729 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
730 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
731 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
732 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
733 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
735 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
736 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
737 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
738 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
739 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
741 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
742 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
743 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
744 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
745 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
746 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
753 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
756 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
757 .cindex "incorporated code"
758 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
761 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
764 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
765 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
766 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
767 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
768 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
769 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
771 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
772 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
773 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
774 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
775 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
776 following statements:
779 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
781 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
782 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
783 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
785 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
786 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
787 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
788 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
789 restrictions applied to it).
792 .cindex "SPA authentication"
793 .cindex "Samba project"
794 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
795 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
796 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
797 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
801 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
802 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
803 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
804 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
805 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
806 conditions expressed therein.
809 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
811 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
812 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
816 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
817 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
819 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
820 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
821 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
824 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
825 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
826 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
827 details, please contact
829 Office of Technology Transfer
830 Carnegie Mellon University
832 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
833 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
834 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
837 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
840 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
841 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
843 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
844 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
845 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
846 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
847 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
848 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
849 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
854 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
857 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
858 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
859 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
860 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
863 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
864 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
868 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
869 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
870 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
871 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
872 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
873 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
874 software without specific, written prior permission.
876 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
877 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
878 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
879 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
880 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
881 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
886 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
887 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
888 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
889 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
890 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
894 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
895 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
896 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
903 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
906 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
907 "Receiving and delivering mail"
910 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
911 .cindex "design philosophy"
912 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
913 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
914 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
915 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
916 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
917 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
920 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
921 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
922 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
923 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
924 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
925 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
926 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
929 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
930 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
931 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
932 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
933 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
934 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
935 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
936 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
937 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
940 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
941 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
943 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
944 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
945 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
946 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
948 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
949 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
950 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
951 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
952 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
954 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
955 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
956 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
958 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
959 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
960 runs at the start of every delivery process.
965 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
966 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
967 .cindex "Sieve filter"
968 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
969 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
970 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
971 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
972 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
973 of filtering are available:
976 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
979 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
980 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
983 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
987 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
988 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
989 .cindex "format" "of message id"
990 .cindex "id of message"
995 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
996 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
997 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
998 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
999 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
1000 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
1001 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
1002 not always case-sensitive.
1004 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
1005 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
1006 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
1007 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
1008 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
1009 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
1013 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1014 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1015 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1016 way of representing the date and time of day).
1018 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1019 received the message.
1021 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1023 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1024 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1025 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1026 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1027 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1029 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1030 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1031 (1/100) of a second.
1035 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1036 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1037 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1038 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1039 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1042 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1043 .cindex "receiving mail"
1044 .cindex "message" "reception"
1045 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1046 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1047 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1048 there are several possibilities:
1051 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1052 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1053 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1055 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1056 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1057 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1058 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1059 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1060 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1062 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1063 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1064 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1065 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1066 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1068 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1069 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1070 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1071 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1075 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1076 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1077 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1078 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1079 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1080 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1081 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1082 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1083 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1084 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1085 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1086 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1087 users to change sender addresses.
1089 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1090 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1091 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1092 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1093 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1094 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1095 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1097 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1098 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1099 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1100 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1101 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1102 message is received.
1108 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1109 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1110 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1111 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1112 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1113 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1114 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1115 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1117 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1118 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1119 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1120 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1121 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1122 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1123 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1124 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1125 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1126 affect file system performance.
1128 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1129 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1130 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1131 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1132 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1134 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1135 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1136 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1137 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1138 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1139 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1140 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1141 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1142 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1143 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1144 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1145 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1149 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1150 .cindex "message" "life of"
1151 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1152 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1153 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1154 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1155 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1156 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1157 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1159 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1160 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1161 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1162 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1163 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1166 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1167 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1168 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1169 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1170 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1172 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1173 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1174 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1175 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1176 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1177 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1178 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1179 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1180 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1181 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1184 .cindex "journal file"
1185 .cindex "file" "journal"
1186 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1187 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1188 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1189 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1190 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1191 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1192 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1193 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1195 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1196 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1197 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1198 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1199 deliveries caused by crashes.
1203 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1204 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1205 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1206 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1207 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1208 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1209 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1210 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1211 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1213 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1214 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1215 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1216 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1217 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1218 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1219 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1220 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1221 the driver's features in general.
1223 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1224 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1225 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1226 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1229 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1230 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1231 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1232 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1233 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1234 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1236 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1237 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1238 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1239 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1240 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1241 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1243 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1244 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1245 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1248 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1249 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1250 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1251 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1252 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1253 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1254 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1255 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1256 configured to fail the address.
1258 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1259 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1260 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1261 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1262 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1263 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1265 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1266 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1267 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1268 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1269 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1270 the address is bounced.
1274 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1275 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1276 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1277 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1278 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1279 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1280 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1281 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1283 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1284 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1285 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1286 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1287 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1288 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1289 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1290 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1295 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1296 .cindex "router" "running details"
1297 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1298 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1299 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1300 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1301 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1302 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1306 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1307 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1308 original address ceases
1309 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1310 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1311 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1312 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1313 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1316 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1317 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1318 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1319 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1320 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1322 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1323 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1324 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1325 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1326 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1328 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1329 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1330 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1331 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1332 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1334 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1335 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1336 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1338 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1339 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1340 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1341 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1343 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1344 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1347 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1348 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1349 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1350 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1351 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1353 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1354 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1355 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1356 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1357 facility for this purpose.
1360 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1361 .cindex "case of local parts"
1362 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1363 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1364 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1365 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1366 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1367 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1368 routed addresses are shown.
1372 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1373 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1374 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1375 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1376 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1377 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1380 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1381 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1382 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1383 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1384 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1385 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1386 of any other conditions.
1388 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1389 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1390 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1392 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1393 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1394 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1395 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1396 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1398 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1399 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1400 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1401 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1402 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1404 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1405 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1406 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1408 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1409 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1412 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1413 of domains that it defines.
1415 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1416 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1417 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1418 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1419 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1420 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1422 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1423 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1427 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1428 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1429 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1430 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1431 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1432 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1433 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1434 the set of local parts that it defines.
1436 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1437 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1438 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1439 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1440 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1442 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1443 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1446 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1447 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1448 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1449 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1450 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1451 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1452 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1455 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1456 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1458 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1459 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1460 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1461 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1462 remaining preconditions.
1465 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1466 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1467 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1468 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1469 could lead to confusion.
1472 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1473 set of addresses that it defines.
1476 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1477 specified files is tested.
1480 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1481 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1482 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1483 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1486 Note that while using
1487 this option for address matching technically works,
1488 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1489 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1490 for transport options.
1491 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1492 convenient way to obtain them.
1497 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1498 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1499 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1500 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1501 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1502 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1503 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1507 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1508 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1509 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1512 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1513 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1514 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1515 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1516 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1518 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1519 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1521 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1522 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1523 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1524 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1525 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1526 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1529 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1530 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1531 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1532 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1533 processed entirely independently of each other.
1535 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1536 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1537 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1538 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1539 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1540 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1541 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1542 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1543 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1545 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1546 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1547 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1548 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1549 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1550 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1551 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1552 addresses to the same domain.
1554 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1555 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1556 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1557 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1558 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1559 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1560 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1561 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1563 .cindex "queue runner"
1564 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1565 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1566 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1567 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1568 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1569 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1570 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1571 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1572 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1574 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1575 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1576 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1577 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1578 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1579 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1581 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1582 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1583 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1584 messages to other addresses.
1586 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1587 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1588 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1591 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1592 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1593 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1599 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1600 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1601 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1602 .cindex "queue runner"
1603 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1604 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1605 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1606 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1607 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1608 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1609 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1610 passed its retry time.
1611 You can run several queue runners at once.
1613 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1614 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1615 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1616 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1617 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1622 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1623 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1624 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1625 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1626 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1627 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1628 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1629 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1630 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1633 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1634 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1635 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1637 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1638 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1639 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1640 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1641 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1646 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1647 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1648 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1649 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1650 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1651 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1652 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1653 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1654 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1655 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1656 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1658 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1659 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1660 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1663 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1664 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1665 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1666 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1667 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1668 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1669 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1674 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1675 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1676 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1677 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1678 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1679 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1680 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1681 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1690 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1691 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1693 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1694 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1695 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1696 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1699 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1700 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1702 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1703 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1704 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1705 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1709 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1710 following subdirectories are created:
1713 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1714 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1715 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1716 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1717 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1718 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1719 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1722 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1723 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1724 that may be useful to some sites.
1727 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1728 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1729 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1730 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1731 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1732 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1734 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1735 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1736 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1737 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1738 overridden if necessary.
1739 .cindex compiler requirements
1740 .cindex compiler version
1741 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1744 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1745 .cindex "PCRE library"
1746 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1747 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1748 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1749 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1750 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1751 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1752 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1753 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1754 If your operating system has no
1755 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1756 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1757 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1759 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1761 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1762 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1763 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1764 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1765 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1767 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1768 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1769 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1770 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1771 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1772 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1773 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1774 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1776 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1777 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1778 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1779 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1780 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1781 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1782 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1783 Berkeley DB library.
1785 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1786 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1790 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1791 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1793 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1794 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1795 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1796 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1797 filename is used unmodified.
1799 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1800 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1801 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1802 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1804 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1805 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1806 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1808 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1809 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1810 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1811 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1812 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1813 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1814 page with far newer versions listed.
1815 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1816 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1817 suited to Exim's usage model.
1819 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1820 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1821 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1822 operates on a single file.
1826 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1827 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1828 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1829 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1830 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1834 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1835 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1837 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1838 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1839 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1840 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1841 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1842 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1844 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1845 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1846 in one of these lines:
1851 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1852 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1853 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1854 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1857 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1858 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1860 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1861 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1865 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1866 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1867 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1868 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1869 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1870 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1871 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1872 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1873 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1874 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1875 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1876 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1878 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1879 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1880 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1881 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1882 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1883 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1885 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1886 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1887 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1888 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1889 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1890 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1893 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1894 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1895 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1896 facilities, you need to set
1898 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1900 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1901 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1904 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1905 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1906 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1907 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1908 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1909 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1910 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1912 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1913 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1914 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1915 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1916 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1921 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1922 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1924 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1925 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1926 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1927 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1928 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1929 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1930 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1932 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1933 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1934 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1935 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1936 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1940 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1944 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1945 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1946 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1947 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1948 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1949 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1950 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1951 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1952 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1955 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1956 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1959 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1963 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1965 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1968 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1971 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1974 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1975 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1977 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1978 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1981 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1983 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1984 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1987 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1989 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1990 library and include files. For example:
1993 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1994 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1996 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1997 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2000 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
2003 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
2004 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
2005 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2010 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2012 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2013 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2014 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2015 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2016 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2017 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2018 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2019 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2020 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2021 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2022 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2023 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2026 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2027 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2028 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2030 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2031 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2033 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2035 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2036 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2037 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2038 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2039 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2040 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2044 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2045 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2046 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2047 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2048 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2049 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2052 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2053 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2054 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2055 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2056 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2058 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2063 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2064 .cindex "lookup modules"
2065 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2066 .cindex ".so building"
2067 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2068 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2070 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2071 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2073 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2075 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2076 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2077 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2078 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2079 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2080 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2082 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2083 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2084 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2093 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2094 .cindex "build directory"
2095 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2096 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2097 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2098 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2099 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2100 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2101 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2103 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2104 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2105 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2106 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2107 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2108 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2109 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2110 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2112 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2113 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2114 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2118 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2119 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2120 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2121 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2122 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2123 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2124 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2128 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2129 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2130 given in addition to the short output.
2134 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2135 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2136 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2137 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2138 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2139 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2140 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2143 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2144 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2146 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2147 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2148 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2149 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2151 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2152 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2153 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2154 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2155 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2156 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2157 and are often not needed.
2159 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2160 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2161 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2162 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2163 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2164 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2165 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2166 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2167 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2170 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2171 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2172 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2173 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2177 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2178 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2179 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2180 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2181 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2182 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2183 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2184 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2185 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2186 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2187 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2188 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2189 containing the lines
2194 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2195 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2197 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2198 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2199 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2202 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2203 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2204 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2205 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2206 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2207 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2208 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2209 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2210 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2211 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2217 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2218 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2219 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2220 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2221 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2222 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2223 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2224 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2227 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2228 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2229 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2230 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2231 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2232 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2233 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2234 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2235 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2236 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2237 syntax. For instance:
2240 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2242 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2243 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2244 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2247 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2248 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2249 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2253 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2254 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2256 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2257 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2258 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2259 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2260 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2261 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2264 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2265 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2267 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2268 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2271 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2272 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2274 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2275 definition of all three of these variables into your
2276 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2279 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2280 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2281 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2282 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2284 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2285 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2286 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2287 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2288 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2291 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2292 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2293 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2294 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2295 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2298 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2300 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2301 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2302 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2303 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2304 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2305 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2309 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2310 .cindex "building Eximon"
2311 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2312 where the files that are involved are
2314 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2315 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2316 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2317 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2318 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2319 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2321 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2322 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2323 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2324 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2325 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2326 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2327 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2331 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2332 .cindex "installing Exim"
2333 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2334 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2335 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2336 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2337 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2338 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2339 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2340 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2341 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2342 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2343 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2344 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2346 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2347 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2348 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2349 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2350 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2351 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2352 alternative files, no default is installed.
2354 .cindex "system aliases file"
2355 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2356 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2357 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2358 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2359 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2360 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2361 and outputs a comment to the user.
2363 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2364 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2365 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2366 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2367 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2369 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2370 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2371 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2372 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2373 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2376 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2377 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2380 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2382 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2383 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2384 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2385 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2386 but this usage is deprecated.
2388 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2389 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2390 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2391 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2392 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2393 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2395 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2396 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2397 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2398 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2399 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2400 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2401 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2403 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2404 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2405 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2408 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2410 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2411 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2412 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2413 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2416 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2418 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2419 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2422 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2423 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2425 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2429 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2431 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2433 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2434 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2435 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2437 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2442 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2443 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2444 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2445 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2446 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2449 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2450 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2451 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2455 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2456 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2457 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2458 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2459 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2465 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2466 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2467 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2468 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2469 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2473 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2474 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2475 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2476 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2477 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2480 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2482 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2484 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2486 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2487 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2488 user agent. For example:
2490 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2491 From: user@your.domain.example
2492 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2493 Subject: Testing Exim
2495 This is a test message.
2498 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2499 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2500 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2502 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2503 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2504 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2505 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2506 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2507 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2509 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2511 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2512 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2513 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2514 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2515 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2517 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2518 .cindex "lock files"
2519 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2520 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2521 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2522 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2523 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2524 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2525 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2526 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2527 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2528 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2529 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2530 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2532 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2533 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2534 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2535 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2536 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2539 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2540 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2541 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2542 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2546 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2547 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2548 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2549 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2550 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2551 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2552 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2553 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2554 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2555 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2556 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2557 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2558 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2560 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2561 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2562 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2563 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2564 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2565 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2568 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2569 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2570 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2571 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2573 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2574 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2575 favourite user agent.
2577 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2578 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2579 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2580 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2581 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2582 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2586 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2587 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2588 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2589 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2590 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2591 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2592 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2593 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2594 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2595 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2601 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2602 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2603 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2605 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2607 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2608 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2609 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2610 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2611 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2613 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2615 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2617 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2618 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2619 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2627 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2628 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2629 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2630 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2631 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2632 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2633 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2634 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2635 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2638 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2640 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2641 were present before any other options.
2642 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2644 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2645 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2646 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2649 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2650 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2651 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2655 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2656 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2657 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2660 .cindex "queue runner"
2661 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2662 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2663 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2665 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2666 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2667 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2668 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2669 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2670 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2671 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2672 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2675 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2676 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2677 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2678 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2679 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2680 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2683 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2684 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2685 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2686 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2687 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2688 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2690 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2691 .cindex "envelope from"
2692 .cindex "envelope sender"
2693 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2694 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2695 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2696 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2697 users to set envelope senders.
2701 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2702 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2703 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2705 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2706 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2707 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2708 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2709 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2710 that are available to trusted users.
2712 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2713 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2714 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2715 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2716 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2718 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2719 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2720 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2721 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2723 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2724 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2725 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2726 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2728 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2729 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2734 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2735 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2736 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2742 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2743 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2744 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2745 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2746 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2747 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2748 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2749 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2752 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2753 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2754 . creates a man page for the options.
2755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2758 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2765 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2766 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2767 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2768 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2771 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2772 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2773 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2776 .vitem &%--version%&
2777 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2778 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2785 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2788 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2790 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2791 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2792 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2793 clean; it ignores this option.
2798 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2799 .cindex "queue runner"
2800 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2801 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2802 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2804 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2805 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2806 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2807 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2809 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2810 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2811 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2812 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2814 When a listening daemon
2815 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2816 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2817 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2818 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2819 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2820 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2823 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2824 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2825 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2829 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2830 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2831 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2832 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2833 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2834 .cindex reload configuration
2835 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2836 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2837 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2838 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2839 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2840 because these are reread each time they are used.
2844 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2845 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2849 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2850 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2851 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2852 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2853 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2854 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2856 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2857 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2858 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2859 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2860 test data. A line history is supported.
2862 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2863 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2864 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2865 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2866 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2867 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2868 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2870 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2871 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2872 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2873 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2875 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2876 defined and macros will be expanded.
2877 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2878 available to admin users.
2880 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2882 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2883 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2884 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2885 of a file. For example:
2887 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2889 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2890 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2891 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2892 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2893 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2894 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2895 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2898 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2900 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2901 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2902 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2903 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2904 system filters are recognized.
2906 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2908 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2909 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2910 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2911 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2912 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2913 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2914 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2915 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2918 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2919 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2920 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2922 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2924 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2925 variables that are used by the user filter.
2927 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2932 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2933 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2934 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2937 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2938 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2939 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2940 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2942 When testing a filter file,
2943 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2944 .cindex "envelope from"
2945 .cindex "envelope sender"
2946 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2947 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2948 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2949 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2950 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2953 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2955 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2956 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2957 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2960 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2962 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2963 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2964 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2965 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2966 actually being delivered.
2968 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2970 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2971 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2972 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2975 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2977 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2978 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2979 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2982 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2984 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2985 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2986 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2987 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2988 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2989 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2990 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2991 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2992 after a full stop. For example:
2994 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2995 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2997 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2998 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2999 conversion to the canonical form is
3000 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3002 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3003 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3004 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3005 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3006 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3010 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
3011 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3012 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3015 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3016 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3017 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3019 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3020 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3021 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3022 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3023 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3024 session were authenticated.
3026 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3027 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3028 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3030 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3031 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3032 specialized SMTP test program such as
3033 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
3035 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
3037 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3038 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3039 updating the callout cache database.
3043 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3044 .cindex "building alias file"
3045 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3046 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3047 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3048 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3049 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3052 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3053 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3054 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3055 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3056 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3057 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3060 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3062 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3063 .cindex "querying exim information"
3064 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3065 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3066 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3067 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3068 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3071 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3072 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3073 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3074 recognised DSCP names.
3076 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3077 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3078 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3079 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3080 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3081 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3082 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3083 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3084 way to guarantee a correct response.
3088 .cindex "local message reception"
3089 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3090 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3091 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3092 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3093 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3094 if no other conflicting option is present.
3096 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3097 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3098 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3099 suppressing this for special cases.
3101 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3102 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3104 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3105 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3106 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3109 .cindex "message" "format"
3110 .cindex "format" "message"
3111 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3112 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3113 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3114 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3115 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3117 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3118 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3120 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3121 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3122 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3123 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3124 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3126 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3127 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3128 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3129 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3130 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3132 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3133 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3134 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3135 .cindex "malware scan test"
3136 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3137 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3138 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3139 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3140 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3141 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3142 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3144 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3145 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3146 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3147 This option requires admin privileges.
3149 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3150 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3151 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3155 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3156 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3157 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3158 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3159 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3160 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3161 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3163 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3164 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3165 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3166 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3167 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3169 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3170 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3171 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3172 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3177 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3178 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3179 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3180 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3181 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3182 arguments, for example:
3184 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3186 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3187 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3188 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3189 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3190 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3191 users, the output is as in this example:
3193 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3195 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3196 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3198 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3199 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3200 backward compatibility.)
3201 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3202 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3204 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3205 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3206 name will not be output.
3208 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3209 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3210 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3211 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3212 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3213 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3214 written directly into the spool directory.
3216 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3218 exim -bP +local_domains
3220 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3221 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3223 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3224 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3225 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3226 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3227 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3228 that driver are output. For example:
3230 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3232 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3233 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3234 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3235 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3236 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3239 .cindex "environment"
3240 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3241 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3244 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3245 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3246 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3247 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3248 The output format is one item per line.
3249 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3250 the exit status will be nonzero.
3254 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3255 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3256 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3257 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3258 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3259 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3260 to allow any user to see the queue.
3262 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3264 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3265 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3268 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3269 .cindex "size" "of message"
3270 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3271 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3272 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3273 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3274 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3275 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3276 before the sender address.
3278 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3279 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3280 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3282 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3283 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3284 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3285 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3286 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3292 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3293 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3294 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3300 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3301 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3302 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3303 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3308 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3309 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3310 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3311 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3315 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3319 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3324 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3325 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3326 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3327 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3332 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3333 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3334 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3335 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3336 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3338 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3339 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3341 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3342 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3343 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3344 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3345 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3346 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3347 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3348 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3349 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3351 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3352 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3357 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3358 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3359 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3360 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3361 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3362 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3363 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3367 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3368 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3369 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3370 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3371 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3372 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3373 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3374 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3375 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3377 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3378 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3379 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3381 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3382 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3383 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3384 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3386 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3387 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3388 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3390 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3391 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3392 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3393 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3394 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3396 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3397 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3401 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3402 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3403 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3404 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3405 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3406 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3407 messages to the MTA.
3410 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3411 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3412 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3413 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3414 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3415 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3416 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3420 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3421 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3422 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3423 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3424 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3425 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3426 the listening daemon.
3430 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3431 .cindex "address" "testing"
3432 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3433 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3434 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3435 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3436 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3438 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3439 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3441 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3442 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3445 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3446 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3447 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3448 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3449 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3452 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3453 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3454 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3455 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3457 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3458 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3459 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3460 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3463 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3464 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3466 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3467 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3468 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3469 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3470 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3471 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3476 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3477 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3478 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3479 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3480 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3481 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3483 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3484 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3485 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3486 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3487 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3488 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3489 dynamic testing facilities.
3493 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3494 .cindex "address" "verification"
3495 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3496 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3497 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3498 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3499 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3500 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3502 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3503 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3504 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3506 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3507 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3509 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3510 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3513 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3514 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3515 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3516 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3517 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3519 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3520 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3521 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3522 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3523 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3524 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3527 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3528 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3529 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3532 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3533 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3534 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3535 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3537 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3538 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3539 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3540 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3544 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3545 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3552 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3553 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3554 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3555 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3557 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3558 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3559 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3560 each port only when the first connection is received.
3562 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3563 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3565 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3567 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3568 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3569 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3570 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3571 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3572 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3573 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3574 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3575 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3577 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3578 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3579 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3580 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3581 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3582 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3583 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3584 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3585 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3587 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3588 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3589 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3590 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3591 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3592 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3593 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3595 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3596 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3597 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3598 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3599 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3600 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3601 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3603 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3604 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3605 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3608 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3609 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3610 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3611 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3612 specified by this option.
3615 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3617 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3618 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3619 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3620 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3621 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3622 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3624 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3625 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3626 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3627 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3628 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3629 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3630 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3632 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3633 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3634 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3640 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3641 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3644 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3646 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3647 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3650 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3652 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3653 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3654 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3655 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3656 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3657 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3658 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3661 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3662 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3663 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3664 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3665 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3666 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3667 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3670 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3671 &`auth `& authenticators
3672 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3673 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3674 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3675 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3676 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3677 &`filter `& filter handling
3678 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3679 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3680 &`ident `& ident lookup
3681 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3682 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3683 &`load `& system load checks
3684 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3685 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3686 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3687 &`memory `& memory handling
3688 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3689 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3690 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3691 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3692 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3693 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3694 &`retry `& retry handling
3695 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3696 &`route `& address routing
3697 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3699 &`transport `& transports
3700 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3701 &`verify `& address verification logic
3702 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3704 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3705 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3706 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3707 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3708 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3709 turn everything off.
3711 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3712 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3713 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3714 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3715 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3718 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3719 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3720 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3721 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3722 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3725 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3726 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3729 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3730 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3731 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3732 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3733 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3734 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3736 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3737 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3739 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3741 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3742 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3743 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3744 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3747 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3748 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3749 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3750 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3754 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3755 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3756 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3757 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3758 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3759 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3760 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3761 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3764 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3765 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3766 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3767 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3768 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3770 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3772 .cindex "sender" "name"
3773 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3774 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3775 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3776 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3777 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3778 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3780 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3782 .cindex "sender" "address"
3783 .cindex "address" "sender"
3784 .cindex "trusted users"
3785 .cindex "envelope from"
3786 .cindex "envelope sender"
3787 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3788 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3789 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3790 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3793 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3794 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3795 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3796 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3799 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3800 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3801 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3802 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3803 examples of shell commands:
3805 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3806 exim -f "" user@domain
3808 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3809 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3812 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3813 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3814 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3815 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3818 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3819 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3820 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3821 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3822 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3823 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3827 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3828 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3830 control = suppress_local_fixups
3832 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3833 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3836 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3839 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3841 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3842 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3843 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3848 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3849 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3850 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3851 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3852 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3853 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3855 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3857 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3858 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3859 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3860 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3861 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3862 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3864 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3866 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3868 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3869 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3870 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3871 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3872 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3873 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3874 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3877 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3878 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3879 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3880 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3881 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3882 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3884 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3885 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3886 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3887 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3889 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3891 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3892 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3893 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3894 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3895 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3896 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3897 can be used only by an admin user.
3899 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3901 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3902 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3904 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3905 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3906 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3907 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3908 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3909 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3910 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3911 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3915 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3916 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3917 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3921 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3922 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3923 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3927 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3928 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3929 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3931 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3933 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3934 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3935 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3939 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3940 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3941 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3945 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3946 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3947 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3949 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3951 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3952 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3953 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3954 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3955 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3956 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3959 .vitem &%-MCq%&&~<&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
3961 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3962 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
3967 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3968 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3969 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3974 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3975 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3976 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3979 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
3983 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3984 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
3985 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
3986 The argument gives the SNI string.
3987 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
3990 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3992 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3993 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3994 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3995 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3997 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3999 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
4000 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
4001 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
4002 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
4003 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
4004 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
4005 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
4006 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
4007 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
4008 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
4009 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
4010 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
4011 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
4013 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
4015 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
4016 .cindex "sender" "changing"
4017 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
4018 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4019 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4020 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4021 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4022 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4024 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4026 .cindex "freezing messages"
4027 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4028 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4029 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4030 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4031 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4032 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4035 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4037 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4038 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4039 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4040 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4041 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4042 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4043 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
4044 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4047 .vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4050 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4051 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4052 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4053 queue to the given named queue.
4054 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4055 string to define the default queue.
4056 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4057 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4059 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4061 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4062 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4063 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4064 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4065 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4067 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4069 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4070 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4071 .cindex "removing recipients"
4072 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4073 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4074 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4075 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4076 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4077 can be used only by an admin user.
4079 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4081 .cindex "removing messages"
4082 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4083 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4084 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4085 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4086 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4087 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4088 placed in the queue.
4093 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4094 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4095 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4099 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4101 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4102 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4103 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4104 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4105 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4106 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4107 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4108 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4109 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4111 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4113 .cindex "thawing messages"
4114 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4117 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4118 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4119 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4122 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4124 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4125 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4126 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4127 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4129 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4131 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4132 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4133 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4134 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4135 only by an admin user.
4137 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4139 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4140 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4141 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4142 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4143 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4145 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4147 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4148 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4149 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4150 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4154 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4155 treats it that way too.
4159 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4160 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4161 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4162 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4163 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4164 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4165 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4168 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4169 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4170 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4171 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4172 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4173 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4174 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4179 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4180 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4181 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4182 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4184 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4186 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4189 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4191 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4192 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4193 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4196 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4198 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4199 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4200 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4201 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4202 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4203 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4207 .cindex "background delivery"
4208 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4209 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4210 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4211 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4212 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4213 processes to finish.
4215 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4216 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4217 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4218 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4220 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4221 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4222 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4223 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4227 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4228 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4229 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4230 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4231 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4232 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4234 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4235 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4238 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4239 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4241 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4242 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4243 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4244 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4249 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4254 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4255 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4256 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4257 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4258 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4259 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4260 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4261 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4262 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4263 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4268 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4269 .cindex "first pass routing"
4270 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4271 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4272 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4273 configuration file is in effect.
4275 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4276 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4277 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4278 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4279 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4280 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4281 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4282 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4283 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4288 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4289 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4290 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4293 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4295 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4296 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4297 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4298 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4302 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4303 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4304 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4305 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4306 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4310 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4311 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4312 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4313 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4314 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4318 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4319 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4324 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4325 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4330 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4331 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4332 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4333 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4334 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4335 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4338 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4339 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4341 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4343 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4344 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4345 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4346 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4347 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4348 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4350 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4351 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4353 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4355 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4356 followed by a colon and the port number:
4358 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4360 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4361 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4362 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4363 whichever one is last.
4365 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4367 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4368 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4369 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4370 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4371 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4372 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4374 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4376 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4377 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4378 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4379 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4380 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4381 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4383 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4385 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4386 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4387 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4388 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4389 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4390 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4391 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4392 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4394 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4396 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4397 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4398 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4399 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4400 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4402 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4404 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4405 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4406 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4407 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4408 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4409 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4410 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4412 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4413 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4414 is sending the bounce.
4416 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4418 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4419 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4420 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4421 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4422 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4423 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4424 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4425 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4426 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4427 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4429 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4431 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4432 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4433 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4434 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4435 uses the name it is given.
4437 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4439 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4440 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4441 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4442 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4443 used, when there is no default.
4447 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4448 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4449 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4450 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4454 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4455 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4456 whatever that means.
4458 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4460 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4461 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4462 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4463 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4464 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4465 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4466 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4470 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4471 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4472 This option is not intended for general use.
4473 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4474 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4475 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4477 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4479 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4480 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4481 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4482 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4483 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4485 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4487 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4488 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4489 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4490 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4491 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4492 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4496 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4498 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4500 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4501 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4502 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4503 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4504 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4505 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4506 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4507 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4512 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4513 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4515 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4517 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4518 option is also present.
4519 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This could be
4520 required if the system is running multiple daemons.
4522 The socket is currently used for
4524 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4526 obtaining a current queue size
4532 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4533 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4534 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4535 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4540 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4541 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4542 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4543 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4546 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4548 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4550 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4552 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4553 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4554 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4555 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4556 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4557 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4561 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4562 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4563 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4564 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4565 and &%-S%& options).
4567 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4568 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4569 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4570 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4571 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4572 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4573 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4576 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4577 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4578 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4579 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4580 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4583 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4584 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4585 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4586 this to be repeated periodically.
4588 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4589 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4590 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4591 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4593 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4594 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4595 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4597 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4598 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4599 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4600 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4604 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4605 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4606 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4607 .cindex "first pass routing"
4608 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4609 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4610 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4611 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4614 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4615 If that is so and the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true then
4616 in the first phase of the run,
4617 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4618 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4620 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4621 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4622 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4623 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4624 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4625 delivered down a single SMTP
4626 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4627 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4628 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4629 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4630 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4633 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4635 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4636 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4637 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4638 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4639 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4641 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4643 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4644 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4645 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4646 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4647 their retry times are tried.
4649 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4651 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4652 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4655 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4657 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4658 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4659 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4662 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4665 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4666 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4667 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4668 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4669 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4670 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4671 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4673 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4674 will specify a queue to operate on.
4677 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4679 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4682 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4683 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4684 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4685 starting message id. For example:
4687 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4689 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4690 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4691 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4693 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4695 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4696 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4697 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4698 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4699 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4700 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4702 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4703 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4704 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4705 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4706 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4707 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4708 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4709 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4710 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4712 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4714 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4715 process every 30 minutes.
4717 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4718 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4720 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4722 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4725 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4727 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4729 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4731 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4732 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4733 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4734 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4735 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4736 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4737 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4739 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4740 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4741 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4742 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4743 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4744 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4746 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4747 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4749 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4751 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4752 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4753 applied to each queue run.
4755 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4756 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4757 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4758 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4759 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4760 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4761 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4762 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4763 address will be skipped.
4765 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4766 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4767 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4770 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4771 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4772 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4773 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4774 an arbitrary command instead.
4778 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4780 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4782 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4783 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4784 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4785 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4786 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4787 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4789 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4791 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4792 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4793 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4797 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4801 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4802 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4803 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4804 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4805 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4807 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4808 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4809 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4810 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4811 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4812 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4813 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4814 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4815 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4816 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4817 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4819 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4820 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4821 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4822 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4823 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4824 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4826 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4827 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4828 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4829 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4830 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4831 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4832 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4833 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4834 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4838 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4839 compatibility with Sendmail.
4841 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4842 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4843 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4844 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4845 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4846 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4847 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4848 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4853 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4854 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4855 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4856 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4857 set. Exim ignores this option.
4861 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4862 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4863 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4864 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4865 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4866 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4871 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4872 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4873 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4876 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4878 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4879 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4881 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4883 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4884 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4885 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4894 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4895 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4896 . creates a man page for the options.
4897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4900 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4911 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4912 "The runtime configuration file"
4914 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4915 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4916 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4917 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4918 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4919 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4920 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4921 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4922 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4925 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4926 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4927 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4928 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4929 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4930 actually alter the string.
4932 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4933 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4934 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4935 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4936 existing file in the list.
4939 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4940 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4941 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4942 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4943 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4944 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4945 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4946 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4947 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4948 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4950 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4951 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4952 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4953 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4954 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4956 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4957 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4958 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4959 compromise the Exim user account.
4961 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4962 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4963 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4964 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4965 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4966 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4971 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4972 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4973 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4974 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4975 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4976 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4977 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4978 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4979 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4980 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4981 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4983 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4984 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4985 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4986 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4987 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4988 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4989 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4990 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4991 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4994 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4995 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4996 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4997 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4998 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
5000 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
5001 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
5002 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
5003 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
5004 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
5005 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
5007 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
5008 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
5009 necessarily be discarded.
5010 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
5011 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
5012 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
5013 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
5014 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
5015 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
5017 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
5018 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
5019 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
5020 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
5021 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
5022 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
5023 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
5025 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
5026 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
5027 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
5031 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
5032 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
5033 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
5034 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
5035 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
5036 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
5037 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
5038 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
5041 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
5044 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5045 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
5046 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
5048 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
5049 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
5050 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
5052 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
5053 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
5054 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
5056 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
5057 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
5058 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
5059 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5062 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5063 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5064 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5066 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5067 want to use this feature, you must set
5069 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5071 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5072 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5075 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5076 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5077 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5078 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5080 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5081 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5082 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5083 and does not introduce a comment.
5085 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5086 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5087 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5088 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5089 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5091 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5092 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5093 change settings as required.
5095 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5096 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5097 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5098 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5099 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5104 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5105 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5106 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5107 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5108 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5109 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5112 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5113 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5115 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5116 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5117 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5118 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5119 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5122 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5123 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5124 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5125 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5127 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5128 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5131 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5134 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5135 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5140 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5141 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5142 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5143 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5144 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5145 definition, and must be of the form
5147 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5149 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5150 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5151 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5152 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5153 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5155 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5156 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5157 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5159 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5160 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5161 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5162 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5163 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5164 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5165 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5168 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5169 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5171 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5172 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5173 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5174 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5175 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5176 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5179 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5180 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5181 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5186 MAC == updated value
5188 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5189 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5190 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5191 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5195 MAC == MAC and something added
5197 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5198 from a number of other files.
5200 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5201 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5202 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5203 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5204 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5209 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5210 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5211 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5212 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5214 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5215 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5217 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5219 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5221 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5222 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5223 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5226 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5227 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5228 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5229 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5230 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5233 The following classes of macros are defined:
5235 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5236 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5237 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5238 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5239 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5240 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5241 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5242 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5243 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5244 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5245 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5246 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5249 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5252 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5253 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5254 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5255 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5256 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5257 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5258 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5260 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5261 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5262 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5266 message_size_limit = 50M
5268 message_size_limit = 100M
5271 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5272 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5273 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5274 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5275 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5277 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5278 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5279 in this line"& will always be true.
5281 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5282 to clarify complicated nestings.
5286 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5287 .cindex "common option syntax"
5288 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5289 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5290 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5291 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5292 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5293 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5294 space) and then the value. For example:
5296 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5298 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5299 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5300 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5301 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5302 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5303 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5304 word &"hide"&. For example:
5306 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5308 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5310 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5312 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5313 all instances of the same driver.
5315 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5316 that are found in option settings.
5319 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5320 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5321 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5322 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5323 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5324 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5325 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5326 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5327 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5328 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5329 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5330 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5335 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5340 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5345 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5346 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5347 .cindex "format" "integer"
5348 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5349 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5350 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5351 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5354 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5355 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5356 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5358 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5359 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5360 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5364 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5365 .cindex "integer format"
5366 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5367 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5368 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5369 Such options are always output in octal.
5372 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5373 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5374 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5375 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5376 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5380 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5381 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5382 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5383 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5384 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5394 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5395 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5396 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5400 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5401 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5402 .cindex "format" "string"
5403 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5404 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5405 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5406 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5407 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5408 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5409 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5410 therefore equivalent:
5412 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5413 trusted_users = uucp:\
5414 # This comment line is ignored
5417 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5418 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5419 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5420 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5421 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5424 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5425 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5426 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5428 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5429 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5433 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5434 character, that character replaces the pair.
5436 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5437 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5438 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5439 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5440 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5441 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5444 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5445 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5446 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5447 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5448 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5449 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5450 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5451 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5452 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5453 within a quoted configuration string.
5456 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5457 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5458 .cindex "format" "user name"
5459 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5460 .cindex "format" "group name"
5461 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5462 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5463 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5464 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5467 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5468 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5469 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5470 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5471 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5472 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5473 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5474 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5475 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5476 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5477 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5479 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5480 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5481 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5482 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5483 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5484 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5487 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5489 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5491 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5492 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5493 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5494 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5496 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5497 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5498 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5499 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5500 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5501 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5502 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5503 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5505 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5507 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5508 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5509 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5511 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5512 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5513 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5514 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5515 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5516 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5517 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5518 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5519 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5521 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5523 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5524 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5525 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5526 the value in quotes. For example:
5528 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5530 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5531 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5532 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5533 enclosing an empty list item.
5537 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5538 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5539 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5540 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5542 senders = user@domain :
5544 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5545 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5546 items, the second of which is empty:
5548 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5550 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5551 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5552 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5553 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5557 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5558 is at the end of the list.
5563 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5564 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5565 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5566 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5567 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5568 a sequence of lines like this:
5570 <&'instance name'&>:
5575 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5576 followed by three options settings:
5581 transport = local_delivery
5583 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5584 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5585 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5586 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5587 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5588 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5590 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5591 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5593 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5594 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5595 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5596 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5597 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5600 .cindex "generic options"
5601 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5602 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5603 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5604 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5605 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5606 .cindex "private options"
5607 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5608 they all have default values.
5610 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5611 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5612 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5614 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5615 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5616 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5617 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5618 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5619 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5620 configuration lines:
5625 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5626 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5627 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5628 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5634 command_timeout = 10s
5636 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5637 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5640 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5641 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5642 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5653 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5654 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5655 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5656 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5657 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5658 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5659 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5660 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5661 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5662 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5663 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5667 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5668 All macros should be defined before any options.
5670 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5672 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5674 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5675 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5676 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5677 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5679 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5680 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5681 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5684 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5685 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5686 in the file, after the macros.
5687 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5689 # primary_hostname =
5691 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5692 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5693 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5694 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5696 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5698 domainlist local_domains = @
5699 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5700 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5702 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5703 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5704 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5705 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5707 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5708 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5711 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5712 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5713 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5714 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5715 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5716 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5718 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5719 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5720 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5721 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5722 domain is permitted.
5724 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5725 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5726 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5727 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5728 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5729 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5731 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5732 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5733 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5735 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5737 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5738 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5740 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5741 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5742 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5743 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5744 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5745 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5746 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5747 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5748 contents of a message to be checked.
5750 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5752 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5753 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5755 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5756 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5757 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5758 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5760 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5762 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5763 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5764 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5766 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5767 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5768 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5769 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5770 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5771 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5772 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5774 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5776 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5777 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5779 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5780 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5781 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5782 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5783 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5784 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5785 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5786 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5787 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5788 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5789 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5790 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5791 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5792 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5793 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5794 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5796 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5797 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5798 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5799 which should be used in preference to 587.
5800 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5802 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5804 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5807 # qualify_recipient =
5809 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5810 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5811 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5812 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5813 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5814 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5816 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5817 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5818 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5819 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5821 # allow_domain_literals
5823 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5824 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5825 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5826 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5827 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5828 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5830 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5834 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5835 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5836 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5837 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5838 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5839 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5840 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5841 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5843 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5844 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5849 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5850 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5851 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5852 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5853 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5854 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5857 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5858 1413 (hence their names):
5861 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5863 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5864 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5865 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5866 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5867 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5868 information, you can change this.
5870 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5871 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5876 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5877 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5878 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5879 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5881 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5882 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5884 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5885 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5887 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5890 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5891 +tls_certificate_verified
5894 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5896 # percent_hack_domains =
5898 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5899 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5900 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5902 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5903 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5904 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5905 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5906 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5907 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5908 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5909 always bounce messages.
5911 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5912 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5914 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5915 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5916 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5917 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5918 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5920 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5921 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5922 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5923 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5924 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5927 # split_spool_directory = true
5930 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5931 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5932 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5933 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5934 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5935 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5936 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5938 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5941 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5942 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5943 that are not 8-bit clean.
5945 # accept_8bitmime = false
5948 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5949 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5950 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5951 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5952 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5953 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5955 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5956 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5960 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5961 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5962 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5963 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5964 It starts with the line
5968 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5969 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5970 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5972 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5973 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5974 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5975 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5976 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5977 result of the ACL processing.
5981 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5986 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5987 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5988 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5989 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5990 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5991 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5993 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5994 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5995 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5998 deny domains = +local_domains
5999 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
6000 message = Restricted characters in address
6002 deny domains = !+local_domains
6003 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
6004 message = Restricted characters in address
6006 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
6007 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
6008 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
6009 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
6010 in Internet mail addresses.
6012 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
6013 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
6014 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
6015 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
6016 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
6017 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
6018 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
6019 policy of being as safe as possible.
6021 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
6022 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
6023 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
6024 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6025 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6026 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6028 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
6029 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
6030 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
6031 have to modify this rule.
6033 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
6034 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
6035 common convention of local parts constructed as
6036 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
6037 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
6038 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
6039 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
6040 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
6041 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
6043 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
6044 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
6045 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
6046 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
6047 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
6048 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
6049 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
6051 accept local_parts = postmaster
6052 domains = +local_domains
6054 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
6055 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
6056 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6057 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6058 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6060 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6061 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6062 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6064 require verify = sender
6066 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6067 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6068 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6069 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6070 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6071 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6072 discusses the details of address verification.
6074 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6075 control = submission
6077 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6078 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6079 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6080 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6081 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6082 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6083 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6084 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6085 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6087 accept authenticated = *
6088 control = submission
6090 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6091 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6092 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6093 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6094 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6095 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6097 require message = relay not permitted
6098 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6100 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6101 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6103 require verify = recipient
6105 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6106 fails, the address is rejected.
6108 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6109 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6110 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6113 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6114 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6115 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6116 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6118 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6119 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6120 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6123 # require verify = csa
6125 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6126 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6131 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6132 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6136 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6137 of this ACL are commented out:
6140 # message = This message contains a virus \
6143 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6144 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6145 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6146 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6148 # warn spam = nobody
6149 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6150 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6151 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6152 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6154 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6155 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6156 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6157 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6158 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6159 whatever the spam score.
6163 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6166 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6167 .cindex "default" "routers"
6168 .cindex "routers" "default"
6169 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6174 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6175 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6176 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6177 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6178 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6181 # driver = ipliteral
6182 # domains = !+local_domains
6183 # transport = remote_smtp
6185 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6186 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6187 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6188 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6189 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6191 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6192 macro has been defined, per
6194 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6203 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6204 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6205 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6206 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6210 driver = manualroute
6211 domains = ! +local_domains
6212 transport = smarthost_smtp
6213 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6214 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6217 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6218 specified by the line
6220 domains = ! +local_domains
6222 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6223 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6224 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6225 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6226 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6227 passed on to the following routers.
6229 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6230 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6231 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6232 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6234 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6235 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6236 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6237 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6238 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6239 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6240 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6245 domains = ! +local_domains
6246 transport = remote_smtp
6247 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6250 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6252 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6253 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6254 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6255 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6256 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6258 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6259 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6260 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6261 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6262 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6263 the address fails and is bounced.
6265 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6266 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6267 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6268 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6269 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6270 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6271 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6278 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6280 file_transport = address_file
6281 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6283 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6284 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6285 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6286 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6287 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6290 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6291 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6292 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6293 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6298 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6299 # local_part_suffix_optional
6300 file = $home/.forward
6305 file_transport = address_file
6306 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6307 reply_transport = address_reply
6309 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6310 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6311 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6312 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6313 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6316 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6317 # local_part_suffix_optional
6319 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6320 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6321 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6322 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6323 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6324 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6325 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6327 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6328 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6329 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6330 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6332 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6333 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6334 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6335 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6336 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6337 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6338 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6340 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6341 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6342 There are two reasons for doing this:
6345 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6346 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6349 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6350 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6351 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6352 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6356 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6357 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6358 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6359 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6361 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6362 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6363 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6365 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6367 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6373 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6374 # local_part_suffix_optional
6375 transport = local_delivery
6377 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6378 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6379 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6380 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6381 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6384 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6385 .cindex "default" "transports"
6386 .cindex "transports" "default"
6387 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6388 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6389 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6393 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6397 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6402 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6403 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6404 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6405 with over-long lines.
6407 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6408 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6409 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6410 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6412 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6413 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6414 usual federated system.
6419 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6423 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6424 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6425 hosts_require_tls = *
6426 tls_verify_hosts = *
6427 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6428 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6429 # you succeed or not:
6430 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6432 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6433 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6434 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6435 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6436 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6437 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6439 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6440 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6443 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6450 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6451 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6452 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6453 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6454 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6455 then no other options are defined.
6456 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6457 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6458 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6459 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6460 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6461 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6462 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6463 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6464 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6465 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6466 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6468 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6470 All other options are defaulted.
6474 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6481 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6482 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6484 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6485 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6486 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6487 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6488 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6490 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6491 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6492 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6493 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6494 show how this can be done.
6496 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6497 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6498 similarly-named options above.
6504 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6505 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6506 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6507 be returned to the sender.
6515 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6516 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6517 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6522 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6527 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6528 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6529 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6530 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6531 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6532 introduced by the line
6536 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6539 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6541 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6542 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6543 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6544 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6545 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6547 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6548 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6549 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6552 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6553 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6557 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6558 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6562 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6563 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6564 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6566 begin authenticators
6568 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6569 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6570 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6571 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6572 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6573 to support most MUA software.
6575 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6578 # driver = plaintext
6579 # server_set_id = $auth2
6580 # server_prompts = :
6581 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6582 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6584 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6587 # driver = plaintext
6588 # server_set_id = $auth1
6589 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6590 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6591 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6594 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6595 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6596 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6597 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6598 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6599 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6600 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6601 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6603 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6604 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6605 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6606 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6608 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6609 usercode and password are in different positions.
6610 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6612 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6619 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6621 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6623 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6624 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6625 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6626 regular expressions is discussed in
6627 online Perl manpages, in
6628 many Perl reference books, and also in
6629 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6630 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6631 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6632 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6633 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6635 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6636 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6637 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6638 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6639 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6642 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6643 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6644 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6645 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6647 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6649 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6650 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6651 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6652 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6653 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6654 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6657 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6658 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6659 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6660 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6661 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6662 match anywhere in the subject string.
6664 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6665 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6667 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6669 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6672 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6674 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6675 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6682 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6683 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6684 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6685 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6686 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6687 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6690 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6691 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6692 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6693 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6694 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6695 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string expansion.
6697 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6698 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6699 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6700 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6701 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6702 The key for the lookup is &*implicit*&,
6703 given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6706 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6707 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6708 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6709 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6710 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6711 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6713 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6714 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6715 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6716 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6717 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6719 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6720 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6722 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6723 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6724 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6725 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6726 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6728 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6729 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6731 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6732 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6733 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6734 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6736 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6737 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6739 The file could contains lines like this:
6744 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6745 matches the list item.
6747 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6748 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6750 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6752 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6753 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6754 causes a second lookup to occur.
6757 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6758 and a comma-separated list of options.
6759 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6760 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6762 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6763 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6764 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6765 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6768 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6769 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6770 lookup is permitted.
6773 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6774 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6775 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6776 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6779 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6780 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6781 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6782 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6783 The file string may not be tainted
6785 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6786 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6787 If this is given and the lookup
6788 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6789 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6790 version of the lookup key.
6791 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6793 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6794 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6795 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6796 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6799 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6800 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6801 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6806 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6807 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6808 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6813 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6814 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6815 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6816 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6819 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6820 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6821 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6822 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6823 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6824 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6825 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6826 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6827 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6829 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6830 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6831 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6832 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6834 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6835 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6836 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6837 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6839 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6840 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6841 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6842 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6843 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6844 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6845 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6847 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6848 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6849 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6850 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6851 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6852 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6853 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6855 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6856 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6858 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6859 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6860 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6861 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6862 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6863 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6864 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6866 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6867 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6868 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6870 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6871 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6872 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6873 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6874 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6875 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6876 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6877 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6878 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6879 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6881 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6882 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6883 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be an
6885 directory path; this is searched for an entry
6886 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6888 contain any forward slash characters.
6889 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6890 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6891 The result is regarded as untainted.
6893 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6894 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6895 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6897 Two options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6899 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6900 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6902 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6904 The default result is just the requested entry.
6905 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6906 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6907 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6909 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6911 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6914 An example of how this
6915 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6916 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6918 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6919 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6920 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6921 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6922 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6923 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6924 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6926 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6927 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6928 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6929 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6931 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6932 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6933 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6934 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6935 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6937 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6938 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6939 lookup types support only literal keys.
6941 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6942 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6943 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6945 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6946 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6947 notation before executing the lookup.)
6950 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6951 rather than omitting the key porttion.
6952 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6957 .cindex json "lookup type"
6958 .cindex JSON expansions
6959 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6960 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6961 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6962 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6963 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6964 of the JSON structure.
6965 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6966 nunbered array element is selected.
6967 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6968 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6969 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6971 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6978 .cindex database lmdb
6979 &(lmdb)&: The given file is an LMDB database.
6980 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
6981 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
6982 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/)
6983 for the feature set and operation modes.
6985 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
6986 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
6987 or your operating system package repository.
6988 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
6990 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
6991 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
6996 .cindex "linear search"
6997 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6998 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6999 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
7000 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
7001 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
7002 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
7003 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
7004 in the file is used.
7006 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
7007 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
7008 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
7009 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
7010 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
7015 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
7016 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
7017 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
7018 wildcarding of any kind.
7020 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
7021 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
7022 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
7023 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
7024 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
7025 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
7026 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
7027 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
7028 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7031 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7032 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7033 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7034 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7035 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7036 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7037 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7038 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7041 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7042 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7043 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7044 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7045 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7046 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7047 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7048 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7049 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7051 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7052 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7053 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7054 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7056 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
7057 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
7060 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7062 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7063 *fish data for anythingfish
7066 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7067 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7069 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7071 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7072 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7073 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7075 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7077 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7078 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7079 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7081 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7084 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7085 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7086 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7087 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7088 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7090 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7091 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7092 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7093 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7094 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7097 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7098 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7099 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7102 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7104 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7107 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7108 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7109 be followed by optional colons.
7111 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7112 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7113 lookup types support only literal keys.
7116 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7117 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7118 &(spf)&: If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7119 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7120 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7124 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7125 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7126 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7127 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7128 many of them are given in later sections.
7131 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7132 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7133 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7134 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7135 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7137 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7138 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7139 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7141 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7142 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7143 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7144 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7145 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7146 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7147 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7149 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7151 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7152 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7154 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7155 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7156 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7157 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7159 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7160 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7161 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7162 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7164 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7165 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7166 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7167 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7168 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7169 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7170 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7171 password value. For example:
7173 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7176 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7177 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7178 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7179 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7182 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7183 .cindex lookup Redis
7184 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7185 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7188 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7189 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7190 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is
7191 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7194 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7195 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7197 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7198 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7199 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
7200 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7201 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7202 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7203 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7204 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7205 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7206 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7208 require condition = \
7209 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7211 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7212 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7213 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7214 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7219 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7220 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7221 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7222 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7223 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7224 options such as a list of local domains.
7226 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7227 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7228 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7229 or may give up altogether.
7233 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7234 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7235 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7236 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7237 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7238 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7239 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7240 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7242 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7243 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7244 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7246 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7247 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7248 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7250 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7251 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7252 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7253 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7254 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7255 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7256 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7257 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7258 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7259 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7261 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7263 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7264 looks up these keys, in this order:
7270 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7271 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7272 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7273 Exim move on to try the next key.
7277 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7278 .cindex "partial matching"
7279 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7280 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7281 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7282 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7283 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7284 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7285 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7286 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7287 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7288 a key in a DBM file is
7290 *.dates.fict.example
7292 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7293 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7294 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7297 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7298 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7299 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7301 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7302 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7303 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7304 partial matching keys
7305 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7306 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7307 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7309 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7310 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7311 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7312 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7313 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7314 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7317 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7318 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7319 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7320 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7321 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7322 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7324 2250.dates.fict.example
7325 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7326 *.dates.fict.example
7329 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7332 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7333 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7334 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7335 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7336 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7337 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7339 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7341 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7342 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7343 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7344 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7346 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7348 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7349 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7351 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7352 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7353 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7356 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7358 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7359 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7361 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7362 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7363 for &"*"& on its own.
7365 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7369 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7370 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7371 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7372 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7373 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7374 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7375 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7377 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7378 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7379 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7380 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7381 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7386 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7387 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7388 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7389 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7390 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7391 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7392 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7394 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7395 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7396 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7397 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7398 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7399 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7401 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7402 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7408 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7409 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7410 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7411 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7412 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7413 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7417 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7418 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7420 [name="$local_part"]
7422 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7423 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7424 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7425 of the following form is provided:
7427 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7429 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7431 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7433 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7434 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7435 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7440 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7441 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7442 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7443 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7444 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7445 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7446 an expansion string could contain:
7448 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7450 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7451 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7452 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7453 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7455 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7456 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7457 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7459 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7460 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7461 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7462 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7463 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7465 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7467 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7468 white space is ignored.
7469 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7470 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7471 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7473 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7474 When the type is PTR,
7475 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7476 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7478 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7480 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7481 altered and nothing is added.
7483 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7484 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7485 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7486 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7487 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7488 The field separator can be modified as above.
7490 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7491 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7492 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7493 unless a field separator is specified.
7494 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7496 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7498 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7499 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7500 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7502 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7503 white space is ignored.
7505 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7506 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7507 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7508 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7511 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7514 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7515 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7516 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7517 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7518 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7519 each followed by a comma,
7520 that may appear before the record type.
7522 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7523 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7524 a defer-option modifier.
7525 The possible keywords are
7526 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7527 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7528 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7529 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7530 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7531 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7532 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7534 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7535 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7537 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7538 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7540 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7541 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7542 The possible keywords are
7543 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7544 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7546 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7547 is not labelled as authenticated data
7548 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7549 The default is &"lax"&.
7551 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7553 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7554 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7555 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7556 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7558 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7560 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7561 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7562 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7564 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7565 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7567 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7568 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7569 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7572 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7573 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7574 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7575 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7576 the pseudo-type MXH:
7578 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7580 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7583 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7584 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7585 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7586 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7587 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7588 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7589 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7590 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7592 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7593 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7595 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7596 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7597 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7599 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7600 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7601 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7602 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7603 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7606 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7607 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7608 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7609 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7610 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7611 result of a successful lookup such as:
7613 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7615 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7616 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7617 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7619 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7620 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7621 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7622 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7624 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7628 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7629 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7630 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7631 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7632 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7634 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7635 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7636 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7638 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7639 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7640 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7641 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7643 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7644 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7645 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7650 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7651 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7652 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7653 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7654 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7655 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7656 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7657 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7658 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7659 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7660 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7661 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7663 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7664 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7665 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7666 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7667 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7669 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7670 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7672 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7673 the way they handle the results of a query:
7676 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7679 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7680 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7682 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7683 from all of them are returned.
7687 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7688 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7689 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7690 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7693 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7694 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7695 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7696 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7698 data = ${lookup ldap \
7699 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7700 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7702 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7703 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7704 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7705 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7707 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7708 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7709 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7711 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7712 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7713 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7714 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7715 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7716 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7717 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7718 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7722 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7723 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7724 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7725 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7726 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7727 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7729 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7730 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7738 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7739 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7743 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7745 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7749 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7751 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7753 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7755 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7756 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7757 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7761 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7762 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7763 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7765 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7769 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7771 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7773 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7775 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7776 authentication below.
7779 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7780 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7781 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7782 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7783 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7786 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7788 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7789 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7790 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7791 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7792 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7793 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7794 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7795 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7796 failures, and timeouts.
7798 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7799 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7800 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7801 doubled. For example
7803 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7805 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7806 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7807 the local host) is used.
7809 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7810 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7811 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7812 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7815 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7816 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7817 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7818 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7820 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7822 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7823 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7825 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7827 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7828 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7829 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7830 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7831 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7832 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7833 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7836 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7837 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7838 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7841 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7844 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7848 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7849 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7853 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7854 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7855 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7856 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7857 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7858 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7859 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7860 them. The following names are recognized:
7862 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7863 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7864 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7865 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7866 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7867 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7868 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7869 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7871 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7872 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7873 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7874 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7876 .cindex LDAP timeout
7877 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7878 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7879 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7880 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7881 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7882 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7883 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7884 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7885 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7886 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7888 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7889 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7891 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7892 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7893 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7894 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7895 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7896 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7897 alternate list (colon-separated).
7899 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7900 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7903 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7904 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7907 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7908 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7909 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7910 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7912 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7913 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7914 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7916 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7917 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7918 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7919 quoting has two advantages:
7922 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7923 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7925 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7928 For example, a setting such as
7930 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7932 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7934 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7935 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7936 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7937 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7941 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7942 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7947 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7948 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7949 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7950 as a sequence of values, for example
7952 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7954 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7955 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7956 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7957 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7958 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7961 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7962 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7963 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7964 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7966 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7967 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7968 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7969 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7970 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7971 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7972 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7973 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7974 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7976 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7977 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7978 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7979 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7980 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7983 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7986 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7989 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7990 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7992 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7993 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7995 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7996 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7999 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
8000 results of LDAP lookups.
8001 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
8002 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
8003 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
8004 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
8005 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
8006 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
8011 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
8012 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
8013 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
8014 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8015 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8016 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8017 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8018 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8020 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8022 might return the string
8024 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8025 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8027 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8029 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8035 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8036 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8037 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8041 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8042 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8043 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8044 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8045 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8046 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8047 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8048 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8049 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8050 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8051 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8052 .cindex lookup Redis
8053 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8055 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8058 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8061 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8062 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8064 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8069 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8071 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8072 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8073 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8077 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8078 with a newline between the data for each row.
8081 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
8082 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8083 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8084 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8085 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8086 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8087 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8088 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8089 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8090 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8091 .cindex lookup Redis
8092 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8093 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8094 or &%redis_servers%&
8095 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8097 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8098 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8099 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8100 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8101 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8102 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8103 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8104 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8106 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8107 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8108 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8109 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8111 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8113 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8114 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8115 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8117 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8118 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8120 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8121 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8122 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8123 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8124 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8125 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8127 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8128 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8129 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8131 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8132 host, database number, and password.
8134 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8135 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8136 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8138 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8140 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8143 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8144 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8145 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8146 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8148 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8149 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8151 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
8152 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8153 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8154 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8156 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8158 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8160 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8161 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8162 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8165 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8167 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8168 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8169 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8171 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8172 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8173 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8176 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8180 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8182 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8184 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8185 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8186 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8188 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8191 An older syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8192 semicolon separated:
8194 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8196 The new version avoids potential issues with tainted
8197 arguments in the query, for explicit expansion.
8198 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8201 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
8202 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8203 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8204 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8205 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8206 the default value is &"exim"&.
8207 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8209 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8210 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8212 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8213 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8215 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8218 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8219 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8221 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8222 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8223 is zero because no rows are affected.
8226 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8227 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8228 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8229 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8230 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8233 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8235 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8236 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8237 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8239 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8240 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8243 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8244 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8245 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8246 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8247 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8248 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8251 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8252 There are two ways of
8253 specifying the file.
8254 The first is is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8255 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8256 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8257 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8259 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8262 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8263 separated by white space.
8265 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8266 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8267 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8270 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8272 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8274 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8276 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8278 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8280 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8281 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8283 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8284 quote, which it doubles.
8286 .cindex timeout SQLite
8287 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8288 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8289 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8290 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8291 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8292 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8293 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8296 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8297 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8298 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8299 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8302 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8303 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8306 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8307 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8308 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8309 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8312 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8313 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8314 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8321 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8322 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8324 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8325 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8326 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8327 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8328 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8329 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8330 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8331 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8332 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8334 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8335 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8336 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8337 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8339 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8340 support all the complexity available in
8341 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8345 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8346 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8347 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8349 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8350 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8353 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8354 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8355 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8356 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8357 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8360 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8361 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8362 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8364 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8365 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8366 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8367 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8368 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8370 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8371 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8373 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8374 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8375 senders based on the receiving domain.
8380 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8381 .cindex "list" "negation"
8382 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8383 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8384 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8385 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8386 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8387 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8389 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8390 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8391 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8392 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8393 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8395 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8397 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8398 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8399 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8401 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8403 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8404 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8405 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8407 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8408 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8413 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8414 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8415 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8416 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8417 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8418 filenames are not allowed,
8419 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8420 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8424 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8425 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8427 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8428 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8429 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8431 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8435 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8436 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8437 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8438 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8440 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8441 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8443 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8445 and the file contains the lines
8450 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8451 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8455 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8456 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8457 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8458 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8459 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8460 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8461 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8462 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8464 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8465 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8466 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8467 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8472 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8473 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8474 In some contexts additional information is stored
8475 about the list element that matched:
8478 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8479 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8481 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8482 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8485 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8486 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable
8489 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8490 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8492 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8493 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8496 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8497 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8502 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8503 .cindex "named lists"
8504 .cindex "list" "named"
8505 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8506 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8507 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8508 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8509 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8510 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8511 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8513 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8515 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8516 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8517 configured with the line
8519 domains = +local_domains
8521 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8522 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8526 domains = ! +local_domains
8527 transport = remote_smtp
8530 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8531 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8532 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8533 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8535 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8536 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8538 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8540 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8541 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8542 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8544 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8545 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8546 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8548 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8549 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8551 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8552 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8553 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8555 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8557 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8558 referenced lists if you can.
8560 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8561 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8562 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8563 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8564 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8565 word &"hide"&. For example:
8567 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8571 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8572 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8573 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8575 domains = +local_domains
8577 on several of your routers
8578 or in several ACL statements,
8579 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8580 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8581 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8582 the same each time they are referenced.
8584 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8585 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8586 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8587 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8591 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8592 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8593 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8594 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8595 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8598 ALIST = host1 : host2
8599 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8601 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8603 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8605 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8608 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8609 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8611 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8613 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8617 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8618 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8619 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8620 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8621 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8622 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8623 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8624 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8625 message. For example:
8627 domainlist special_domains = \
8628 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8630 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8631 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8632 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8633 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8634 same list each time.
8636 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8637 cache the result anyway. For example:
8639 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8641 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8642 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8646 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8647 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8648 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8649 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8650 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8653 .cindex "primary host name"
8654 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8655 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8656 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8657 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8658 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8659 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8660 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8661 differ only in their names.
8663 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8667 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8668 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8669 .cindex "domain literal"
8670 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8671 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8672 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8673 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8674 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8675 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8676 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8678 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8683 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8684 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8685 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8686 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8687 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8688 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8689 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8690 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8691 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8692 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8693 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8695 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8696 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8697 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8698 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8699 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8701 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8702 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8703 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8704 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8705 on a router). For example:
8707 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8709 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8710 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8712 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8713 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8714 contain negative items.
8716 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8717 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8718 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8720 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8721 an.other.domain : ...
8723 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8724 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8726 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8727 an.other.domain ? ...
8729 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8733 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8734 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8735 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8736 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8737 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8738 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8739 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8740 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8741 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8744 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8745 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8746 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8749 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8750 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8751 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8752 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8753 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8754 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8755 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8756 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8757 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8759 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8760 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8761 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8762 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8763 expression by expansion, of course).
8765 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8766 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8767 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8772 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8773 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8774 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8775 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8776 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8777 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8779 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8781 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8782 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8783 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8784 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8785 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8786 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8787 other statements in the same ACL.
8788 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8789 The value will be untainted.
8792 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8793 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8794 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8795 may be what is wanted.
8800 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8801 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8803 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8805 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8806 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8809 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8810 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8811 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8812 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8813 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8814 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8818 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8819 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8820 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8821 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8823 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8824 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8826 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8827 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8828 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8829 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8830 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8831 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8832 The value will be untainted.
8835 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8836 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8837 followed by a comma and options,
8838 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8839 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=".
8842 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8843 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8844 between the pattern and the domain.
8846 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8847 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8848 Note that this is commonly untainted
8849 (depending on the way the list was created).
8850 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8851 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8852 the domain, for later operations.
8854 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8855 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8856 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8860 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8862 domainlist funny_domains = \
8865 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8866 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8867 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8868 nis;domains.byname : \
8869 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8871 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8872 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8873 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8874 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8875 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8880 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8881 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8882 .cindex "list" "host list"
8883 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8884 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8885 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8886 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8887 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8888 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8889 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8892 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8893 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8894 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8895 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8896 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8897 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8900 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8901 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8902 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8906 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8907 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8908 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8909 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8910 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8911 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8912 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8915 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8916 inspecting its IP address:
8919 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8920 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8921 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8922 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8923 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8924 with the IP address of the subject host.
8926 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8927 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8928 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8929 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8930 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8933 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8934 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8935 domain name, as just described.
8938 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8939 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8940 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8941 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8942 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8943 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8944 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8945 that can never match a client host.
8948 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8949 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8950 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8951 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8953 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8957 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8958 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8959 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8960 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8961 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8962 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8963 significant end of the address.
8965 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8966 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8967 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8968 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8972 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8973 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8976 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8978 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8979 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8981 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8982 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8985 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8987 could make use of a file containing
8992 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8993 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8994 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8996 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8999 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9005 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9006 "SECThoslispatsikey"
9007 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9008 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9009 address, the pattern takes this form:
9011 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9015 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9017 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9018 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9019 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9020 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9021 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9022 returned by the lookup is not used.
9024 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9025 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9026 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9027 patterns of this form:
9029 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9033 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9035 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9036 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9037 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9038 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9039 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9041 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9042 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9043 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9044 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9045 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9046 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9047 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9048 converted using colons and not dots.
9049 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9050 addresses are always used.
9051 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9053 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9054 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9055 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9058 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9059 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9060 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9061 case the IP address is used on its own.
9065 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
9066 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9067 .cindex "unknown host name"
9068 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9069 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9070 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9071 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9072 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9075 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9076 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9077 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9078 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9079 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9080 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9081 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9083 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9084 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9086 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9087 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9088 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9089 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9090 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9091 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9092 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9093 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9094 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9096 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9097 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9099 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9100 .cindex "alias for host"
9101 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9102 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9105 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9106 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9107 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9108 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9109 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9112 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9113 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9114 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9115 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9116 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9117 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9118 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9123 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9124 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9125 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9126 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9127 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9129 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9131 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9132 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9133 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9140 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
9141 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9142 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9143 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9144 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9145 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9147 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9148 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9150 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9151 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9152 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9153 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9154 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9155 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9156 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9157 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9158 not recognized in an indirected file).
9161 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9162 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9164 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9166 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9167 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9170 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9171 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9174 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9177 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9178 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9179 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9182 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9183 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9186 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9188 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9190 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9191 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9192 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9195 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9196 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9197 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9199 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9201 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9202 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9203 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9204 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9205 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9206 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9207 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9210 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9211 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9213 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9214 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9216 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9217 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9218 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9223 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9225 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9226 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9227 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9228 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9229 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9230 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9231 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9232 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9233 host lists such as whitelists.
9237 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9238 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
9239 .cindex "unknown host name"
9240 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9241 If a pattern is of the form
9243 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9247 dbm;/host/accept/list
9249 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9250 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9253 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9254 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9255 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
9256 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9257 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9258 lookup, both using the same file.
9262 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
9263 If a pattern is of the form
9265 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9267 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9268 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9269 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9271 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9272 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9274 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9275 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9276 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9279 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9280 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9281 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9283 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9284 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9285 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9286 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9287 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9288 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9294 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9295 .cindex "list" "address list"
9296 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9297 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9298 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9299 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9300 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9301 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9302 using this option setting:
9306 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9307 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9308 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9309 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9311 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9314 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9316 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9317 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9318 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9319 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9320 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9321 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9322 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9324 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9325 *@+hostile_domains:\
9326 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9327 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9329 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9330 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9331 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9332 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9333 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9335 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9336 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9337 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9338 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9339 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9341 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9344 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9345 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9349 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9350 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9351 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9352 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9353 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9354 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9355 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9357 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9358 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9360 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9361 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9364 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9365 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9366 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9369 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9370 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9371 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9373 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9374 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9375 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9376 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9378 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9379 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9381 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9382 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9383 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9384 default. For example, with this lookup:
9386 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9388 the file could contains lines like this:
9390 user1@domain1.example
9393 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9396 nimrod@jaeger.example
9400 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9401 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9403 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9405 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9406 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9408 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9409 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9410 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9414 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9415 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9420 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9421 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9422 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9423 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9424 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9425 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9426 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9427 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9428 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9430 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9431 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9432 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9433 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9434 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9437 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9439 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9441 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9443 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9445 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9446 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9447 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9448 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9449 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9450 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9452 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9455 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9458 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9459 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9460 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9461 might have entries like
9463 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9464 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9467 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9468 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9469 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9470 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9472 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9473 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9474 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9477 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9478 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9479 can only return a single list of local parts.
9482 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9483 in these two examples:
9486 senders = *@+my_list
9488 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9489 example it is a named domain list.
9494 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9495 .cindex "case of local parts"
9496 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9497 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9498 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9499 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9500 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9501 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9502 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9503 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9506 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9507 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9508 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9509 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9510 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9511 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9512 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9515 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9516 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9517 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9518 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9519 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9520 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9521 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9522 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9526 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9527 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9528 .cindex "local part" "list"
9529 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9532 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9533 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9534 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9535 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9536 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9537 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9538 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9539 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9541 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9542 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9543 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9544 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9545 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9546 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9547 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9549 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9557 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9558 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9559 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9560 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9562 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9563 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9564 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9565 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9566 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9567 escape character, as described in the following section.
9569 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9570 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9571 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9572 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9573 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9575 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9576 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9577 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9578 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9580 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9584 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9586 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9587 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9588 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9589 or the password file,
9590 or accessed via a DBMS.
9591 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9596 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9597 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9598 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9599 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9600 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9601 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9602 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9603 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9605 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9606 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9607 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9608 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9610 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9612 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9613 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9618 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9619 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9620 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9621 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9622 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9623 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9624 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9627 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9628 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9629 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9632 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9633 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9634 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9636 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9637 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9638 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9639 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9640 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9641 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9642 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9645 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9646 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9647 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9650 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9651 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9652 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9653 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9655 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9657 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9658 Exim message identifier. For example:
9660 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9662 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9663 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9666 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9667 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9668 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9669 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9670 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9671 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9672 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9673 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9674 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9675 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9676 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9677 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9683 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9684 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9685 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9686 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9687 white space is significant.
9690 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9691 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9692 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9697 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9698 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9699 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9700 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9701 given, the expansion fails.
9703 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9704 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9705 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9706 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9710 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9711 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9712 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9713 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9714 string easier to understand.
9716 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9717 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9718 expansion item below.
9721 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9722 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9723 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9724 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9725 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9726 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9727 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9728 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9729 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9730 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9731 the result of the expansion.
9732 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9733 the expansion result is an empty string.
9734 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9737 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9738 .cindex authentication "results header"
9739 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9740 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9741 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9742 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9744 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9745 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9746 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9755 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9757 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9759 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9762 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9763 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9764 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9765 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9766 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9767 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9768 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9769 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9773 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9774 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9779 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9783 If the field is found,
9784 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9785 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9786 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9787 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9789 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9790 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9793 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9795 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9796 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9798 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9799 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9800 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9801 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9802 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9803 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9804 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9805 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9807 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9808 take an optional modifier of "int"
9809 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9810 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9811 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9813 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9814 newline-separated by default,
9815 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9816 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9817 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9819 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9820 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9821 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9822 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9823 if so the element tags are omitted.
9825 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9827 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9828 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9830 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9831 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9835 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9836 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9837 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9839 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9842 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9843 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9844 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9845 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9846 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9847 must have the following type:
9849 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9851 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9852 function should return one of the following values:
9854 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9855 into the expanded string that is being built.
9857 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9858 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9860 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9861 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9863 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9865 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9866 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9867 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9870 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9871 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9872 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9873 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9875 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9876 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9877 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9879 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9880 appear, for example:
9882 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9884 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9885 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9887 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9889 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9892 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9893 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9896 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9897 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9898 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9899 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9900 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9901 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9902 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9903 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9905 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9908 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9909 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9910 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9911 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9912 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9913 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9914 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9915 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9916 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9918 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9919 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9920 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9923 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9924 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9926 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9927 appear, for example:
9929 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9931 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9932 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9934 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9935 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9936 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9937 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9938 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9939 .cindex JSON expansions
9940 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9941 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9942 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9943 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9945 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9948 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9949 the spaces are optional.
9950 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9951 For the &"json"& variant,
9952 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9954 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9955 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9956 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9958 The results of matching are handled as above.
9961 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9962 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9963 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9964 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9965 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9966 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9967 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9968 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9969 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9970 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9971 <&'string3'&> as before.
9973 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9974 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9975 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9976 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9977 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9978 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9979 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9980 provided. For example:
9982 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9986 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9988 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9989 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9992 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9993 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9994 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9995 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9996 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9997 .cindex JSON expansions
9998 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9999 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10001 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10002 there is no choice of field separator.
10003 For the &"json"& variant,
10004 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10006 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10007 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10010 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10011 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10012 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10014 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10015 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10017 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
10018 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10019 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10020 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10021 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10023 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10025 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10026 to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10029 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10030 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10031 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10032 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10033 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10034 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10036 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10037 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10038 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10039 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10041 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10043 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10044 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10045 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10046 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10047 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10049 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10051 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10052 letters appear. For example:
10054 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10055 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10056 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10059 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10060 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10061 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10062 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10063 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10064 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10065 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10066 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10067 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10068 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10069 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10070 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10071 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10072 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10073 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10074 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10075 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10079 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10080 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10081 lines) may be present.
10083 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10084 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10087 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10088 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10089 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10092 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10093 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10094 are multiple headers with a given name.
10095 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10096 list-processing facilities can be used.
10097 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10098 the content is &"raw"&.
10101 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10102 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10103 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10104 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10105 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10106 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10107 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10108 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10111 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10112 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10113 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10114 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10115 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10116 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10119 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10120 command of the following form:
10122 headers charset "UTF-8"
10124 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10125 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10126 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10127 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10128 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10131 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
10132 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10133 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10134 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10136 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10137 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10138 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10139 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10140 router or transport are not accessible.
10142 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10143 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10144 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10145 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10146 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10147 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10148 point they are added.
10149 When any of the above ACLs ar
10150 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10152 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10153 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10154 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10155 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10156 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10157 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10158 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10161 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10162 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10163 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10164 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10165 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10166 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10167 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10168 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10170 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10171 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10172 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10175 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10176 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10178 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10179 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10180 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10181 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10182 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10183 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10184 present. For example:
10186 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10188 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10191 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10193 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10194 an Exim configuration:
10196 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10198 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10201 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10202 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10203 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10205 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10206 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10207 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10208 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10209 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10210 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10213 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10214 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10215 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10216 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10217 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10218 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10220 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10222 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10223 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10224 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10225 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10226 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10228 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10229 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10230 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10232 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10236 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10241 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10242 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10243 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10244 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10245 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10246 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10250 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10251 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10252 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10253 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10254 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10255 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10256 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10257 some of the braces:
10259 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10261 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10262 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10263 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10264 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10267 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10268 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10269 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10270 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10271 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10272 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10273 apart from an optional leading minus,
10274 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10276 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10277 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10279 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10280 If the number is negative, the fields are
10281 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10282 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10283 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10285 If the modulus of the
10286 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10287 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10291 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10295 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10297 yields &"result: 42"&.
10299 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10300 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10302 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10306 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10307 .cindex quoting "for list"
10308 .cindex list quoting
10309 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10310 in the given string.
10311 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10312 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10313 in a list using the given separator.
10317 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10318 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10319 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10320 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10321 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10322 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10323 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10324 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10325 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10326 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10327 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10329 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10330 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10331 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10332 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10333 out by the system administrator.
10335 .vindex "&$value$&"
10336 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10337 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10338 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10339 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10340 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10341 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10342 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10343 original lookup fails.
10345 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10346 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10347 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10348 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10349 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10350 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10351 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10352 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10354 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10355 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10356 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10357 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10359 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10360 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10361 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10362 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10364 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10366 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10368 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10369 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10371 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10376 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10377 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10379 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10380 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10382 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10383 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10384 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10385 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10387 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10389 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10390 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10391 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10393 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10394 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10395 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10396 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10397 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10398 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10399 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10401 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10403 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10404 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10405 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10406 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10409 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10411 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10415 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10416 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10417 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10418 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10419 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10420 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10421 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10422 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10424 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10425 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10426 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10427 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10428 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10431 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10432 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10433 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10435 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10436 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10439 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10440 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10441 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10442 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10443 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10444 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10445 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10446 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10448 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10449 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10450 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10451 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10452 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10453 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10454 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10455 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10456 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10457 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10459 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10460 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10461 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10462 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10464 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10465 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10466 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10467 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10468 is the expansion of the third argument.
10470 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10471 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10472 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10474 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10475 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10476 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10477 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10478 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10479 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10480 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10481 newlines are left in the string.
10482 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10483 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10484 the string expansion fails.
10486 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10487 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10491 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10492 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10493 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10494 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10495 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10496 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10497 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10500 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10501 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10503 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10504 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10505 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10506 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10507 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10510 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10512 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10513 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10514 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10515 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10516 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10517 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10518 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10520 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10523 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10524 and must be present if any options are given.
10525 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10528 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10531 The following option names are recognised:
10534 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10535 request in the same process.
10536 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10537 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10538 will be invalidated.
10542 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10543 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10544 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10548 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10549 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10550 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10554 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10555 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10556 turns them into spaces:
10558 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10560 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10561 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10562 addition, the following errors can occur:
10565 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10567 Failure to connect the socket;
10569 Failure to write the request string;
10571 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10574 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10575 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10576 errors occurs. For example:
10578 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10581 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10582 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10583 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10584 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10585 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10587 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10588 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10591 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10592 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10593 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10594 .vindex "&$value$&"
10596 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10597 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10598 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10599 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10600 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10601 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10602 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10603 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10604 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10605 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10607 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10609 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10612 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10614 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10615 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10618 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10619 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10620 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10622 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10623 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10624 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10625 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10626 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10627 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10628 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10629 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10630 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10632 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10633 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10634 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10635 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10636 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10637 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10638 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10639 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10640 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10643 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10644 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10645 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10646 .vindex "&$value$&"
10647 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10648 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10649 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10650 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10651 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10654 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10655 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10656 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10657 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10659 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10660 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10661 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10664 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10665 log_message = Output of id: $value
10667 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10668 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10670 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10673 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10674 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10675 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10677 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10678 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10682 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10683 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10686 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10687 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10688 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10689 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10691 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10692 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10695 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10696 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10697 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10698 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10699 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10700 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10701 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10702 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10704 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10706 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10707 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10708 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10710 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10712 yields &"defabc"&, and
10714 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10716 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10717 the regular expression from string expansion.
10719 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10720 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10723 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10724 .cindex sorting "a list"
10725 .cindex list sorting
10726 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10727 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10728 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10729 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10730 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10731 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10732 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10733 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10734 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10735 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10736 to give values for comparison.
10738 The item result is a sorted list,
10739 with the original list separator,
10740 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10744 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10746 sorts a list of numbers, and
10748 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10750 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10755 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10756 SRS encoding. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10761 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10762 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10763 .cindex "substring extraction"
10764 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10765 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10766 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10767 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10768 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10770 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10772 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10773 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10776 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10777 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10778 length required. For example
10780 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10782 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10783 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10784 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10785 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10787 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10788 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10789 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10791 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10793 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10794 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10795 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10797 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10799 yields an empty string, but
10801 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10805 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10806 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10807 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10808 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10811 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10813 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10815 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10819 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10820 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10821 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10822 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10823 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10824 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10825 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10826 replacement list. For example
10828 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10830 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10831 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10832 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10835 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10841 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10842 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10843 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10844 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10845 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10846 following operations can be performed:
10849 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10850 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10851 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10852 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10853 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10854 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10856 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10859 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10860 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10861 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10862 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10863 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10864 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10865 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10866 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10867 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10869 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10870 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10871 character. For example:
10873 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10875 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10876 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10877 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10878 separator explicitly:
10880 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10883 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10884 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10885 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10888 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10889 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10890 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10891 email address separator. For the example header line:
10893 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10895 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10896 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10897 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10898 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10899 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10900 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10901 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10903 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10904 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10906 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10907 Last:user@example.com
10908 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10910 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10914 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10915 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10916 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10917 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10918 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10919 Only lowercase letters are used.
10921 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10922 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10923 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10924 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10925 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10927 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10928 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10929 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10930 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10931 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10932 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10933 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10934 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10935 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10937 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10938 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10939 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10940 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10941 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10942 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10945 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10946 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10947 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10948 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10949 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10950 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10952 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10953 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10956 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10957 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10958 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10959 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10960 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10963 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10964 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10965 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10966 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10967 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10970 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10971 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10972 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10973 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10974 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10975 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10976 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10978 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10979 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10980 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10981 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10982 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10983 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10986 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10987 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10988 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10989 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10990 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10991 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10992 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10993 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10994 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10995 C programming language):
10997 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10998 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10999 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11000 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11001 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11003 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11005 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11006 space is permitted before or after operators.
11008 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11009 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11010 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11011 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11012 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11014 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11016 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11017 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11020 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11021 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11022 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11023 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11024 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11025 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11026 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11027 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11028 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11029 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11030 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11033 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11037 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11040 {$recipients_count} \
11041 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11044 message = Too many bad recipients
11046 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11047 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11050 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11051 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11052 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11055 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11057 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11058 and then re-expands what it has found.
11061 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11063 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11064 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11065 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11066 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11067 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11068 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11069 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11070 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11071 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11073 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11074 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11075 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11076 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11077 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11078 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11079 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11082 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11084 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11085 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11086 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11087 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11089 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11091 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11092 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11096 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11097 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11098 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11099 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11100 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11101 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11105 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11106 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11107 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11108 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11109 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11110 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11111 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11114 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11115 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11116 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11117 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11118 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11119 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11120 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11122 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11123 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11124 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11125 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11126 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11127 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11128 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11129 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11130 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11133 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11134 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11135 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11136 .cindex "lower casing"
11137 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11138 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11139 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11143 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11145 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11146 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11147 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11148 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11149 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11150 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11152 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11154 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11155 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11156 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11157 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11160 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11161 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11162 .cindex "list" "item count"
11163 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11164 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11165 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11168 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11169 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11170 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11171 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11172 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11173 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11174 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11175 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11176 matching list is returned.
11179 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11180 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11181 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11182 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11183 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11185 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11188 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11189 .cindex "masked IP address"
11190 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11191 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11192 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11193 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11194 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11195 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11196 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11197 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11198 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11200 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11202 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
11203 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
11204 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11205 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11207 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11211 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11213 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11216 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11218 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11219 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11220 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11221 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11222 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11224 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11225 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11228 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11229 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11230 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11231 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11232 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11233 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11235 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11237 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11240 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11241 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11242 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11243 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11244 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11245 is an empty string or
11246 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11247 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11248 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11249 respectively For example,
11257 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11258 variable or a message header.
11260 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11261 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11262 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11263 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11264 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11265 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11266 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11268 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11269 will likely use the quoting form.
11270 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11273 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11274 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11275 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11276 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11277 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11279 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11285 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11286 yields an unchanged string.
11289 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11290 .cindex "random number"
11291 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11292 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11293 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11294 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11295 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11296 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11297 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11298 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11302 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11303 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11304 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11305 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11306 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11307 for DNS. For example,
11309 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11310 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11315 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11319 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11320 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11321 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11322 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11323 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11324 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11325 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11326 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11327 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11330 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11332 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11333 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11337 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11338 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11339 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11340 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11341 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11342 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11343 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11344 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11346 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11347 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11348 to use this operator as well.
11352 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11353 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11354 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11355 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11356 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11357 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11358 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11361 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11362 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11363 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11364 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11365 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11366 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11367 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11369 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11370 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11373 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11374 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11375 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11376 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11377 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11378 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11379 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11380 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11381 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11382 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11384 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11386 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11387 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11389 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11390 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11391 Finally, if an underbar
11392 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11393 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11394 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11397 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11398 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11399 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11400 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11401 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11402 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11404 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11406 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11407 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11408 with 256 being the default.
11410 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11411 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11412 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11413 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11416 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11417 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11418 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11419 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11420 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11421 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11422 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11423 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11424 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11425 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11426 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11427 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11428 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11430 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11431 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11432 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11434 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11435 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11436 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11440 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11441 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11442 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11443 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11444 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11445 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11446 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11449 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11450 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11451 .cindex "substring extraction"
11452 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11453 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11454 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11455 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11457 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11459 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11460 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11461 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11463 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11464 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11465 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11466 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11469 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11470 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11471 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11472 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11473 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11474 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11477 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11478 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11479 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11480 .cindex "upper casing"
11481 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11482 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11483 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11484 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11486 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11487 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11488 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11489 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11490 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11491 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11492 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11493 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11494 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11495 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11496 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11497 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11498 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11499 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11501 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11503 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11504 literal question mark).
11506 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11507 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11508 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11509 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11510 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11511 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11513 .cindex internationalisation
11514 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11515 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11516 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11517 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11518 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11519 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11527 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11528 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11529 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11530 while expanding strings:
11533 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11534 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11535 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11536 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11539 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11540 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11541 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11542 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11548 &`>= `& greater or equal
11550 &`<= `& less or equal
11554 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11556 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11557 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11558 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11559 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11560 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11563 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11564 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11565 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11568 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11569 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11570 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11571 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11572 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11573 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11574 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11575 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11576 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11577 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11578 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11579 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11580 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11581 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11583 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11584 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11585 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11586 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11587 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11588 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11590 An empty string is treated as false.
11591 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11592 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11593 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11595 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11596 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11599 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11603 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11604 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11605 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11606 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11607 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11608 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11609 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11610 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11612 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11614 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11615 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11616 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11617 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11618 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11619 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11620 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11621 included in the binary.
11623 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11624 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11625 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11626 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11627 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11628 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11629 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11630 string in LDAP form is:
11632 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11634 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11635 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11637 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11639 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11644 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11645 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11646 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11647 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11648 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11649 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11653 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11654 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11655 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11656 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11657 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11658 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11661 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11662 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11663 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11664 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11665 whatever its length.
11668 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11669 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11670 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11671 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11673 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11674 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11675 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11676 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11677 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11678 support &[crypt16()]&.
11680 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11681 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11682 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11683 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11684 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11686 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11687 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11688 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11690 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11691 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11692 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11693 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11694 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11696 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11697 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11698 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11699 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11700 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11701 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11703 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11705 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11706 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11708 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11709 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11710 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11711 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11712 exists in the message. For example,
11714 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11716 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11717 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11719 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11720 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11721 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11722 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11723 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11724 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11725 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11726 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11727 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11728 case is defined per the system C locale.
11730 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11731 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11732 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11733 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11734 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11735 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11736 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11737 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11740 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11742 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11745 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11746 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11747 .cindex "first delivery"
11748 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11749 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11750 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11751 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11754 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11755 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11756 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11757 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11758 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11760 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11761 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11762 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11763 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11764 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11765 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11767 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11768 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11769 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11771 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11772 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11773 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11775 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11776 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11777 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11778 list separator is changed to a comma:
11780 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11782 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11783 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11785 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11787 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11788 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11789 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11790 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11791 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11792 .cindex JSON expansions
11793 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11794 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11795 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11796 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11797 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11799 The array separator is not changeable.
11800 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11801 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11805 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11806 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11807 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11808 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11809 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11810 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11811 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11812 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11813 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11815 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11817 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11818 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11819 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11820 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11821 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11822 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11823 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11824 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11825 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11827 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11831 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11832 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11836 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11837 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11838 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11839 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11840 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11841 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11843 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11845 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11846 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11848 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11849 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11850 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11851 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11854 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11855 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11856 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11857 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11858 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11859 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11860 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11861 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11862 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11863 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11864 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11866 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11867 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11868 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11869 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11870 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11872 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11873 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11875 This is no longer the case.
11877 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11878 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11880 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11882 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11884 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11885 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11886 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11887 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11888 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11889 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11890 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11891 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11892 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11893 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11894 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11895 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11896 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11900 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11901 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11902 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11903 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11904 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11905 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11906 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11907 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11908 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11910 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11912 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11913 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11914 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11915 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11916 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11917 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11918 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11919 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11920 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11922 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11925 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11926 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11927 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11928 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11929 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11930 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11931 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11932 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11933 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11934 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11935 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11938 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11940 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11941 backslashes is also required.
11943 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11944 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11945 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11946 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11947 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11948 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11949 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11950 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11952 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11953 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11954 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11955 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11956 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11957 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11958 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11959 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11961 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11962 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11963 See &*match_local_part*&.
11965 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11966 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11967 See &*match_local_part*&.
11969 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11970 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11971 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11972 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11973 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11974 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11976 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11978 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11981 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11983 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11985 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11986 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11987 in a single test such as
11988 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11989 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11990 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11991 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11993 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11995 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11997 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11999 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
12000 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12001 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12002 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12003 masks. For example:
12005 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12007 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12008 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12009 address mask, for example:
12011 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12013 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12014 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12016 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12020 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12021 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12023 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12025 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12026 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12027 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12028 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12029 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12030 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12031 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12032 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12035 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12037 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12038 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12039 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12040 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12042 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12044 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12045 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12046 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
12047 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
12050 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12051 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12053 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12054 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12055 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12056 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12058 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12059 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12060 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12061 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12062 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12063 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12064 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12065 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12066 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
12067 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12068 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12072 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12073 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12075 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12076 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12077 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12078 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12079 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12080 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12081 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12083 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12084 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12086 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12087 For example, the configuration
12088 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12090 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12092 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12093 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12094 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12095 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12098 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12099 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12101 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12102 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12103 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12104 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12105 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12106 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12108 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12109 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12110 building Exim. For example:
12112 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12114 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12115 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12116 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12117 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12119 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12120 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12121 configuration, you might have this:
12123 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12125 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12127 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12129 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12130 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12131 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12132 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12133 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12134 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12137 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12139 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12140 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12141 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12142 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12143 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12146 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12147 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12148 this library, you need to set
12150 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12152 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12153 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12155 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12157 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12158 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12159 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12161 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12162 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12163 the authentication is successful. For example:
12165 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12169 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12170 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12171 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12173 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12174 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12175 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12176 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12177 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12178 by a process that is not running as root.
12180 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12181 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12182 building Exim. For example:
12184 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12186 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12187 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12188 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12190 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12191 two are mandatory. For example:
12193 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12195 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12196 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12197 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12202 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12203 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12204 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12205 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12206 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12207 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12208 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12212 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12213 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12214 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12215 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12216 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12219 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12221 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12222 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12223 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12225 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12226 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12227 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12228 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12229 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12230 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12231 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12232 parsed but not evaluated.
12234 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12239 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12240 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12241 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12242 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12243 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12246 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12247 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12248 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12249 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12250 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12251 In the expansion condition case
12252 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12253 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12254 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12255 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12256 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12257 matching condition.
12259 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12260 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12261 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12262 any unused variables being made empty.
12264 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12265 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12266 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12267 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12268 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12269 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12270 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12271 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12272 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12273 during subsequent delivery.
12275 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12276 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12277 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12278 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12279 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12280 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12281 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12282 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12285 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12286 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12287 this variable has the number of arguments.
12289 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12290 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12291 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12292 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
12293 be preserved by coding like this:
12295 warn !verify = sender
12296 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12298 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12299 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12302 .vitem &$address_data$&
12303 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12304 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12305 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12306 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12307 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12308 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12311 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12312 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12313 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12314 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12315 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12316 from the child's routing.
12318 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12319 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12320 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12323 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12324 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12325 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12327 .vitem &$address_file$&
12328 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12329 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12330 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12331 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12332 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12334 /home/r2d2/savemail
12336 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12337 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12338 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12339 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12340 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12341 to the relevant file.
12343 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12344 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12345 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12346 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12348 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12349 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12350 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12351 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12353 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12354 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12355 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12356 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12357 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12358 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12359 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12360 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12361 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12363 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12364 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12365 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12366 command line option.
12367 This second case also sets up information used by the
12368 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12370 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12371 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12372 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12373 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12374 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12375 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12376 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12377 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12378 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12382 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
12383 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12384 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12385 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12386 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12387 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12388 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12389 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12390 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12391 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12392 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12394 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12395 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12396 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12397 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12398 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12401 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12402 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12403 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12404 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12405 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12406 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12407 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12408 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12409 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12410 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12411 an undefined mechanism.
12413 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12414 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12415 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12416 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12417 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12418 the ACL malware condition.
12420 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12421 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12422 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12423 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12424 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12425 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12427 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12428 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12429 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12430 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12431 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12432 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12433 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12435 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12436 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12437 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12438 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12439 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12441 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12442 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12443 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12444 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12445 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12447 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12448 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12449 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12450 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12451 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12452 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12453 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12455 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12456 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12457 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12458 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12459 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12460 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12461 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12463 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12464 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12465 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12466 address that was connected to.
12468 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12469 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12470 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12471 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12472 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12474 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12475 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12476 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12477 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12478 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12479 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12481 .vitem &$config_file$&
12482 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12483 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12485 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12486 Results of DKIM verification.
12487 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12489 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12490 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12491 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12492 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12493 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12495 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12496 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12497 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12498 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12499 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12500 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12501 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12502 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12503 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12504 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12505 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12506 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12507 &$dkim_key_length$&
12508 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12509 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12511 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12512 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12513 When a message has been received this variable contains
12514 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12515 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12517 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12518 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12519 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12520 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12521 Results of DMARC verification.
12522 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12524 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12525 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12526 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12528 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12529 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12530 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12531 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12532 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12533 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12534 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12535 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12536 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12539 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12540 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12541 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12542 case for &$domain$&.
12544 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12545 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12546 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12547 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12549 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12550 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12551 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12552 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12553 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12554 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12556 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12557 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12558 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12560 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12563 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12564 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12565 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12566 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12567 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12568 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12569 the &(smtp)& transport.
12572 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12573 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12574 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12575 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12578 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12579 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12580 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12581 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12582 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12583 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12586 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12587 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12588 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12589 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12592 .cindex "tainted data"
12593 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12594 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12595 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12596 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12597 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12598 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12601 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12602 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12603 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12607 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12608 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12609 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12610 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12613 If the router routes the
12614 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12615 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12618 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12619 the rest of the ACL statement.
12621 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12622 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12623 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12625 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12626 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12627 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12629 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12630 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12631 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12633 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12634 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12635 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12636 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12637 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12638 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12639 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12641 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12642 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12643 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12644 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12645 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12646 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12648 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12649 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12650 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12651 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12652 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12656 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12657 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12658 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12659 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12660 by a setting on the transport itself.
12662 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12663 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12664 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12668 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12669 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12670 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12671 to local and remote transports.
12673 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12674 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12675 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12676 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12677 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12678 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12679 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12682 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12683 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12684 client is connected.
12687 .vitem &$host_address$&
12688 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12689 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12690 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12691 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12693 .vitem &$host_data$&
12694 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12695 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12696 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12697 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12699 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12700 message = $host_data
12702 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12703 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12704 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12705 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12706 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12707 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12708 variables is set to &"1"&.
12711 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12712 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12715 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12716 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12717 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12720 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12721 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12722 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12723 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12724 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12725 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12726 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12727 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12728 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12729 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12731 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12732 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12733 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12736 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12737 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12738 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12740 .vitem &$host_port$&
12741 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12742 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12743 for an outbound connection.
12745 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12746 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12747 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12748 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12749 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12750 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12753 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12754 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12755 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12756 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12757 a unique name for the file.
12759 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12760 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12761 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12763 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12764 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12765 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12769 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12770 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12771 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12775 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12776 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12777 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12780 .vitem &$load_average$&
12781 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12782 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12783 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12784 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12786 .vitem &$local_part$&
12787 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12788 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12789 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12790 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12791 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12793 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12794 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12795 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12796 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12799 .cindex "tainted data"
12800 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12801 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
12802 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
12804 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12806 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12808 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12809 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12810 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12811 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12812 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12813 rather than this variable.
12814 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12815 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12816 the retrieved data.
12818 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12819 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12820 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12823 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12824 local part of the recipient address.
12826 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12827 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12828 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12830 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12833 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12834 abc\:xyz@test.example
12836 the value of &$local_part$& is
12840 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12841 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12844 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12846 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12847 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12848 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12850 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12851 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12852 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
12853 matches a local part list
12855 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
12856 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12857 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12858 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12861 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
12863 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
12864 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
12865 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
12866 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12867 .cindex affix variables
12868 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12869 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12870 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12871 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12872 .cindex "tainted data"
12873 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
12874 the affix variable value is not tainted.
12876 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12877 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12878 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
12879 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
12881 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12882 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12883 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12884 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12886 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12887 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12888 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12890 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12891 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12892 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12893 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12894 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12895 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12896 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12897 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12899 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12900 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12901 This contains the expanded value of the
12902 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12905 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12906 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12907 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12908 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12909 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12910 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12912 .vitem &$log_space$&
12913 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12914 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12915 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12916 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12917 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12918 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12921 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12922 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12923 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12924 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12925 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12926 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12927 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12928 and &"yes"& if it was.
12929 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12930 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12931 as authenticated data.
12933 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12934 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12935 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12936 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12937 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12938 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12939 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12942 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12943 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12944 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12945 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12946 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12948 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12949 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12950 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12951 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12952 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12953 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12955 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12957 .vitem &$message_age$&
12958 .cindex "message" "age of"
12959 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12960 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12961 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12964 .vitem &$message_body$&
12965 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12966 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12967 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12968 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12969 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12970 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12971 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12972 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12973 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12975 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12976 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12977 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12978 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12979 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12981 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12982 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12983 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12984 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12985 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12986 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12989 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12990 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12991 .cindex "message body" "size"
12992 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12993 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12994 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12995 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12996 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12998 If the spool file is wireformat
12999 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
13000 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13002 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13003 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13004 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13005 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13006 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13007 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13008 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13009 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13011 .vitem &$message_headers$&
13012 .vindex &$message_headers$&
13013 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13014 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13015 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13016 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13018 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
13019 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
13020 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13021 contents of header lines is done.
13023 .vitem &$message_id$&
13024 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13026 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13027 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13028 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13029 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13030 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13031 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13032 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13033 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13034 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13035 from the body is not counted.
13037 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13038 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13039 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13040 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13041 header and the body).
13043 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13046 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13047 message = Too many lines in message header
13049 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13050 message has not yet been received.
13052 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
13054 .vitem &$message_size$&
13055 .cindex "size" "of message"
13056 .cindex "message" "size"
13057 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13058 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13059 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13060 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13061 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13062 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13063 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13064 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13065 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13067 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13068 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13069 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13070 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13072 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
13073 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13074 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13075 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13077 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13078 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13079 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13081 .vitem &$original_domain$&
13082 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13083 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
13084 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13085 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13086 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13087 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13088 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13089 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13090 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13092 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13093 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13094 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13096 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
13097 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13098 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
13099 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13100 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13101 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13102 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13103 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13104 the original address.
13106 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13107 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13108 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13109 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13110 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13112 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13113 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13114 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13116 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13117 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13118 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13119 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13120 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13121 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13122 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13123 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13124 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13126 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13127 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13128 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13129 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13130 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13131 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13132 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13133 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13136 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
13137 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
13138 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13139 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13141 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
13142 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
13143 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13144 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13147 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13149 This variable contains the current process id.
13151 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13152 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13153 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13154 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13155 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13156 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13157 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13158 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13159 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13160 variable"& error if encountered.
13162 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13163 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13164 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13165 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13166 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13167 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13168 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13171 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13172 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13173 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13174 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13176 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13178 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13180 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13181 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13182 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13183 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13185 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
13186 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13187 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13188 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13190 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
13191 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13192 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13193 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13195 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
13196 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13197 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13198 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13200 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13201 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13202 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13204 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13205 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13206 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13207 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13209 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13210 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13211 .cindex "named queues" variable
13212 .cindex queues named
13213 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13215 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13216 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13217 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13218 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13219 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13220 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13221 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13226 .cindex router variables
13227 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13228 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13229 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13230 and the eventual transport.
13232 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13233 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13234 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13235 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13236 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13238 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13239 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13240 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13241 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13242 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13243 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13245 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13246 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13247 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13248 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13249 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13251 .vitem &$received_count$&
13252 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13253 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13254 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13255 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13258 .vitem &$received_for$&
13259 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
13260 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13261 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13262 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13263 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13265 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
13266 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13267 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
13268 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
13269 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
13270 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13271 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13274 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13275 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13276 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13277 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13278 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13280 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13282 .vitem &$received_port$&
13283 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13284 See &$received_ip_address$&.
13286 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13287 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13288 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13289 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13290 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13291 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13292 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13293 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13294 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13296 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13297 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13298 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13299 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13300 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13301 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13303 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13304 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13305 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13307 .vitem &$received_time$&
13308 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13309 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13310 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13312 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13313 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13314 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13315 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13316 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13318 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13319 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13321 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13322 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13323 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13324 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13326 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13327 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13328 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13329 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13332 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13333 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13336 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13339 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13340 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13344 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13347 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13350 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13351 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13353 .vitem &$recipients$&
13354 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
13355 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
13356 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
13357 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13358 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
13362 In a system filter file.
13364 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13365 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13366 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13367 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13369 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13373 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13374 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13375 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13376 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13377 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13378 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13381 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13382 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13383 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13384 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13386 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13387 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13388 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13389 these variables contain the
13390 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13393 .vitem &$reply_address$&
13394 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
13395 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13396 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13397 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13398 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13399 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13401 .vitem &$return_path$&
13402 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13403 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13404 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13405 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13406 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13407 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13408 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13409 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13410 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13411 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13414 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13415 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13416 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13418 .vitem &$router_name$&
13419 .cindex "router" "name"
13420 .cindex "name" "of router"
13421 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13422 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13425 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13426 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13427 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13428 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13429 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13430 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13431 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13434 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13435 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13436 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13437 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13438 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13439 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13440 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13441 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13443 .vitem &$sender_address$&
13444 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13445 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13446 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13447 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13448 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13450 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13451 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13452 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13453 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13454 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13455 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13456 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13457 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13459 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13460 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13461 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13463 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13464 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13465 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13467 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13468 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13469 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13470 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13471 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13474 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13475 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13477 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13478 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13479 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13480 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13482 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13483 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13484 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13485 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13486 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13487 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13488 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13489 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13490 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13491 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13492 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13493 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13494 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13496 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13497 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13498 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13499 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13500 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13502 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13503 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13504 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13505 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13506 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13507 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13509 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13510 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13511 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13512 this variable contains that
13513 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13515 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13516 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13517 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13518 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13519 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13520 &$authenticated_id$&.
13522 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13523 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13524 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13525 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13526 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13527 resolver library states that both
13528 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13529 other times, this variable is false.
13531 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13532 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13533 library, by setting:
13538 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13539 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13540 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13541 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13542 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13543 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13548 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13549 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13551 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13552 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13554 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13555 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13556 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13557 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13560 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13561 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13562 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13563 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13564 other means, this variable is empty.
13566 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13567 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13568 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13569 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13570 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13571 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13572 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13574 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13575 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13576 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13577 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13579 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13580 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13581 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13584 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13585 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13586 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13587 following are true:
13590 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13592 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13593 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13594 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13596 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13597 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13598 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13600 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13601 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13602 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13604 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13605 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13606 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13607 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13609 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13611 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13612 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13616 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13617 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13618 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13619 number that was used on the remote host.
13621 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13622 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13623 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13624 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13625 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13628 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13629 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13630 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13631 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13633 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13634 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13635 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13636 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13637 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13638 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13639 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13640 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13641 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13642 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13643 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13646 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13647 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13648 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13649 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13650 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13652 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13653 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13654 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13655 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13656 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13658 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13659 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13660 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13661 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13662 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13663 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13664 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13666 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13667 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13668 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13669 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13670 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13672 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13673 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13674 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13675 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13676 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13677 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13679 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13680 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13681 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13682 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13683 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13688 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13689 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13690 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13691 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13693 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13694 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13695 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13696 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13697 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13698 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13699 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13701 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13702 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13703 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13704 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13705 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13708 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13709 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13710 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13711 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13712 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13713 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13714 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13715 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13716 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13717 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13718 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13720 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13721 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13722 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13723 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13724 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13725 message is junk mail.
13727 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
13728 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
13730 &$spam_report$& &&&
13732 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13733 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13734 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13736 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13737 &$spf_received$& &&&
13739 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13740 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13741 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13742 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13744 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13745 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13746 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13748 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13749 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13750 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13751 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13752 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13753 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13755 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13756 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13757 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13758 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13759 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13760 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13761 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13762 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13764 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13766 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13769 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13770 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13771 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13772 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13773 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13774 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13776 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13777 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13778 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13779 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13780 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13781 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13782 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13783 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13785 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13786 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13789 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13790 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13791 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13792 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13793 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13794 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13796 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13797 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13798 .cindex certificate variables
13799 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13800 inbound connection when the message was received.
13801 It is only useful as the argument of a
13802 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13803 or a &%def%& condition.
13805 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13806 when a list of more than one
13807 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13808 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13810 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13811 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13812 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13813 inbound connection when the message was received.
13814 It is only useful as the argument of a
13815 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13816 or a &%def%& condition.
13817 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13818 which is not the leaf.
13820 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13821 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13822 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13823 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13824 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13825 or a &%def%& condition.
13827 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13828 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13829 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13830 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13831 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13832 or a &%def%& condition.
13833 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13834 which is not the leaf.
13836 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13837 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13838 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13839 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13841 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13842 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13845 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13846 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13847 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13848 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13849 and &"0"& otherwise.
13851 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13852 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13853 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13854 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13855 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13856 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13857 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13858 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13859 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13861 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13862 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13863 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13865 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13866 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13867 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13869 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13870 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13872 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13873 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13874 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13875 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13877 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13878 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13879 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13881 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13882 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13883 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13885 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13886 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13887 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13888 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13890 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13891 1 No response to request
13892 2 Response not verified
13893 3 Verification failed
13894 4 Verification succeeded
13897 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13898 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13899 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13900 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13901 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13903 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13904 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13905 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13906 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13907 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13908 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13909 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13910 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13911 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13912 which is not the leaf.
13914 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13915 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13918 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13919 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13920 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13921 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13922 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13923 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13924 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13925 which is not the leaf.
13929 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
13930 &$tls_out_resumption$&
13931 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
13932 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
13933 .cindex TLS resumption
13934 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
13938 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13939 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13940 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13941 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13943 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
13944 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13945 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13946 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13947 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13948 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13949 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13950 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13952 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13953 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13956 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13957 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13958 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13960 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
13962 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13965 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13966 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13967 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13969 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13970 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13971 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13972 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13974 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13975 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13976 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13977 this variable is set to the protocol version.
13980 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13981 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13982 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13983 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13985 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13986 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13987 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13989 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13990 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13991 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13993 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13994 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13995 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13996 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13997 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13998 values for those that are behind (west).
14001 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14002 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14003 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14005 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14006 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14007 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14008 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14011 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14012 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14013 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14016 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14017 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14018 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14019 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14021 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14022 .cindex "transport" "name"
14023 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14024 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14025 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14028 .vindex "&$value$&"
14029 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14030 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14031 &*reduce*& expansion.
14033 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14034 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14035 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14036 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14039 .vitem &$version_number$&
14040 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14041 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14042 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14044 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14045 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14046 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14047 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14049 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14050 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14051 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14052 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14058 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14059 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14061 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14062 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14063 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14064 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14065 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14066 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14071 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14074 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14075 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14076 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14077 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14078 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14079 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14080 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14081 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14082 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14084 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14085 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14086 should usually be something like
14088 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14090 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14091 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14092 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14093 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14094 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14095 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14096 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14097 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14101 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14102 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14103 a startup when Exim is entered.
14105 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14106 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14109 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14110 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14113 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14114 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14115 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14116 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14117 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14118 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14122 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14126 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14127 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14128 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14129 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14133 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14134 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14136 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14137 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14138 with an error message of the form
14140 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14142 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14143 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14144 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14145 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14146 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14147 that was passed to &%die%&.
14150 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14151 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14152 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14155 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14157 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14158 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14159 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14161 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14162 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14163 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14164 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14166 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14167 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14168 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14169 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14170 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14171 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14172 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14175 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14176 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14177 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14178 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14179 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14180 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14181 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14182 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14183 avoided, but the output is lost.
14185 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14186 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14187 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14188 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14189 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14190 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14191 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14193 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14195 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14196 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14197 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14198 as the first subroutine argument.
14202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14203 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14205 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14206 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14207 "Starting the daemon"
14208 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14209 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14210 .cindex "network interface"
14211 .cindex "interface" "network"
14212 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14213 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14214 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14215 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14216 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14217 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14218 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14219 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14220 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14221 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14222 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14225 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14226 and ports to listen on.
14228 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14229 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14230 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14231 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14232 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14233 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14234 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14235 as an error situation.
14237 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14238 for the outgoing connection.
14242 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14243 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14244 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14245 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14246 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14248 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14249 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14250 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14251 chapter describes how they operate.
14253 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14254 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14258 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14259 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14260 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14264 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14266 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14268 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14269 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14272 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14273 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14274 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14275 colons. For example:
14277 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14280 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14282 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14283 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14286 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14287 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14289 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14290 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14293 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14294 with a colon separator, for example:
14296 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14297 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14301 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14302 default setting contains just one port:
14304 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14306 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14307 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14308 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14309 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14310 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14314 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14315 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14316 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14317 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14318 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14319 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14321 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14323 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14325 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14327 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14331 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14332 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14333 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14334 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14335 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14336 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14339 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14340 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14341 If there are any items that do not
14342 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14343 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14344 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14345 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14349 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14352 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14354 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14355 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14356 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14360 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14361 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14362 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14363 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14364 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14365 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14366 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14367 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14368 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14369 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14370 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14371 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14372 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14375 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14376 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14377 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14379 The common use of this option is expected to be
14381 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14384 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14385 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14387 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14388 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14389 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14390 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14391 connections via the daemon.)
14396 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14397 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14398 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14399 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14400 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14401 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14402 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14403 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14405 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14407 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14408 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14409 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14410 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14411 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14412 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14414 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14416 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14417 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14418 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14419 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14420 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14422 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14423 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14424 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14425 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14426 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14427 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14428 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14429 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14430 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14431 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14432 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14433 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14435 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14436 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14437 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14438 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14439 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14443 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14444 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14446 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14447 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14449 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14450 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14451 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14452 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14454 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14456 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14458 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14460 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14461 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14463 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14464 IPv4 loopback address only:
14466 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14468 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14470 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14472 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14476 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14477 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14478 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14479 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14482 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14483 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14484 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14485 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14487 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14488 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14489 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14490 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14491 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14492 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14493 used for listening. Consider this example:
14495 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14497 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14499 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14501 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14502 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14505 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14506 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14507 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14508 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14509 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14510 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14511 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14512 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14516 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14517 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14518 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14519 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14520 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14521 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14530 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14531 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14532 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14533 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14536 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14537 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14539 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14540 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14541 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14543 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14544 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14545 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14546 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14550 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14551 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14552 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14553 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14554 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14555 listed in more than one group.
14557 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14559 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14560 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14561 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14562 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14563 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14564 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14565 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14566 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14567 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14568 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14569 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14570 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14571 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14575 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14577 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14578 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14579 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14580 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14581 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14582 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14587 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14589 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14590 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14591 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14592 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14593 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14594 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14595 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14596 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14597 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14598 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14599 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14600 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14605 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14607 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14608 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14609 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14610 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14611 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14612 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14613 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14614 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14615 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14616 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14617 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14618 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14619 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14620 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14621 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14626 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14628 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14629 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14630 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14631 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14636 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14638 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14639 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14640 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14641 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14642 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14643 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14644 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14645 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14646 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14647 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14648 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14649 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14650 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14651 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14652 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14657 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14659 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14660 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14665 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14667 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14668 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14669 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14674 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14676 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14677 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14678 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14679 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14680 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14681 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14682 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14683 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14688 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14690 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14691 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14692 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14693 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14694 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14695 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14696 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14697 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14698 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14699 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14700 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14701 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14702 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14703 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14704 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14705 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14707 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14708 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14709 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14710 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14711 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14716 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14718 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14719 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14720 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14721 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14722 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14723 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14724 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14725 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14726 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14727 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14728 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14729 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14730 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14731 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14732 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14733 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14734 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14735 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14736 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14737 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14738 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14739 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14741 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14742 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14743 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14744 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14745 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14746 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14747 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14748 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14749 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14750 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14751 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14752 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14753 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14754 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14755 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14756 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14757 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14758 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14759 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
14760 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14761 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14762 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14767 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14769 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14771 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14773 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14774 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14775 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14780 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14782 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14783 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14784 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14785 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14786 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14787 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14788 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14789 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14790 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14791 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14792 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14793 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14794 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14795 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14796 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14797 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14798 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14803 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14805 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14806 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14807 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14808 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14809 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14810 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14811 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14812 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14817 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14819 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14820 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14821 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14822 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14823 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14824 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14825 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14826 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14832 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14834 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14841 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14842 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14845 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14846 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14847 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14848 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14849 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
14850 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
14851 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
14852 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14853 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14854 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14855 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14856 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14857 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14858 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14859 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14860 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14861 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14862 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14863 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14864 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14865 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14867 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14868 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14869 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14870 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14871 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14872 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14873 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14874 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14875 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14876 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14877 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14878 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14879 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14880 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14881 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14882 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14887 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14889 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14890 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14891 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14892 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14893 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14894 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14895 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14896 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14897 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14898 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14899 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14904 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14906 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14907 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14908 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14909 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14911 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14912 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14913 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14914 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14915 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14916 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14917 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14918 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14919 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14920 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14925 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14927 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14928 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14930 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14931 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14932 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14933 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14934 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14939 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14941 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14942 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14943 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14944 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14945 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14946 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14947 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14948 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14949 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14950 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14951 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14952 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14953 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
14954 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14955 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14956 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14957 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14958 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14959 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14960 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14961 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14962 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14963 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14964 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14965 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14970 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14972 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14973 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14974 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14975 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14976 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14977 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14978 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14979 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14980 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14981 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14982 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14983 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14984 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14985 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14986 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14991 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14992 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14995 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14997 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14998 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14999 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15000 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15001 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15002 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15003 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15004 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15006 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15007 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15008 It now defaults to true.
15009 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15011 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15014 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15016 log_selector = +8bitmime
15019 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15020 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15021 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15022 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15023 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15026 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15027 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15028 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15031 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15032 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15033 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15034 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15035 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15037 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15038 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15039 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15040 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15041 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15043 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15044 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15045 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15046 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15048 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15049 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15050 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15051 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15052 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15054 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15055 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15056 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15057 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15058 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15059 This option defines the ACL that,
15060 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15061 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15062 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15063 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15065 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15066 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15067 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15068 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15069 of a received message.
15070 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15072 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15073 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15074 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15075 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15077 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15078 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15079 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15080 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15082 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15083 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15084 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15085 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15086 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15089 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15090 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15091 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15092 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15094 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15095 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15096 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15097 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
15098 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15100 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15101 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15102 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15103 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15104 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15106 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15107 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15108 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15109 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15110 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15112 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15113 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15114 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15117 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15118 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15119 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15120 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15122 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15123 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15124 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15125 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15127 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15128 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15129 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15130 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15132 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15133 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15134 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15135 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15137 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15138 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15139 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15140 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15141 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15143 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15145 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15146 .cindex "admin user"
15147 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15148 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15149 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15150 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15151 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15152 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15153 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15155 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15156 .cindex "domain literal"
15157 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
15158 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15159 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15160 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15162 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15163 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15164 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15165 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15166 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15167 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15168 the local host's IP addresses.
15171 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15172 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15173 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15174 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15175 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15176 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15177 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15178 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15179 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15181 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15182 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15183 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15184 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15185 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15186 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15187 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15189 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15190 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15191 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15193 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15194 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15195 this option can be left as default.
15197 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15198 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15199 suitable setting is:
15201 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15202 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15204 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15206 dns_check_names_pattern =
15208 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15211 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15212 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15213 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15214 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15215 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15216 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15217 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15218 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15219 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15220 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15221 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15222 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15224 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15225 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15226 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15227 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15228 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15229 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15231 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15232 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15233 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15234 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15236 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15238 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15239 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15240 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15241 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15244 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15245 .cindex "thawing messages"
15246 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15247 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15248 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15249 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15250 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15251 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15253 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15254 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15255 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15258 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15259 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15260 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15262 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15264 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15265 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15268 .option bi_command main string unset
15270 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15271 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15272 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15273 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15276 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15277 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15278 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15279 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15280 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15281 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15282 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15283 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15284 absolute and untainted.
15285 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15288 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15289 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15290 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15291 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15293 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15294 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15295 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15296 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15297 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15298 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15299 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15300 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15301 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15302 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15304 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15305 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15306 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15307 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15308 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15309 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15310 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15311 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15312 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15313 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15315 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15316 during reception of a message.
15317 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15319 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15322 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15323 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15324 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15325 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15328 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15329 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15330 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15331 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15332 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15333 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15334 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15335 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15336 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15338 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15339 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15340 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15341 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15342 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15345 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15346 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15347 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15348 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15349 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15350 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15351 connection. A typical setting might be:
15353 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15355 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15357 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15359 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15362 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15363 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15364 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15365 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15366 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15367 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15370 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15371 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15372 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15373 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15376 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15377 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15378 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15379 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15382 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15383 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15384 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15385 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15388 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15389 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15390 callout verification. The default value is
15392 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15394 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15397 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
15398 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15401 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
15402 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15404 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15405 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15406 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15407 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15408 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15409 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15410 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15411 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15412 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15413 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15416 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15417 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15420 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15421 .cindex "checking disk space"
15422 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15423 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15424 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15425 message is accepted.
15427 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15428 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15429 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15430 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15431 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15432 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15433 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15434 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15437 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15438 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15440 check_spool_space = 100M
15441 check_spool_inodes = 100
15443 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15444 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15447 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15448 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15449 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15451 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15452 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15453 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15454 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15455 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15456 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15458 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15459 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15460 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15462 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15463 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15464 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15466 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15467 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15468 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15469 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15471 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15472 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15473 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15474 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15475 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15477 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15479 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15480 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15481 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15482 administrative user.
15483 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15485 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15486 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15487 .cindex memory debugging
15488 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15489 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15490 it should normally be left as default.
15492 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15493 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15494 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15495 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15496 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15497 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15499 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15500 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15501 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15502 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15503 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15504 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15505 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15507 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15508 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15510 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15511 .cindex "warning of delay"
15512 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15513 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15514 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15515 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15516 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15517 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15518 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15519 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15522 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15524 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15525 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15526 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15527 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15531 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15532 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15534 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15536 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15537 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15538 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15540 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15541 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15542 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15543 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15544 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15545 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15546 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15547 not sent. The default is:
15549 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15550 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15551 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15552 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15555 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15556 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15557 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15558 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15560 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15561 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15562 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15563 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15564 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15565 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15566 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15567 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15569 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15570 .cindex "load average"
15571 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15572 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15573 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15574 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15575 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15578 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15579 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15580 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15581 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15582 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15583 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15584 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15585 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15587 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15588 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15589 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15590 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15591 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15592 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15593 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15594 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15596 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15597 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15598 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15599 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15602 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15603 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15604 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15605 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15606 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15607 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15608 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15611 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15612 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15613 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15614 and an order of processing.
15615 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15617 Acceptable values include:
15624 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15626 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15627 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15628 and an order of processing.
15629 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15632 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15633 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15634 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15635 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15637 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15639 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15640 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15643 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15644 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15645 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15646 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15647 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15648 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15651 .option dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset
15652 .option dmarc_history_file main string unset
15653 .option dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15654 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15655 These options control DMARC processing.
15656 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15659 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15660 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15661 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15662 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15663 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15664 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15665 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15666 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15667 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15668 by a setting such as this:
15670 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15672 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15673 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15674 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15675 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15676 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15677 options are applied after this global option.
15679 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15680 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15681 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15682 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15683 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15684 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15685 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15686 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15687 value of this option. The default pattern is
15689 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15690 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15692 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15693 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15694 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15695 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15696 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15699 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15700 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15701 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15703 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15704 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15705 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15706 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15708 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15709 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15710 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15711 not do it internally.
15712 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15713 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15715 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15716 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15717 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15720 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15721 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15722 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15723 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15724 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15725 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15727 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15729 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15730 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15731 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15732 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15733 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15734 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15740 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15741 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15742 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15743 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15744 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15745 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15746 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15747 domain matches this list.
15749 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15750 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15751 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15752 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15753 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15754 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15757 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15758 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15759 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15760 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15761 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15762 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15763 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15764 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15765 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15766 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15767 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15768 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15770 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15773 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15774 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15777 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15778 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15779 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15780 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15781 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15782 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15783 match with this expanded domain list.
15785 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15786 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15787 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15788 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15789 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15790 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15792 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15793 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15794 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15796 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15797 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15798 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15799 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15800 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15802 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15803 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15804 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15805 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15806 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15807 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15808 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15809 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15812 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15814 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15815 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15816 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15819 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15820 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15821 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15822 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15824 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15825 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15826 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15827 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15828 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15829 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15830 and accepted from, these hosts.
15831 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15832 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15833 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15834 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15836 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15837 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15839 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15840 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15841 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15842 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15843 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15844 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15846 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15848 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15849 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15851 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15852 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15853 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15854 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15855 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15856 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15857 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15858 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15859 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15862 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15863 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15864 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15865 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15866 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15867 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15868 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15869 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15870 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15872 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15873 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15874 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15875 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15876 are examined. For example:
15878 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15879 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15880 postmaster@mydomain.example
15882 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15883 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15884 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15885 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15886 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15887 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15888 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15891 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15892 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15893 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15895 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15897 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15898 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15899 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15900 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15901 overrides the default.
15903 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15904 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15905 and warning messages. For example:
15907 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15909 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15910 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15911 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15912 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15916 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15918 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15919 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15922 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15923 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15924 .cindex "Exim group"
15925 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15926 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15927 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15928 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15929 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15933 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15934 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15935 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15936 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15937 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15938 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15940 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15941 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15942 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15943 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15946 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15947 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15948 .cindex "Exim user"
15949 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15950 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15951 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15952 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15954 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15955 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15956 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15957 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15960 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15961 .cindex "Exim version"
15962 .cindex customizing "version number"
15963 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15964 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15965 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15968 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15969 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15970 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15971 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15974 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15975 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15977 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15978 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15980 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15981 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15982 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15983 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15984 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15985 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15986 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15987 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15988 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15989 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15993 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15994 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15995 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15996 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15997 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15998 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15999 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16000 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16003 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16004 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16005 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16006 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16010 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16011 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16012 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16013 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16014 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16015 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16016 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16017 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16018 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16019 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16020 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16021 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16022 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16023 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16024 logging that you require.
16027 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
16029 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16030 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16031 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16032 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16033 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16034 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16035 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16036 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16038 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16039 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16040 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16043 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16044 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16045 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16046 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16048 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16052 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
16053 See &%gecos_name%& above.
16056 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16057 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16058 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16059 implementations of TLS.
16062 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16063 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16064 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16067 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16072 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16073 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16074 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16075 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16076 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16077 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16081 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16082 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16083 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16084 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16085 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16086 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16087 sections are rejected.
16090 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16091 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16092 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16093 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16094 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16095 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16096 zero means &"no limit"&.
16101 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16102 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16103 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16104 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16105 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16106 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16107 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16108 if you want to do semantic checking.
16109 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16113 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16114 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16115 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16116 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16117 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16118 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16119 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
16121 helo_allow_chars = _
16123 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16126 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16127 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16128 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16129 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16130 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16131 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16132 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16136 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16137 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16138 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16139 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16140 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16141 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16142 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16143 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16144 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16145 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16146 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16147 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16149 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16150 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16151 EHLO command either:
16154 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16156 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16157 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16158 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16159 calling host address, or
16161 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16164 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16165 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16166 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16168 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16169 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16170 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16172 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16173 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16174 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16175 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16176 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16177 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16178 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16179 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16180 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16183 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16184 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16185 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16186 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16187 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16188 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16189 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16190 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16191 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16193 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16194 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16195 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16196 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16197 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16199 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16200 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16201 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16202 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16205 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16206 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16207 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16208 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16209 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16210 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16211 default configuration file contains
16215 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16216 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16218 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16219 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16220 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16222 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16223 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16224 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16225 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16226 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16227 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16230 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16231 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16232 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16233 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16234 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16237 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16238 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16239 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16240 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16244 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16245 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16246 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16247 as soon as the connection is made.
16248 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16249 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16250 connections immediately.
16252 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16253 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16254 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16255 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16256 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16259 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16260 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16261 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16262 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16263 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16264 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16265 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16266 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16267 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16269 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16271 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
16275 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16276 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16277 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16278 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16281 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16282 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16283 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16284 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16285 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16287 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16288 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16290 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16291 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16292 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16293 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16294 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16295 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16296 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16299 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16300 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16301 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16302 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16303 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16307 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16308 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16309 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16310 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16311 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16312 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16314 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16315 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16316 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16317 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16318 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16319 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16320 for frozen messages. For example,
16322 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16324 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16325 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16326 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16327 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16328 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16329 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16332 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16333 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16334 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16335 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16336 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16337 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16338 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16339 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16340 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16341 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16344 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16345 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
16347 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16348 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16349 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16350 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16351 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16352 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16353 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16354 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16355 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16357 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16358 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16360 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16361 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16362 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16363 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16365 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16366 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16367 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16370 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16371 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16372 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16376 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16377 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16378 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16379 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16383 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16384 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16385 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16386 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16387 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16388 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16389 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16390 and constrained to be a directory.
16393 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16394 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16395 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16396 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16397 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16398 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16399 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16400 and constrained to be a file.
16403 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16404 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16405 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16406 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16407 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16408 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16411 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16412 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16413 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16414 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16415 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16416 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16417 identity to be proven.
16420 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16421 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16422 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16423 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16424 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16427 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16428 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16429 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16430 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16431 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16435 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16436 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16437 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16438 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16439 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16440 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16444 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16445 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16446 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16447 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16448 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16450 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16451 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16452 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16455 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16456 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16457 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16458 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16459 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16460 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16461 has been built with LDAP support.
16465 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16466 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16467 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16468 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16469 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16470 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16471 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16473 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16474 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16475 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16477 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16478 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16479 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16480 and the default qualify domain.
16482 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16483 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16484 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16485 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16487 .cindex "envelope from"
16488 .cindex "envelope sender"
16489 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16490 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16491 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16493 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16494 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16495 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16500 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
16501 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16502 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16503 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16504 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16505 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16506 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16509 local_from_prefix = *-
16511 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16513 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16515 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16516 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16520 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
16521 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16524 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16525 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16526 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16527 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16528 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16529 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16530 &%local_interfaces%& is
16532 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16534 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16536 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16539 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16540 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16541 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16542 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16543 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16544 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16545 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16546 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16550 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16551 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16552 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16553 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16554 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16555 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16556 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16557 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16562 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16563 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16564 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16565 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16566 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16567 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16568 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16569 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16570 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16571 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16572 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16573 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16574 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16575 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16576 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16580 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16581 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16582 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16583 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16584 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16585 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16586 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16587 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16588 A path must start with a slash.
16589 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16590 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16591 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16592 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16593 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16594 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16595 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16596 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16599 .option log_selector main string unset
16600 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16601 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16602 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16603 minus characters. For example:
16605 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16607 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16608 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16611 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16612 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16613 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16614 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16615 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16616 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16617 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16618 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16619 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16620 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16621 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16622 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16623 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16626 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16627 .cindex "too many open files"
16628 .cindex "open files, too many"
16629 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16630 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16631 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16632 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16633 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16634 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16635 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16636 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16637 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16638 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16639 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16640 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16643 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16644 .cindex "length of login name"
16645 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16646 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16647 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16648 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16649 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16650 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16653 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16654 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16655 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16656 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16657 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16658 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16659 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16660 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16663 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16664 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16665 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16666 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16667 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16668 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16669 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16672 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16673 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16674 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16675 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16676 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16677 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16678 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16679 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16680 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16681 empty string, the option is ignored.
16684 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16685 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16686 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16687 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16688 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16689 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16690 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16691 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16692 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16693 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16694 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16695 colons will become hyphens.
16698 .option message_logs main boolean true
16699 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16700 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16701 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16702 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16703 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16704 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16705 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16706 which is not affected by this option.
16709 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16710 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16711 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16712 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16713 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16714 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16715 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16716 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16717 optionally followed by K or M.
16719 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16720 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16721 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16722 service extension keyword.
16724 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16725 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16726 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16727 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16728 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16730 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16731 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16732 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16733 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16734 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16735 message that an individual transport can process.
16737 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16738 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16739 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16740 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16741 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16742 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16743 some problems may result.
16745 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16746 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16747 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16750 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16751 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16752 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16754 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16756 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16757 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16758 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16759 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16760 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16763 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16764 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16765 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16766 contains a full description of this facility.
16770 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16771 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16772 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16773 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16774 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16777 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16778 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16779 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16780 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16781 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16784 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16785 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16786 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16787 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16788 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16790 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16791 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16794 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16796 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16797 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16801 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16802 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16803 listens for work and information-requests.
16804 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16805 should need to modify the default.
16807 The option is expanded before use.
16808 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16809 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16811 .new "if nonempty,"
16812 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16816 If this option is set as empty,
16817 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
16819 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
16820 then a notifier socket is not created.
16823 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16824 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16825 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16826 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16827 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16829 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16830 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16831 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16832 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16833 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16834 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16835 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16837 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16838 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16839 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16840 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16841 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16843 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16845 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16846 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16847 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16848 some now infamous attacks.
16852 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16853 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16854 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16856 # Disable older protocol versions:
16857 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16860 Possible options may include:
16864 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16866 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16868 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16872 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16874 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16876 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16878 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16880 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16882 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16886 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16900 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16904 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16906 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16908 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16910 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16914 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16917 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16918 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16919 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16920 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16921 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16922 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16925 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16926 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16927 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16928 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16929 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16932 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16933 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16934 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16935 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16936 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16937 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16938 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16939 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16940 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16941 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16944 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16945 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16946 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16947 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16948 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16949 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16950 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16953 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16955 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16956 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16959 .option perl_startup main string unset
16961 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16962 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16964 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16966 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16969 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16970 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16971 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16972 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16973 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16974 PostgreSQL support.
16977 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16978 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16979 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16980 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16981 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16984 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16986 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16988 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16989 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16990 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16993 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16994 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16995 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
16996 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16997 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16998 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16999 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17000 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17001 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17002 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17004 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17005 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17006 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
17007 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPE_CONNECT
17008 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17009 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17010 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17011 commands are acceptable.
17012 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17014 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17017 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPE_CONNECT"&.
17021 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17022 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17023 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17024 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17025 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17026 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17027 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17028 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17029 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17031 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17032 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17033 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17034 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17035 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17036 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17037 volume of mail. Use with care!
17040 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17041 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17042 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17043 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17044 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17045 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17046 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17047 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17048 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17049 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17051 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17052 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17053 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17054 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17055 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17056 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17059 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17060 .cindex "printing characters"
17061 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17062 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17063 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17064 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17065 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17066 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17069 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17070 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
17071 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17072 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17073 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17077 .option process_log_path main string unset
17078 .cindex "process log path"
17079 .cindex "log" "process log"
17080 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17081 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17082 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17083 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17084 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17085 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17086 different spool directories.
17089 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17090 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17094 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17095 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17096 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17100 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17101 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17102 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17103 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17107 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17108 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17109 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17110 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17111 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17112 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17113 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17114 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17115 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17117 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17118 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17119 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17120 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17121 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17122 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17123 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17126 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17127 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17128 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17132 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17133 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17134 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17135 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17136 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17137 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17138 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17139 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17143 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean false
17144 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17145 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17146 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17147 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17148 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17149 routed for a single host.
17153 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17154 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17156 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17157 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17158 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17159 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17162 .option queue_only main boolean false
17163 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17164 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17165 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17166 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17167 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17168 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17170 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17171 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17172 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17173 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17176 .option queue_only_file main string unset
17177 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17178 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17179 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17180 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17181 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17182 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17183 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17184 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17186 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17188 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17189 &_/some/file_& exists.
17192 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17193 .cindex "load average"
17194 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17195 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17196 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17197 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17198 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17199 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17200 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17203 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17204 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17205 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17206 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17209 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17210 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17211 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17212 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17213 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17214 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17215 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17216 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17217 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17218 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17219 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17220 re-evaluated for each message.
17223 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17224 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17225 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17226 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17227 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17228 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17231 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17232 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17233 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17234 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17235 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17236 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17237 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17238 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17239 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17240 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17241 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17242 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17243 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17247 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17248 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17249 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17250 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17251 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17252 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17253 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17254 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17255 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17257 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17258 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17259 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17260 the daemon's command line.
17262 .cindex queues named
17263 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17264 To set limits for different named queues use
17265 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17267 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17268 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17269 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17270 .cindex "first pass routing"
17271 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17272 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17273 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17274 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17275 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17276 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17277 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17278 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17279 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17280 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17284 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17285 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17286 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17287 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17288 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17289 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17290 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17292 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17293 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17294 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17295 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17296 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17297 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17298 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17299 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17300 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17302 The default setting is:
17305 received_header_text = Received: \
17306 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17307 {${if def:sender_ident \
17308 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17309 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17310 by $primary_hostname \
17311 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17312 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17313 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17314 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17315 ${if def:sender_address \
17316 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17317 id $message_exim_id\
17318 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17321 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17322 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17323 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17324 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17325 header lines such as the following:
17327 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17328 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17329 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17330 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17331 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17332 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17333 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17335 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17336 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17337 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17338 message was accepted.
17341 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17342 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17343 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17344 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17345 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17346 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17347 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17348 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17351 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17352 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17353 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17354 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17355 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17356 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17357 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17358 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17359 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17360 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17361 option was not set.
17364 .option recipients_max main integer 0
17365 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17366 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17367 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17368 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17369 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17370 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17371 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17374 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17375 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17376 RCPT commands in a single message.
17379 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17380 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17381 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17382 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17383 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17384 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17385 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17388 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
17389 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17390 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17391 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17392 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17393 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17394 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17395 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17396 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17397 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17398 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17399 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17400 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17401 tagged with its process id.
17403 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17404 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17405 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17406 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17409 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17410 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17412 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17413 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17414 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17415 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17416 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17417 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17418 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17419 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17420 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17421 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17422 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17424 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17425 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17426 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17427 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17430 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17431 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17432 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17433 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17434 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17436 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17438 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17439 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17442 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17443 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17444 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17445 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17446 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17450 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17451 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17452 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17453 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17454 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17455 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17456 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17460 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17461 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17462 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17463 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17464 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17465 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17466 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17467 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17468 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17469 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17472 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17473 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17476 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17478 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17479 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17480 an item in the list.
17481 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17484 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17485 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17486 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17487 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17488 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17491 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17492 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17493 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17494 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17495 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17496 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17497 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17498 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17499 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17500 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17503 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17504 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17505 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17506 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17507 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17508 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17509 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17513 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17514 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17515 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17516 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17517 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17518 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17519 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17520 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17521 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17522 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17523 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17527 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17528 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17529 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17531 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17532 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17533 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17534 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17535 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17536 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17538 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17539 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17540 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17541 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17544 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17545 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17546 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17547 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17548 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17549 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17550 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17551 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17553 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17554 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17555 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17556 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17557 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17558 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17559 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17560 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17563 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17564 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17565 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17566 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17570 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17571 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17572 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17573 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17574 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17575 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17576 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17577 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17578 . the option name to split.
17580 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer&!! 1000 &&&
17581 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17582 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17583 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17584 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17585 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17586 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17587 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17588 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17591 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17592 and may depend on values available at that time.
17593 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17597 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17598 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17599 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17600 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17601 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17602 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17603 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17604 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17605 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17606 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17607 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17609 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17610 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17611 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17612 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17613 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17614 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17618 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17619 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17620 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17621 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17622 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17623 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17624 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17625 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17626 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17627 to all messages received in the same connection.
17629 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17630 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17631 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17632 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17635 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17637 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17638 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17639 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17640 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17641 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17642 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17643 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17644 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17645 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17646 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17647 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17648 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17649 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17652 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17653 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17654 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17655 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17656 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17657 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17658 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17659 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17660 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17661 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17662 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17665 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17666 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17667 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17668 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17671 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17672 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17673 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17674 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17675 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17676 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17677 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17678 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17679 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17681 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17682 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17683 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17684 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17686 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17687 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17688 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17689 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17690 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17693 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17694 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17697 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17698 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17699 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17700 &%helo_data%& value.
17702 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17703 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17704 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17705 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17706 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17707 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17708 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17710 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17711 $version_number $tod_full
17713 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17714 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17715 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17716 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17717 multiline response).
17720 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17721 .cindex "checking disk space"
17722 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17723 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17724 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17725 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17726 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17727 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17728 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17731 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17732 .cindex "connection backlog"
17733 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17734 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17735 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17736 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17737 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17738 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17739 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17740 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17741 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17742 attacks by SYN flooding.
17745 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17746 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17747 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17748 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17749 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17750 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17751 fewer, but they still exist.
17753 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17754 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17755 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17756 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17757 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17758 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17759 does detect many instances.
17761 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17762 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17763 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17764 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17768 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17769 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17770 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17771 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17772 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17773 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17774 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17775 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17776 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17779 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17780 $sender_host_address
17782 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17783 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17784 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17785 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17787 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17788 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17789 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17790 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17791 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17795 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17796 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17797 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17798 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17799 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17802 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17803 .cindex "load average"
17804 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17805 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17806 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17807 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17808 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17809 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17813 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17814 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17815 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17816 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17817 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17819 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17821 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17822 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17823 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17824 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17825 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17827 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17828 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17829 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17830 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17831 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17832 not count towards the limit.
17836 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17837 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17838 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17839 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17840 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17843 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17844 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17848 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17849 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17850 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17851 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17852 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17853 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17856 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17857 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17858 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17859 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17861 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17862 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17863 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17864 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17868 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17870 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17871 fractional parts are allowed here.
17873 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17875 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17876 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17879 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17880 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17882 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17883 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17885 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17886 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17887 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17888 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17891 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17892 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17895 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17896 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17899 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17900 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17901 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17902 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17903 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17904 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17905 the message is abandoned.
17906 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17908 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17909 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17911 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17912 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17914 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17915 expanded before use and may depend on
17916 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17920 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17921 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17922 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17923 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17924 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17927 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17928 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17929 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17932 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17933 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17934 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17935 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17936 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17937 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17938 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17939 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17940 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17941 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17943 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17944 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17948 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17949 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
17950 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
17951 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17952 the availability thereof is advertised in
17953 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17954 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17957 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17958 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17959 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17960 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17964 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17965 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17966 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17968 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
17969 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
17970 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
17971 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
17972 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
17973 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
17974 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
17975 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
17979 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
17981 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
17983 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
17985 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
17987 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
17989 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
17991 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
17993 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
17995 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
17997 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
17999 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18001 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18002 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18005 A note on using Exim variables: As
18006 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18007 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18010 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18011 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18012 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18013 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18014 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18015 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18016 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18017 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18018 arrival of the message.
18020 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18021 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18022 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18023 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18024 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18026 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18027 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18028 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18029 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18030 automatically deleted.
18032 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18033 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18034 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18035 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18036 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18037 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18038 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18039 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18040 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18043 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18044 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18045 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18046 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18047 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18048 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18049 &$primary_hostname$&.
18051 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18052 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18053 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18054 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18055 as failures in the configuration file.
18057 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18058 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18060 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18061 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18062 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18063 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18064 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18065 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18068 The following variables will not have useful values:
18070 $max_received_linelength
18075 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18076 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18077 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18078 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18080 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18081 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18082 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18084 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18085 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18086 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18087 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18089 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18090 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18091 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18092 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18093 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18094 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18096 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18097 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18098 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18099 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18100 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18101 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18102 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18105 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18106 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18107 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18108 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18109 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18110 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18111 domain causes a syntax error.
18112 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18116 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18117 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18118 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18119 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18120 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18121 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18122 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18123 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18124 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18125 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18126 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18127 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18130 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18131 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18132 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18133 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18134 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18135 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18136 details of Exim's logging.
18139 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18140 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18141 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18142 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18143 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18144 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18145 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18149 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18150 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18151 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18152 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18153 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18157 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18158 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18159 .cindex timestamps syslog
18160 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18161 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18162 details of Exim's logging.
18165 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18166 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18167 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18168 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18169 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18170 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18171 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18172 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18173 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18174 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18175 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18176 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18179 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18180 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18181 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18182 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18183 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18184 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18187 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18188 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18189 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18190 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18191 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18193 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18194 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18195 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18196 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18197 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18199 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18200 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18201 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18202 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18203 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18204 contains the pipe command.
18207 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18208 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18209 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18210 is used in a system filter.
18213 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18214 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18215 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18216 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18217 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18218 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18219 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18220 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18221 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18222 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18224 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18225 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18226 transport option overrides.
18229 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18230 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18231 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18232 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18233 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18234 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18235 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18236 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18237 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18238 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18239 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18240 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18244 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18245 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18246 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18247 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18248 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18249 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18250 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18251 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18252 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18253 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18255 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18256 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18257 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18260 .option timezone main string unset
18261 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18262 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18263 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18264 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18265 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18266 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18270 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18271 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18272 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18273 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18274 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18275 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18278 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18279 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18280 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18281 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18282 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18283 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18284 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18285 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18286 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18287 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18288 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18289 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18292 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
18293 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18294 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18295 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18296 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18297 Commonly only one file is needed.
18298 The server's private key is also
18299 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18300 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18302 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18303 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18304 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18305 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18307 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18308 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18310 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18311 when a list of more than one
18312 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18313 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18315 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18316 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18317 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18318 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18319 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18321 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
18322 generated for every connection.
18324 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18325 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18326 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18327 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18328 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18330 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18332 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18333 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18334 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18336 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18339 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18340 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18341 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18342 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18343 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18344 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18346 The value must be at least 1024.
18348 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18349 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18350 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18352 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18355 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18356 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18357 larger prime than requested.
18360 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18361 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18362 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18363 to be used by Exim.
18365 This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
18366 The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
18368 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
18369 for other TLS library versions,
18370 using a filename with site-generated
18371 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18372 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18373 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18375 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18376 then it names a file from which DH
18377 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18378 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18379 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18380 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18381 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18382 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18384 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18387 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18388 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18389 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18390 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18392 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18393 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18395 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18396 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18397 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18399 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18400 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18401 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18402 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18403 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18405 The available standard primes are:
18406 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18407 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18408 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18409 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18411 The available additional primes are:
18412 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18414 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18415 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18416 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18417 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18418 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18420 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18421 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18422 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18424 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18425 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18426 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18427 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18428 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18431 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18432 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18433 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18434 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18435 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18436 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18437 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18440 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
18441 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18442 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18443 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
18445 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
18446 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
18447 for valid selections.
18449 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18450 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18451 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18453 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
18456 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18457 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18458 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18460 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18461 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18462 Certificate Authority.
18464 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18465 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18467 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18468 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18469 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18470 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18471 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18473 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18474 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18476 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18477 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18478 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18479 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18480 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18481 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18482 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18484 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18485 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18486 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18487 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18489 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18492 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18493 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18494 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18495 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18499 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
18500 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18501 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18502 files which contains the server's private keys.
18503 If this option is unset, or if
18504 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18505 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18506 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18508 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18511 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18512 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18513 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18514 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18515 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18516 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18520 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18521 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18522 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18523 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18524 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18525 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18526 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18527 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18528 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18529 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18530 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18534 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18535 .cindex TLS resumption
18536 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18537 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18541 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18542 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18543 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18544 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18547 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18548 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18549 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18550 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18552 or the absolute path to
18553 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18554 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18556 The "system" value for the option will use a
18557 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18558 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18559 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18562 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18563 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18565 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18567 either by file or directory
18568 are added to those given by the system default location.
18570 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18571 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18572 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18573 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18574 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18575 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
18576 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
18577 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
18579 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18581 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18585 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18586 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18587 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18588 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18589 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18590 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18591 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18592 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18594 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18595 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18596 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18597 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18598 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18599 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18600 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18602 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18603 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18604 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18605 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18606 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18607 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18608 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18611 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18615 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18616 .cindex "trusted groups"
18617 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18618 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18619 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18620 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18621 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18622 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18623 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18626 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18627 .cindex "trusted users"
18628 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18629 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18630 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18631 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18632 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18633 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18634 Exim user are trusted.
18636 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18637 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18638 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18639 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18640 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18641 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18642 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18643 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18644 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18647 .option unknown_username main string unset
18648 See &%unknown_login%&.
18650 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18651 .cindex "trusted users"
18652 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18653 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18654 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18655 .cindex "envelope from"
18656 .cindex "envelope sender"
18657 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18658 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18659 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18660 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18661 is used) is ignored.
18663 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18664 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18666 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18668 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18669 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18670 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18671 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18672 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18673 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18674 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18675 followed by a hyphen
18676 by a setting like this:
18678 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18680 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18681 restriction, you can use
18683 untrusted_set_sender = *
18685 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18686 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18687 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18688 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18689 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18690 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18691 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18692 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18694 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18695 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18696 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18697 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18701 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18702 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18703 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18704 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18705 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18706 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18707 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18708 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18709 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18710 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18712 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18713 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18715 The pattern can be seen by running
18717 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18719 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18720 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18721 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18722 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18723 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18724 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18727 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18728 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18731 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18732 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18733 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18734 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18735 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18736 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18737 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18738 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18739 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18740 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18741 absolute and untainted.
18742 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18745 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18746 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18747 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18748 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18749 .ecindex IIDconfima
18750 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18756 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18758 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18759 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18760 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18761 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18762 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18764 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18765 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18766 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18767 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18768 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18772 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18773 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18774 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18775 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18776 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18777 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18778 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18780 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18781 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18782 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18783 routers, and the eventual transport.
18785 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18786 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18787 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18788 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18789 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18791 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18792 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18793 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18794 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18795 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18797 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18798 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18799 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18801 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18803 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18805 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18807 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18808 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18810 See also the &%set%& option below.
18812 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18813 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18814 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18815 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18816 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18817 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18818 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18822 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18824 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18825 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18826 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18827 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18828 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18833 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18834 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18835 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18836 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18837 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18838 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18839 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18840 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18841 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18842 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18845 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18847 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18850 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18852 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18853 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18854 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18855 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18858 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18859 .cindex "case of local parts"
18860 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18861 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18862 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18863 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18864 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18865 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18866 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18869 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18870 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18871 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18872 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18873 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18874 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18875 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18876 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18877 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18879 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18880 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18881 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18882 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18886 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18887 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18888 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18889 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18891 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18892 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18893 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18894 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18895 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18897 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
18898 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
18899 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
18900 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18901 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18902 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18903 the router is skipped.
18905 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18906 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18907 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18908 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18909 setting to achieve this. For example:
18911 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18913 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18914 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18915 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18919 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18920 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18921 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18922 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18923 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18924 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18925 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18926 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18928 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18929 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18931 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18932 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18934 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18935 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18936 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18938 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18940 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18942 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18945 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18947 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18948 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18952 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18953 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18954 be specified using &%condition%&.
18956 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18957 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18958 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18959 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18960 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18961 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18962 Router rules processing behavior.
18964 This is best illustrated in an example:
18966 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18967 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18969 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18972 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18975 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18976 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18977 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18978 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18979 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18980 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18981 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18982 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18984 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18985 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18986 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18987 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18990 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18991 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18992 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18993 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18994 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18997 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18998 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18999 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19000 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19001 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19002 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19003 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19004 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19005 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19006 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19007 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19008 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19009 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19010 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19014 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19015 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19016 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19017 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19018 transport option of the same name.
19020 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19021 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19022 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19023 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19024 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19025 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19026 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19027 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19029 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19030 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19031 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19032 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19033 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19034 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19035 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19036 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19037 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19040 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19041 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19042 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19043 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19044 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
19045 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19046 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19047 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19048 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19052 .option driver routers string unset
19053 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19057 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19058 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19059 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19060 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
19061 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19062 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19063 Not effective on redirect routers.
19067 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19068 .cindex "envelope from"
19069 .cindex "envelope sender"
19070 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19071 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19072 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19073 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19074 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19075 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19076 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19078 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19079 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19080 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19083 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19084 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19085 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19086 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19088 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19089 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19090 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19091 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19097 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19098 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19099 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19100 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19101 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19103 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19104 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19105 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19106 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19107 setting &%return_path%&.
19109 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19110 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19111 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19115 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19116 .cindex "address" "testing"
19117 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19118 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19119 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19120 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19121 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19122 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19123 on for the system alias file.
19124 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19127 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19128 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19129 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19133 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19134 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19135 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19136 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19140 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19141 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19142 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19146 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19147 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19148 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19152 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19153 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19154 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19155 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19156 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19157 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19158 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19159 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19160 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19162 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19163 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19164 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19165 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19166 transport for further details.
19169 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19170 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19171 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19172 .cindex "transport" "local"
19173 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19174 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19175 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19177 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19178 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19179 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19180 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19181 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19185 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19186 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19187 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19188 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19189 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19190 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19191 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19192 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19193 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19194 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19195 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19196 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19197 &"see"& the added header lines.
19199 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19200 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19201 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19202 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19204 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19205 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19207 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19208 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19210 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19211 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19212 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19213 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19214 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19215 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19216 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19217 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19218 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19219 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19223 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19224 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19225 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19226 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19227 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19228 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19229 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19230 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19231 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19233 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19234 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19235 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19236 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19237 &"see"& the original header lines.
19239 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19240 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19241 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19244 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19245 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19247 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19248 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19250 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19251 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19252 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19253 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19255 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19256 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19257 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19261 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19262 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19263 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19264 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19265 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19266 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19267 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19270 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19274 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19276 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19277 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19278 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19279 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19280 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19281 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19283 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19284 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19286 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19287 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19289 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19290 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19292 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19293 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19294 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19295 domain that is being routed.
19297 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19298 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19301 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19302 .cindex "additional groups"
19303 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19304 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19305 .cindex "transport" "local"
19306 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19307 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19308 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19309 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19310 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19314 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19315 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19316 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19317 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19318 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19319 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19320 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19323 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19324 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19325 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19326 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19327 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19328 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19329 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19330 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19331 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19333 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19334 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19335 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19336 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19337 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19338 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19339 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19340 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19341 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19342 the relevant transport.
19344 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19345 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19346 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19348 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19349 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19350 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19353 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19354 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19355 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19356 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19357 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19361 local_part_prefix = real-
19363 transport = local_delivery
19365 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19366 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19368 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19369 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19372 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19373 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19374 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19375 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19378 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19379 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19383 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19384 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19385 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19386 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19387 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19388 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19389 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19390 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19391 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19395 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19396 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19400 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19401 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19402 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19403 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19404 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19406 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19407 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19410 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19412 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19413 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
19414 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19415 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19416 You might use this option, for
19417 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19418 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19419 each virtual domain:
19423 local_parts = postmaster
19424 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19428 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19429 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19430 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19431 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19432 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19433 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19434 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19435 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19436 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19437 redirect addresses.
19441 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19442 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19443 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19444 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19445 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19446 delivery to be deferred.
19448 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19449 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19451 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19452 means of the setting
19456 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19457 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19458 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19460 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19461 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19462 controls what happens next.
19465 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19466 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19467 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19468 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19469 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19470 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19471 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19472 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19474 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19475 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19476 applies to all of them.
19480 .option pass_router routers string unset
19481 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19482 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19483 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19484 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19485 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19486 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19487 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19488 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19489 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19490 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19494 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19495 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19496 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19497 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19498 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19499 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19501 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19502 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19503 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19504 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19508 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19509 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19510 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19511 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19512 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19513 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19514 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19516 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19517 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19518 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19519 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19520 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19522 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19523 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19524 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19525 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19526 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19529 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19530 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19533 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19534 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19535 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19536 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19537 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19538 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19539 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19540 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19542 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19543 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19544 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19545 operates as follows:
19547 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19548 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19549 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19550 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19553 require_files = mail:/some/file
19554 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19556 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19557 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19559 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19560 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19561 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19562 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19564 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19565 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19566 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19567 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19568 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19570 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19571 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19572 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19573 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19574 check again in that process.
19576 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19577 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19578 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19579 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19580 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19581 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19582 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19584 require_files = +/some/file
19586 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19587 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19588 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19592 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19593 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19594 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19595 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19596 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19597 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19598 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19599 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19602 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19603 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19604 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19605 &%check_local_user%&,
19608 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19609 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19612 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19613 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19616 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19617 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19618 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19620 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19621 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19622 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19626 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19627 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19628 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19630 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19631 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19632 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19633 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19634 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19635 cause the router to defer.
19637 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19638 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19640 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19642 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19643 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19645 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19646 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19647 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19648 of these values that is set:
19651 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19653 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19655 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19657 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19660 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19661 router, but not for the transport.
19665 .option self routers string freeze
19666 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19667 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19668 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19669 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19670 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19671 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19673 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19674 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19675 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19676 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19677 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19679 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19680 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19681 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19682 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19683 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19688 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19690 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19691 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19692 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19693 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19695 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19696 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19697 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19702 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19703 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19704 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19705 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19706 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19707 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19713 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19714 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19715 be passed to the next router.
19718 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19721 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19722 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19723 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19724 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19725 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19726 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19731 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19732 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19733 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19734 address matches something on the list.
19735 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19738 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19739 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19740 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19741 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19742 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19743 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19744 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19748 .option set routers "string list" unset
19749 .cindex router variables
19750 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19751 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19752 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19755 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19756 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19757 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19758 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19759 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19762 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
19763 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
19765 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19766 The variables can be used by the router options
19767 (not including any preconditions)
19768 and by the transport.
19769 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19770 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19772 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19773 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19776 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19777 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19778 .cindex "packet radio"
19779 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19780 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19781 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19782 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19783 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19784 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19785 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19786 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19788 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19789 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19790 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19791 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19792 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19793 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19794 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19795 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19796 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19797 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19799 translate_ip_address = \
19800 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19803 The file would contain lines like
19805 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19806 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19808 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19813 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19814 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19815 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19816 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19817 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19818 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19819 delivery is deferred.
19821 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19822 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19823 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19827 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19828 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19829 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19830 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19831 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19832 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19833 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19834 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19835 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19836 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19837 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19843 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19844 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19845 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19846 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19847 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19848 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19849 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19850 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19851 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19852 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19854 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19855 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19856 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19857 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19858 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19860 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19866 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19867 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19868 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19869 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19870 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19871 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19872 delivery to be deferred.
19874 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19875 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19876 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19877 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19878 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19879 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19881 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19882 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19883 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19884 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19885 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19886 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19887 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19888 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19890 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19891 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19892 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19893 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19894 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19895 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19896 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19897 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19898 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19899 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19901 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19902 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19903 subsequent routers.
19906 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19907 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19908 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19909 .cindex "transport" "local"
19910 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19911 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19912 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19913 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19914 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19915 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19916 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19917 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19918 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19919 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19920 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19921 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19925 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19926 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19927 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19930 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19931 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19933 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19934 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19935 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19936 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19937 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19938 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19939 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19941 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19942 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19943 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19947 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19948 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19950 delivering in cutthrough mode
19951 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19952 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19954 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19957 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19958 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19959 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19960 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19962 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19963 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19964 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19971 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19972 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19974 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19975 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19976 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19977 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19978 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19979 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19980 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19981 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19982 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19986 domains = mydomain.example
19988 transport = local_delivery
19990 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19991 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19992 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19993 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20003 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20004 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20005 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20006 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20007 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20008 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20010 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20011 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20012 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20013 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20016 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20017 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20018 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20019 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20020 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20021 generic option, the router declines.
20023 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20024 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20025 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20027 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20028 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20029 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20030 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20031 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20032 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20035 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20036 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20037 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20038 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20039 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20040 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20042 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20043 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20044 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20045 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20046 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20047 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20048 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20049 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20050 case routing fails.
20053 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20054 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20055 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20056 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20057 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20059 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20060 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20062 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20064 The domain does not exist in DNS
20066 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20067 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20068 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20070 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20072 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20074 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20075 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20077 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20078 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20080 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20081 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20083 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20084 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20090 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20091 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20092 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20094 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20095 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20096 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20097 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20098 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20099 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20100 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20103 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20104 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20105 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
20106 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20107 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20108 required. For example,
20112 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20113 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20114 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20115 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20116 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20119 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20120 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20121 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20122 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20123 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20124 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20126 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20127 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20128 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20129 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20130 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20131 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20132 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20133 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20135 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20136 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20141 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20142 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20143 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20144 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20145 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20146 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20147 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20148 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20152 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20153 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20154 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20155 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20156 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20157 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20158 only A records are used.
20160 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20161 .cindex IPv4 preference
20162 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20163 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20164 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20165 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20166 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20168 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20169 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20170 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20171 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20172 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20173 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20174 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20177 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20179 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20180 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20181 the address record.
20184 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20185 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20186 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20187 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20192 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20193 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20194 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20195 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20196 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20197 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20198 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20199 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20200 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20205 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20206 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20207 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20208 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20209 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20210 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20211 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20212 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20213 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20214 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20215 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20217 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20218 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20221 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20222 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20223 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20224 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20225 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20229 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20230 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20231 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20232 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20233 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20234 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20235 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20236 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20238 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20239 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20240 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20241 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20242 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20243 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20244 without processing them independently,
20245 provided the following conditions are met:
20248 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20249 &%headers_remove%&.
20251 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20258 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20259 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20260 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20261 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20262 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20263 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20264 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20265 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20266 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20267 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20269 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20270 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20275 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20276 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20277 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20278 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20283 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20284 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20285 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20286 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20289 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20291 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20292 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20293 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20294 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20295 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20296 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20299 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20300 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20301 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20302 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20303 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20305 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20306 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20307 such as that implied by
20311 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20312 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20313 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20314 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20327 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20328 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20329 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20330 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20331 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20332 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20333 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20334 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20335 router handles the address
20339 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20340 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20341 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20343 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20345 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20346 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20348 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20349 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20350 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20351 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20353 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20354 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20355 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20356 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20361 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20363 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20364 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20365 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20366 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20367 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20368 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20371 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20373 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20375 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20376 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20377 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20378 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20379 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20380 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20381 must not be specified for it.
20383 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20384 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20385 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20386 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20387 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20388 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20389 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20392 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20393 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20394 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20395 delivery to the address is deferred.
20398 .option port iplookup integer 0
20399 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20400 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20404 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20405 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20406 protocols is to be used.
20409 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20410 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20413 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20415 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20416 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20419 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20420 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20421 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20422 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20423 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20424 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20425 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20426 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20429 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20430 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20431 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20432 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20433 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20434 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20435 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20436 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20437 following could be used:
20439 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20440 reroute = $local_part@$1
20443 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20444 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20445 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20446 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20454 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20455 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20456 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20457 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20458 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20459 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20460 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20461 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20462 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20463 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20465 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20466 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20467 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20468 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20469 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20470 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20471 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20474 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20475 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20476 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20477 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20478 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20479 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20480 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20483 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20484 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20485 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20486 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20487 below, following the list of private options.
20490 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20492 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20493 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20495 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20496 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20498 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20499 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20500 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20501 of the following values:
20510 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20511 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20512 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20515 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20516 router only if &%more%& is true.
20518 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20519 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20520 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20521 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20523 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20524 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20525 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20528 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20529 .cindex "randomized host list"
20530 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20531 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20532 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20533 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20534 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20535 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20536 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20537 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20539 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20540 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20541 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20542 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20544 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20546 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20547 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20548 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20549 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20550 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20553 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20554 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20555 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20558 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20560 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20561 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20565 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20566 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20567 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20568 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20571 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20572 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20573 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20574 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20575 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20576 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20577 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20578 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20580 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20581 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20582 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20583 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20584 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20585 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20586 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20587 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20592 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20593 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20594 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20595 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20596 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20597 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20599 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20601 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20605 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20606 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20608 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20609 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20610 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20611 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20612 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20613 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20614 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20615 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20616 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20617 in a &%route_list%&).
20619 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20620 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20621 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20622 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20626 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20627 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20628 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20629 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20630 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20631 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20632 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20635 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20636 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20638 This data can be accessed by setting
20640 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20642 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20643 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20644 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20645 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20646 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20651 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20652 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20653 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20654 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20655 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20656 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20657 The format of each item
20658 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20659 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20661 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20662 variables are set during its expansion:
20665 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20666 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20667 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20669 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20672 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20674 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20677 .vindex "&$value$&"
20678 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20679 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20681 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20685 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20686 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20690 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20691 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20692 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20693 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20694 When no port is given, an IP address
20695 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20696 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20697 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20700 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20701 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20702 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20704 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20705 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20708 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20709 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20710 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20711 number follows. For example:
20713 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20717 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20718 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20719 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20720 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20721 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20724 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20725 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20726 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20727 records in the DNS. For example:
20729 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20731 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20734 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20736 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20737 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20738 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20739 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20740 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20741 happens is controlled by the
20742 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20743 &%self%& option of the router.
20745 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20746 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20747 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20748 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20749 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20750 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20751 defined by MX preferences.
20753 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20754 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20755 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20757 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20758 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20759 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20760 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20762 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20763 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20766 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20767 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20768 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20770 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20771 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20775 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20776 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20777 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20778 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20779 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20780 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20781 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20784 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20785 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20787 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20788 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20790 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20791 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20792 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20794 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20795 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20796 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20798 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20800 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20805 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20806 domain2 host4:host5
20808 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20809 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20810 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20811 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20814 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20815 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20816 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20817 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20820 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20821 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20826 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20827 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20830 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20831 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20835 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20836 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20837 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20840 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20841 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20842 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20843 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20845 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20847 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20848 your first router something like this:
20851 driver = manualroute
20852 domains = !+local_domains
20853 transport = remote_smtp
20854 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20856 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20857 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20858 they are tried in order
20859 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20860 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20863 driver = manualroute
20864 transport = remote_smtp
20865 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20867 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20868 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20869 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20870 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20871 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20872 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20873 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20874 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20877 .cindex "mail hub example"
20878 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20879 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20880 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20881 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20882 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20883 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20884 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20885 lookup is easier to manage.
20887 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20888 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20892 driver = manualroute
20893 transport = remote_smtp
20894 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20896 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20897 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20898 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20899 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20900 domain can be used to find the host:
20903 driver = manualroute
20904 transport = remote_smtp
20905 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20907 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20908 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20909 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20913 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20914 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20915 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20916 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20917 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20918 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20921 driver = manualroute
20922 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20923 route_list = saved.domain.example
20925 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20926 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20927 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20930 driver = manualroute
20932 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20933 *.saved.domain2.example \
20934 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20937 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20939 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20940 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20941 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20942 the address if the lookup fails.
20945 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20946 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20947 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20948 one way it can be done:
20954 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20955 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20956 return_fail_output = true
20961 driver = manualroute
20963 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20965 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20967 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20969 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20970 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20971 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20973 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20974 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20986 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20987 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20988 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20989 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20990 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20991 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20992 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20993 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20994 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20995 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20997 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20999 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21000 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21001 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21002 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21003 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21006 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21007 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21008 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21009 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21010 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21011 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21014 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21015 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21016 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21017 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21018 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21019 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21020 not set, a value for the gid also.
21022 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21023 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21024 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21025 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21026 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21027 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21031 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21032 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21033 before running the command.
21036 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21037 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21038 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21042 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21043 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21044 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21045 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21046 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21049 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21052 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21053 &%no_more%& is set.
21055 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21056 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21057 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21058 included in the SMTP response.
21060 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21061 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21062 included in any SMTP response.
21064 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21066 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21067 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21069 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21070 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21071 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21074 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21075 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21078 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21079 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21081 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21082 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21083 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21084 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21086 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21087 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21088 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21089 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21090 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21092 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21093 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21094 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21095 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21096 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21098 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21099 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21100 variable. For example, this return line
21102 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21104 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21105 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21106 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21107 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21112 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21113 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21115 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21116 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21117 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21118 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21119 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21120 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21121 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21122 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21123 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21124 redirected in several different ways:
21127 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21130 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21132 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21134 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21136 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21138 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21140 It can be discarded.
21143 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21144 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21145 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21146 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21148 If success DSNs have been requested
21149 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21150 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21151 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21155 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21156 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21157 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21158 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21159 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21160 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21164 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21166 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21167 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21168 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21169 cause delivery to be deferred.
21171 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21172 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21177 file = $home/.forward
21180 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21181 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21182 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21183 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
21186 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21187 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21188 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21190 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21191 directly for redirection,
21192 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21193 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21194 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21195 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21199 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21200 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21201 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21202 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21205 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21206 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21207 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21208 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21210 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21211 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21212 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21213 saves some resources.
21221 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21222 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21223 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21224 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21225 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21228 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21229 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21230 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21231 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21232 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21233 document is intended for use by end users.
21235 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21236 described in the next section.
21239 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21240 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21241 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21242 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21243 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21247 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21248 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21249 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21250 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21251 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21252 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21253 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21254 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21255 commas or newlines.
21256 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21259 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21260 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21261 next newline character is ignored.
21263 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21264 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21265 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21266 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21269 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21270 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21271 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21272 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21273 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21274 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21277 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21281 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21282 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21283 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21284 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21285 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21286 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21287 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21288 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21289 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21290 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21291 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21293 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21294 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21295 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21296 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21297 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21299 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21301 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21302 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21303 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21304 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21305 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21308 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21309 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21310 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21311 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21312 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21314 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21315 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21320 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21321 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21324 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21326 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21327 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21328 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21329 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21330 should really contain
21332 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21334 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21335 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21336 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21340 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21341 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21342 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21345 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21346 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21347 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21348 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21349 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21350 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21351 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21353 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21354 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21355 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21356 in double quotes, for example:
21358 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21360 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21361 quote just the command. An item such as
21363 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21365 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21367 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21368 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21369 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21370 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21371 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21372 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21373 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21374 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21375 an &%accept%& router.
21378 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21379 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21380 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21381 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21383 /home/world/minbari
21385 is treated as a filename, but
21387 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21389 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21390 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21391 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21392 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21394 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21395 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21397 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21398 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21399 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21400 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21403 .cindex "included address list"
21404 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21405 If an item is of the form
21407 :include:<path name>
21409 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21410 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21411 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21412 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21413 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21414 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21416 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21418 It must be given as
21420 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21422 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21423 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21424 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21426 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21427 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21428 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21429 .cindex "black hole"
21430 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21431 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21432 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21433 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21437 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21438 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21439 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21441 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21442 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21443 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21444 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21448 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21449 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21450 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21451 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21452 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21453 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21454 redirection items of the form
21459 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21460 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21461 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21462 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21464 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21466 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21468 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21469 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21471 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21472 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21473 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21475 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21476 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21477 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21478 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21479 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21480 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21481 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21482 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21483 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21486 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21487 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21488 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21489 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21491 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21492 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21493 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21494 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21495 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21497 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21498 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21499 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21500 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21501 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21505 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21506 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21507 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21508 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21509 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21510 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21511 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21515 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21516 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21517 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21518 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21519 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21520 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21521 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21522 aliasing scheme of the type
21524 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21528 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21529 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21530 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21533 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21534 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21536 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21537 the pipes are distinct.
21541 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21542 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21543 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21544 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21545 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21546 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21547 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21548 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21549 can be used to avoid this.
21552 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21553 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21554 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21555 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21556 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21557 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21558 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21562 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21564 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21565 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21568 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21569 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21570 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21573 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21574 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21575 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21576 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21579 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21580 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21581 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21582 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21583 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21584 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21585 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21587 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21588 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21591 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21592 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21593 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21594 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21595 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21599 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21600 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21601 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21602 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21603 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21604 let ordinary users do.
21608 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21609 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21610 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21611 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21612 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21613 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21615 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21616 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21617 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21618 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21619 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21620 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21622 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21624 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21625 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21626 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21627 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21628 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21629 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21630 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21631 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21634 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21635 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21636 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21637 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21638 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21639 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21640 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21641 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21645 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21646 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21647 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21648 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21649 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21650 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21653 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21654 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21655 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21656 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21657 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21658 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21660 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21661 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21662 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21664 data = #Exim filter\n\
21665 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21667 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21668 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21669 choice into a newline.
21672 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21673 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21674 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21675 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21676 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21679 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21680 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21681 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21682 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21683 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21684 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21685 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21686 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21688 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21689 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21690 runs a check on the containing directory,
21691 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21692 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21693 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21694 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21695 not, the router declines.
21698 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21699 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21700 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21701 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21702 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21703 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21704 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21707 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21708 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21709 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21710 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21711 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21714 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21715 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21716 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21717 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21721 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21722 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21723 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21724 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21725 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21730 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21731 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21732 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21733 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21734 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21735 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21736 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21737 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21738 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21739 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21740 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21743 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21744 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21745 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21746 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21747 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21750 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21751 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21752 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21753 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21754 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21755 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21757 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21758 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21759 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21760 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21761 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21762 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21763 &_.forward_& files).
21766 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21767 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21768 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21769 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21770 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21773 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21774 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21775 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21776 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21777 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21778 of the embedded Perl support.
21781 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21782 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21783 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21784 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21785 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21788 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21789 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21790 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21791 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21792 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21795 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21796 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21797 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21798 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21799 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21800 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21801 &%one_time%& is set.
21804 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21805 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21806 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21807 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21808 to make use of &%run%& items.
21811 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21812 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21813 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21814 If this option is true, items of the form
21816 :include:<path name>
21818 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21821 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21822 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21823 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21824 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21825 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21826 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21827 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21830 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21831 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21832 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21833 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21834 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21837 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21838 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21839 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21840 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21841 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21846 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21847 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21848 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21849 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21850 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21851 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21852 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21855 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21857 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21858 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21859 file did not exist.
21862 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21864 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21865 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21866 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21868 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21869 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21870 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21871 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21872 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21873 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21874 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21875 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21879 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21880 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21881 redirection list must start with this directory.
21884 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21885 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21886 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21889 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21890 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21891 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21892 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21893 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21894 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21895 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21896 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21897 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21898 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21899 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21900 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21901 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21902 before they subscribed.
21904 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21905 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21906 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21907 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21910 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21911 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21912 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21913 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21915 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21916 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21917 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21919 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21922 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21923 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21924 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21925 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21926 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21930 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21931 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21932 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21933 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21934 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21935 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21936 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21937 See &%check_owner%& above.
21940 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21941 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21942 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21943 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21946 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21947 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21948 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21949 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21950 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21951 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21952 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21955 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21956 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21957 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21958 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21959 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21960 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21961 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21962 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21964 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21965 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21966 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21969 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21970 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21971 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21972 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21973 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21974 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21975 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21976 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21977 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21978 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21981 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21982 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21983 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21984 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21985 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21986 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21989 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21990 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21991 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21992 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21993 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21994 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21997 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21998 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21999 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22000 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22001 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22004 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22005 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22006 :subaddress part of an address.
22008 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22009 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22010 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22011 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22014 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22015 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22016 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22017 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22018 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22019 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22020 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22024 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22025 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22026 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22027 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22028 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22029 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22030 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22031 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22032 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22033 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22034 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22035 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22036 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22037 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22038 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22039 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22041 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22042 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22043 the following routers.
22045 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22046 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22047 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22048 so it is passed to the following routers.
22050 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22051 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22052 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22053 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22055 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22056 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22057 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22058 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22064 file = $home/.forward
22065 file_transport = address_file
22066 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22067 reply_transport = address_reply
22070 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22071 syntax_errors_text = \
22072 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22073 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22074 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22075 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22076 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22077 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22078 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22079 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22080 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22081 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22083 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22084 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22085 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22090 local_part_prefix = real-
22091 transport = local_delivery
22093 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22094 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22096 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
22097 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
22101 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22102 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22105 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22106 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22107 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22108 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22118 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22119 "Environment for local transports"
22120 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22121 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22122 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22123 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22124 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22125 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22126 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22128 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22129 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22130 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22131 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22133 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22134 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22135 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22136 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22137 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22141 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22142 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22143 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22144 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22145 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22146 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22147 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22150 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22151 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22155 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22157 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22158 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22159 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22160 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22165 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22166 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22167 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22168 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22169 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22170 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22171 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22172 group (set by the transport). For example:
22175 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22179 transport = group_delivery
22182 # This transport overrides the group
22184 driver = appendfile
22185 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22188 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22189 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22190 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22193 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22194 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22195 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22196 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22197 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22198 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22200 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22201 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22202 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22203 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22204 original gid is also used.
22206 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22207 following that is set is used:
22210 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22212 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22214 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22215 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22217 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22219 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22220 the uid is the creator's uid;
22222 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22225 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22226 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22227 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22228 The first of the following that is set is used:
22231 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22233 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22235 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22237 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22242 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22243 &%never_users%& list.
22249 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22250 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22251 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22252 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22253 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22254 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22255 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22256 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22257 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22258 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22261 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22263 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22265 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22267 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22270 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22273 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22275 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22279 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22280 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22281 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22285 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22286 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22287 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22288 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22289 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22290 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22291 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22292 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22293 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22294 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22295 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22296 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22297 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22298 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22306 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22307 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22309 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22310 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22311 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22312 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22313 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22316 .option body_only transports boolean false
22317 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22318 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22319 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22320 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22321 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22322 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22323 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22324 automatically suppress them.
22327 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22328 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22329 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22330 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22331 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22332 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22335 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22336 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22337 deliveries by the transport or for any
22338 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22339 what you are doing.
22342 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22343 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22344 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22345 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22347 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22348 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22349 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22350 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22351 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22352 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22354 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22355 transport and the router that called it.
22357 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22358 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22359 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22360 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22361 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22362 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22363 safely be resent to other recipients.
22366 .option driver transports string unset
22367 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22368 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22371 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22372 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22373 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22374 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22375 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22376 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22377 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22378 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22379 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22380 resent to other recipients.
22383 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22385 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22386 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22389 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22390 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22391 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22392 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22393 &%user%& (see below).
22396 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22397 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22398 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22399 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22400 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22401 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22402 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22403 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22404 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22405 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22406 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22408 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22409 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22412 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22413 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22414 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22415 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22416 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22417 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22418 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22419 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22422 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22423 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22424 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22425 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22426 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22427 to be removed from the message.
22428 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22429 Each list item is separately expanded.
22430 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22431 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22432 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22433 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22435 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22436 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22439 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22440 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22442 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22443 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22444 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22448 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22449 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22450 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22451 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22452 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22453 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22454 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22455 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22458 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22461 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22462 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22463 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22464 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22465 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22466 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22467 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22468 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22469 change envelope recipients at this time.
22472 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22473 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22475 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22476 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22477 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22478 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22479 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22480 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22481 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22485 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22486 .cindex "additional groups"
22487 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22488 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22489 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22490 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22491 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22494 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22495 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22496 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22497 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22498 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22499 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22500 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22501 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22503 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22504 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22505 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22506 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22507 Obviously there is scope for
22508 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22509 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22511 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22512 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22513 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22514 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22515 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22518 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22519 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22520 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22521 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22522 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22523 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22524 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22525 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22526 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22527 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22528 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22529 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22530 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22535 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22536 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22537 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22538 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22539 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22540 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22541 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22542 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22545 local_part_prefix = *-
22547 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22550 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22552 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22553 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22554 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22555 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22556 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22559 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22560 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22561 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22562 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22563 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22564 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22565 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22566 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22567 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22569 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22570 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22571 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22572 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22574 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22575 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22576 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22579 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22580 .cindex "envelope sender"
22581 .cindex "envelope from"
22582 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22583 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22584 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22585 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22586 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22587 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22588 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22589 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22590 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22592 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22593 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22595 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22596 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22597 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22598 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22599 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22600 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22601 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22603 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22604 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22605 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22606 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22607 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22611 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22612 .chindex Return-path:
22613 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22614 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22615 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22616 have easy access to it.
22618 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22619 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22620 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22621 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22622 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22626 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22627 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22630 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22631 .cindex "shadow transport"
22632 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22633 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22634 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22636 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22637 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22638 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22639 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22640 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22641 cause a log line to be written.
22643 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22644 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22645 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22646 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22647 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22650 ST=<shadow transport name>
22652 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22653 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22654 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22655 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22656 headers that some sites insist on.
22659 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22660 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22661 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22662 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22663 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22664 individual users or via a system filter.
22665 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22667 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22668 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22669 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22670 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22671 command must be specified as an absolute path.
22673 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22674 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22675 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22676 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22677 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22678 &(pipe)& transports.
22680 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22681 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22682 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22683 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22684 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22686 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22687 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22688 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22689 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22691 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22692 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22693 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22694 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22695 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22696 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22698 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22699 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22700 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22701 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22702 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22703 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22704 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22705 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22707 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22708 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22709 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22710 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22711 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22712 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22713 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22714 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22715 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22716 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22719 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22720 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22721 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22722 which the message is being sent. For example:
22724 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22725 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22728 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22729 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22730 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22732 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22733 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22734 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22737 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22739 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22740 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22741 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22742 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22743 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22744 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22746 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22747 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22748 arguments. Consider this example:
22750 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22751 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22753 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22754 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22756 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22757 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22761 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22762 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22763 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22764 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22765 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22766 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22767 bounced from a transport filter.
22769 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22770 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22771 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22774 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22775 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22776 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22777 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22778 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22779 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22780 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22781 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22782 becomes a temporary error.
22785 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22786 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22787 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22788 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22789 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22790 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22791 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22794 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22795 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22796 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22798 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22799 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22800 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22801 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22803 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22804 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22805 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22813 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22815 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22817 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22818 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22819 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22820 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22821 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22822 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22823 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22825 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22826 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22827 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22828 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22829 local transport, for example:
22832 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22833 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22834 recipients saves space.
22836 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22837 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22839 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22840 to a scanner program or
22841 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22845 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22846 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22847 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22849 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22850 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22851 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22852 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22853 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22854 to certain conditions:
22857 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22858 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22859 batching is possible.
22861 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22862 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22863 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22865 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22866 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22867 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22868 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22869 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22872 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22873 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22874 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22878 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22879 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22880 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22881 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22882 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22883 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22884 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22887 escape_string = ".."
22889 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22890 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22891 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22893 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22894 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22895 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22896 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22897 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22898 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22900 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22901 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22902 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22903 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22904 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22905 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22906 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22907 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22908 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22913 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22914 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22916 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22917 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22918 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22919 .cindex "directory creation"
22920 .cindex "creating directories"
22921 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22922 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22923 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22924 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22925 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22926 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22927 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22928 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22929 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22930 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22932 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22933 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22934 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22937 .cindex "quota" "system"
22938 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22939 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22940 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22942 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22943 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22944 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22945 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22947 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22948 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22951 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22952 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22953 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22954 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22959 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22960 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22961 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22962 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22963 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22965 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22966 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22967 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22968 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22969 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22970 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22971 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22972 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22973 operation. There are two cases:
22976 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22977 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22978 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22979 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22980 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22981 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22982 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22984 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22985 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22986 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22988 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
22989 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
22990 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
22991 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
22992 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
22993 which returns a path (or component).
22996 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22998 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22999 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23004 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23006 require "fileinto";
23007 fileinto "folder23";
23009 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23010 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23011 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
23012 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23013 way of handling this requirement:
23015 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23016 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23017 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23019 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23023 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23024 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23025 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23027 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23028 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23029 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23030 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23031 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23032 path to the transport.
23034 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23035 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23040 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23041 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23045 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23046 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23047 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23048 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23049 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23050 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23051 delivery is deferred.
23054 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23055 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23056 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23057 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23058 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23059 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23060 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23061 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23064 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23065 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23066 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23067 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23071 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23072 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23075 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23076 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23077 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23078 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23079 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23082 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23083 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23084 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23085 process is running.
23088 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23089 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23090 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23091 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23092 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23093 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23094 contains is significant.
23096 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23097 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23098 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23099 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23100 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23102 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23103 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23104 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23105 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23106 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23107 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23109 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23110 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23111 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23112 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23114 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23115 .cindex "directory creation"
23116 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23117 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23118 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23120 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23121 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23122 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23123 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23124 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23128 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23129 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23130 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23131 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23132 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23135 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23136 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23137 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23138 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23139 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23140 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23141 &%file_must_exist%&.
23144 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23145 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23146 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23147 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23149 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23150 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23151 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23152 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23153 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23156 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23158 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23159 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23160 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23161 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23163 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23165 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23166 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23170 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23171 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23172 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23175 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23176 See &%check_string%& above.
23179 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23180 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23181 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23182 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23183 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23184 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23187 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23188 .cindex "locking files"
23189 .cindex "lock files"
23190 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23191 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23193 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23194 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23197 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23198 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23201 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23202 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23203 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23204 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23205 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23206 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23210 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23211 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23212 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23213 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23214 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23215 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23216 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23217 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23218 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23221 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23222 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23224 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23225 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23226 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23227 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23228 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23229 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23230 delivery is deferred.
23233 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23234 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23235 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23236 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23239 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23240 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23241 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23242 .cindex "locking files"
23243 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23244 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23245 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23246 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23247 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23248 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23249 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23250 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23252 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23253 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23254 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23255 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23257 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23258 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23261 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23263 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23264 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23265 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23267 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23268 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23270 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23273 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23274 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23275 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23276 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23279 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23280 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23281 for details of locking.
23284 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23285 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23286 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23289 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23290 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23291 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23294 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23295 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23296 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23297 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23298 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23301 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23302 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23303 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23304 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23305 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23306 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23307 external source that maintains the data.
23310 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23311 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23312 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23313 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23314 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23315 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23316 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23317 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23321 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23322 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23323 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23324 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23325 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23326 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23327 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23328 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23329 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23330 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23333 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23334 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23335 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23336 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23337 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23338 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23339 calculation. The default value is:
23341 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23343 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23344 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23346 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23348 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23350 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23351 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23352 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23353 directly into that directory.
23356 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23357 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23358 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23361 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23362 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23363 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23366 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23367 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23368 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23369 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23370 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23371 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23372 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23373 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23375 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23376 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23377 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23378 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23379 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23380 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23381 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23382 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23383 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23384 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23387 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23388 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23389 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23390 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23391 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23392 below for further details.
23395 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23396 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23397 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23400 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23401 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23402 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23405 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23406 .cindex "locking files"
23407 .cindex "file" "locking"
23408 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23409 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23410 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23411 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23412 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23413 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23414 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23416 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23417 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23418 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23425 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23426 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23427 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23428 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23429 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23430 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23431 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23432 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23434 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23435 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23436 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23437 append messages to it.
23440 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23441 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23442 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23443 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23444 in which case it is:
23446 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23447 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23449 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23450 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23452 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23453 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23454 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23455 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23460 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23461 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23463 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23464 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23465 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23466 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23467 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23468 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23469 value, and this option is ignored.
23472 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23473 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23474 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23475 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23476 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23479 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23480 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23481 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23482 on users about incoming mail.
23485 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23486 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23487 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23488 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23489 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23490 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23491 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23492 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23493 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23495 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23496 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23497 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23499 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23500 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23501 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23502 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23503 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23504 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23506 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23507 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23508 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23509 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23510 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23513 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23514 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23516 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23518 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23519 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23520 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23521 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23522 system quota failures.
23524 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23525 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23526 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23527 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23528 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23529 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23530 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23531 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23532 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23533 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23536 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23537 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23538 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23539 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23540 delivery directory.
23543 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23544 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23545 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23546 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23547 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23550 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23551 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23553 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23554 See &%quota%& above.
23557 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23558 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23559 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23560 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23561 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23562 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23563 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23565 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23566 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23567 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23568 the file length to the filename. For example:
23570 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23571 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23573 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23574 number of lines in the message.
23576 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23577 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23578 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23580 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23582 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23583 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23584 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23585 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23586 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23587 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23590 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23591 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23592 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23594 quota_warn_message = "\
23595 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23596 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23597 This message is automatically created \
23598 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23599 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23600 a warning threshold that is\n\
23601 set by the system administrator.\n"
23605 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23606 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23607 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23608 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23609 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23610 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23611 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23612 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23613 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23617 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23619 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23620 percent sign is ignored.
23622 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23623 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23624 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23625 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23626 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23627 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23629 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23631 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23632 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23635 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23636 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23640 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23641 .cindex "envelope from"
23642 .cindex "envelope sender"
23643 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23644 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23645 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23646 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23647 for details of batch SMTP.
23650 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23651 .cindex "carriage return"
23653 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23654 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23655 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23656 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23658 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23659 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23660 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23661 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23662 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23663 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23666 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23667 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23668 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23669 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23670 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23671 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23674 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23675 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23676 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23677 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23678 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23680 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23681 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23682 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23683 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23685 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23686 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23687 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23688 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23689 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23692 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23693 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23696 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23697 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23698 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23699 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23700 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23701 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23702 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23704 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23705 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23706 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23707 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23710 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23711 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23712 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23715 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23716 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23717 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23718 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23719 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23720 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23721 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23722 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23723 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23725 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23726 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23727 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23728 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23733 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23734 .cindex "appending to a file"
23735 .cindex "file" "appending"
23736 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23739 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23743 .cindex "directory creation"
23744 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23745 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23746 &%directory_mode%& option.
23749 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23750 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23754 .cindex "file" "locking"
23755 .cindex "locking files"
23756 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23757 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23758 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23761 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23762 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23763 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23765 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23767 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23768 Unlink the hitching post name.
23770 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23771 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23772 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23773 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23775 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23776 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23777 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23778 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23779 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23780 it before trying again.
23784 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23785 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23786 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23789 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23790 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23791 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23792 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23793 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23794 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23795 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23796 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23797 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23801 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23802 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23803 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23804 delivery is deferred.
23807 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23808 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23809 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23813 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23814 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23815 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23818 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23819 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23820 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23823 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23824 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23825 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23826 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23827 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23828 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23829 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23830 that prevents link following.
23833 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23834 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23835 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23836 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23837 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23840 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23843 .cindex "file" "locking"
23844 .cindex "locking files"
23845 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23846 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23847 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23848 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23849 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23851 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23853 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23854 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23855 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23857 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23858 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23859 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23861 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23862 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23863 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23864 delivery is deferred.
23866 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23867 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23868 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23869 immediately. It retries up to
23871 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23873 times (rounded up).
23876 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23877 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23880 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23881 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23882 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23883 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23884 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23885 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23886 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23887 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23888 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23889 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23891 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23892 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23893 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23894 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23895 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23896 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23897 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23899 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23900 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23901 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23902 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23905 .cindex "maildir format"
23906 .cindex "mailstore format"
23907 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23908 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23909 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23910 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23911 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23913 .cindex "directory creation"
23914 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23915 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23916 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23917 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23918 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23919 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23924 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23925 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23926 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23927 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23928 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23929 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23930 &_new_& subdirectory.
23932 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23933 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23934 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23935 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23936 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23937 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23938 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23940 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23941 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23942 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23943 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23944 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23945 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23946 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23947 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23949 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23950 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23951 folders. Consider this example:
23953 maildir_format = true
23954 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
23955 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23956 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23957 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23959 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23960 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23961 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23962 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23963 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23964 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23966 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23967 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23968 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23969 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23970 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23972 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23973 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23974 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23976 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23977 .cindex "maildir++"
23978 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23979 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23980 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23981 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23982 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23983 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23984 amount of space used.
23986 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23987 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23988 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23989 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23990 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23991 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23996 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23997 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23998 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23999 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24000 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24001 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24004 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24005 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24006 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24007 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24008 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24009 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24010 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24011 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24012 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24013 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24014 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24015 backwards compatibility).
24017 For one common implementation, you might set:
24019 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24021 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24023 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24024 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24025 &[stat()]& each message file.
24028 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24029 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24030 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24031 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24032 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24033 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24034 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24035 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24036 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24038 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24039 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24040 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24041 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24042 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24043 need to know the quota.
24045 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24046 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24048 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24049 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24050 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24054 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24055 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24056 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24057 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24058 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24059 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24060 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24061 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24063 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24064 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24065 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24066 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24067 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24068 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24070 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24071 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24072 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24073 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24074 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24075 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24077 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24078 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24079 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24080 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24083 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24084 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24085 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24086 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24087 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24089 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24091 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24092 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24093 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24094 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24095 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24103 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24105 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24106 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24107 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24108 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24109 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24110 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24111 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24112 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
24114 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24115 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24116 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24117 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24118 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24121 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24122 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24123 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24124 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24125 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24127 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24128 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24129 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24130 transport is run as a consequence of a
24132 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24133 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24134 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24135 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24136 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24137 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24139 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24140 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24141 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24142 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24144 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24145 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24146 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24147 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24148 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24149 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24150 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24152 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24153 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24154 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24155 the transport defers.
24156 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24157 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24159 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24160 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24161 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24162 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24164 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24165 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24166 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24167 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24168 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24169 problems. They are just discarded.
24173 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24174 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24176 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24177 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24178 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24181 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24182 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24183 when the message is specified by the transport.
24186 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24187 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24188 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24189 string comes first.
24192 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24193 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24194 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24197 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24198 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24199 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24202 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24203 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24204 specified by the transport.
24207 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24208 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
24209 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24210 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24213 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24214 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24215 the message is specified by the transport.
24218 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24219 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24223 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24224 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24225 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24226 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24227 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24231 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24232 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24233 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24234 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24236 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24237 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24238 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24239 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24240 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24241 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24242 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24245 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24246 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24247 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24248 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24249 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24251 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24252 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24253 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24254 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24255 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24256 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24259 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24260 See &%once%& above.
24263 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24264 See &%once%& above.
24265 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24268 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24269 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24270 specified by the transport.
24273 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24274 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24275 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24276 configuration option.
24279 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24280 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24281 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24282 automatic responses. For example:
24284 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24286 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24287 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24288 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24289 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24294 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24295 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24296 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24297 the text comes first.
24300 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24301 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24302 when the message is specified by the transport.
24303 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24304 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24309 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24312 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24313 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24314 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24315 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24316 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
24317 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24319 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24320 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24321 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24322 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24323 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24324 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24328 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24329 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24330 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24333 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24334 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24337 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24338 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24339 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24340 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24341 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24344 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24345 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24346 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24347 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24348 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24349 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24352 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24353 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24354 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24355 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24356 in its response to the LHLO command.
24358 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24359 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24360 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24361 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24364 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24365 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24366 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24367 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24372 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24376 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24377 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24382 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24384 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24385 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24386 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24387 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24388 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24389 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24390 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24391 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24395 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24396 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24397 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24398 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24399 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24401 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24402 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24403 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24404 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24405 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24406 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24407 that are routed to the transport.
24409 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24410 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24411 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24412 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24413 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24414 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24415 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24419 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24420 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24421 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24423 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24424 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24425 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24426 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24427 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24428 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24429 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24431 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24432 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24433 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24436 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24437 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24438 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24439 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24440 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24441 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24442 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24447 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24448 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24449 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24450 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24451 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24452 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24453 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24454 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24455 &"local delivery failed"&.
24457 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24458 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24459 will be sent as normal.
24461 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24462 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24463 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24464 apply in this case.
24466 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24467 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24468 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24469 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24471 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24472 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24473 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24474 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24475 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24476 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24477 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24482 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24483 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24484 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24485 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24486 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24489 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24490 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24491 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24492 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24494 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24495 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24496 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24497 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24498 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24500 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24502 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24503 arguments. You have to write
24505 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24507 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24508 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24509 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24510 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24511 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24512 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24515 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24518 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24519 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24520 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24521 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24522 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24523 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24524 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24525 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24526 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24527 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24528 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24530 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24531 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24532 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24533 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24534 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24535 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24536 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24537 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24539 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24540 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24541 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24542 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24543 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24544 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24545 control what is done with it.
24547 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24548 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24549 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24550 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24551 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24552 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24553 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24554 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24555 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24556 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24557 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24561 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24562 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24563 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24564 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24565 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24566 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24567 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24568 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24570 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24571 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24572 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24573 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24574 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24575 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24576 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24577 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24578 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24579 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24580 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24581 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24582 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24583 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24584 &`USER `& see below
24586 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24587 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24588 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24589 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24590 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24591 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24592 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24595 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24596 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24597 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24601 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24602 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24603 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24604 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24607 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24608 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24612 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24613 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24614 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24615 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24616 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24617 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24618 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24619 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24620 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24621 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24622 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24625 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24627 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24628 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24629 &%use_shell%& is set.
24632 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24633 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24636 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24637 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24638 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24641 .option check_string pipe string unset
24642 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24643 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24644 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24645 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24646 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24647 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24648 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24652 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24653 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24654 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24655 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24656 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24657 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24658 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24661 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
24662 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24663 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24664 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24665 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24666 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24667 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24670 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24671 See &%check_string%& above.
24674 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24675 .cindex "exec failure"
24676 .cindex "failure of exec"
24677 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24678 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24679 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24680 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24681 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24684 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24685 .cindex "signal exit"
24686 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24687 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24688 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24689 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24692 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24693 .cindex "force command"
24694 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24695 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24696 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24697 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24698 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24699 command. For example:
24701 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24705 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24706 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24707 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24710 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24711 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24712 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24713 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24714 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24715 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24717 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24718 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24721 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24722 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24723 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24724 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24725 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24726 written to the main log.
24729 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24730 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24731 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24732 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24733 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24734 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24738 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24739 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24740 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24741 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24742 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24745 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24746 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24747 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24748 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24749 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24750 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24751 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24752 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24755 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24756 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24757 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24760 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24764 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24765 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24766 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24767 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24768 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24773 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24774 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24777 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24778 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24779 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24780 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24784 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24785 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24788 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24789 This option is expanded and
24790 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24791 variable of the subprocess.
24792 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24793 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24794 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24797 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24798 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24799 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24800 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24801 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24802 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24803 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24804 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24805 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24808 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24809 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24810 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24811 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24812 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24813 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24814 accept the message is used.
24817 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24818 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24819 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24820 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24821 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24822 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24825 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24826 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24827 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24828 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24829 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24830 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24831 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24835 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24836 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24837 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24838 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24839 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24840 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24841 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24842 of them may be set.
24846 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24847 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24848 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24849 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24850 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24851 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24852 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24853 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24854 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24855 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24856 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24857 and 73, respectively.
24860 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24861 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24862 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24863 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24864 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24865 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24866 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24868 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24869 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24870 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24871 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24872 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24873 delivery to be deferred.
24875 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24876 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24879 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24880 .cindex "envelope sender"
24881 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24882 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24883 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24884 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24885 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24887 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24888 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24889 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24890 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24891 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24892 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24896 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24897 .cindex "carriage return"
24899 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24900 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24901 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24902 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24904 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24905 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24906 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24907 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24908 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24911 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24912 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24913 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24914 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24915 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24916 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24917 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24918 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24919 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24924 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24925 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24926 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24927 .cindex "external local delivery"
24928 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24929 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24930 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24931 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24932 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24933 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24934 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24935 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24936 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24937 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24942 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
24946 check_string = "From "
24947 escape_string = ">From "
24949 user = $local_part_data
24956 transport = procmail_pipe
24958 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24959 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24960 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24961 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24962 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24963 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24965 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24969 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24970 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24973 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24974 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24977 local_delivery_cyrus:
24979 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24980 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24992 local_part_suffix = .*
24993 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24995 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24996 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24998 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24999 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25002 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25003 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25005 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25006 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25007 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25008 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25009 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25010 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25011 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25012 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25015 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25016 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25020 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25021 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25022 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25023 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25024 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25025 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25026 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25028 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25029 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25030 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25031 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25032 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25033 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25038 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25039 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25040 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25044 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25046 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25047 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25048 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25049 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25050 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25051 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25052 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25053 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25056 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25057 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25058 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25059 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25060 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25061 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25062 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25063 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25064 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25065 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25066 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25067 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25068 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25069 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25071 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25072 and will be removed in a future release.
25075 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25076 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25077 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25080 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25081 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25082 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25083 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25084 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25085 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25086 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25087 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25089 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25090 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25091 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25092 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25093 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25094 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25095 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25096 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25097 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25100 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25102 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25103 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25104 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25105 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25106 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25109 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25110 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25111 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25112 particular connection.
25114 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25115 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25116 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25117 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25119 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25120 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25121 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25123 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25125 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25126 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25128 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25129 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25133 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25134 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25135 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25136 authenticated as a client.
25139 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25140 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25141 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25142 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25143 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25146 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25147 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25148 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25149 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25150 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25151 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25152 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25153 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
25156 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25157 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25158 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25159 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25160 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25161 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25162 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25166 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25167 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25168 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25169 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25170 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25171 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25172 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25173 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25174 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25175 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25176 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25177 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25178 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25179 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25182 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25183 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25184 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25185 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25186 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25189 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25190 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25191 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
25192 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25193 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25194 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25195 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25196 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25197 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25198 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25199 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25200 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25201 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25202 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25203 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25204 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25205 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25206 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25209 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25210 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25211 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25212 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25213 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25216 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25217 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25218 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25219 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25220 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25221 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25223 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25224 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25225 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25226 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25227 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25228 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25229 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25230 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25234 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25235 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25236 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25237 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25238 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25241 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25242 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25243 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25244 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25248 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25249 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25250 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25251 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25252 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25253 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25254 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25255 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25260 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25261 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25262 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25263 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25264 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25265 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25266 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25267 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25268 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25272 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25273 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25274 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25275 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25276 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25277 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25278 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25280 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25281 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25282 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25283 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25284 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25287 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25288 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25289 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25290 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25291 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25292 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25293 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25294 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25296 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25297 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25298 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25299 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25300 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25301 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25303 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25304 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25305 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25306 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25307 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25309 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25310 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25311 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25312 copy of the message is sent.
25314 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25315 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25316 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25317 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25321 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25322 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25323 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25324 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25327 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25328 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25329 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25330 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25331 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25332 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25334 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25335 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25336 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25337 implementations of TLS.
25339 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25340 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25341 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25342 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25343 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25344 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25345 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25350 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25351 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25352 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25353 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25354 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25355 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25356 interface address, you could use this:
25358 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
25359 {$primary_hostname}}
25361 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25364 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25365 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25366 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25367 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25368 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25369 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25371 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25372 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25373 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25374 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25376 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25377 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25378 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25379 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25380 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25381 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25382 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25384 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25385 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25386 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25387 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25388 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25389 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25390 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25393 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25394 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25397 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25398 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25399 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25400 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25401 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25402 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25403 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25404 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25405 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25406 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25409 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25410 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25411 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25412 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25413 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25415 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25416 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25417 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
25418 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25419 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25420 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25422 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25423 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25424 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25425 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25426 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25428 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25431 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
25432 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25434 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25435 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25436 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25437 You have been warned.
25440 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25441 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25442 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25443 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25445 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25446 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25447 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25448 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25449 to any host that matches this list.
25452 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25453 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25454 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25455 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25456 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25457 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25458 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25459 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25462 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25463 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25464 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25469 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25470 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25471 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25472 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25473 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25474 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25475 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25476 explanation of when this might be needed.
25478 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25479 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25480 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25481 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25482 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25483 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25484 message on the same session.
25486 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25487 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25488 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25489 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25490 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25491 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25496 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25497 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25498 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25499 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25500 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25503 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25504 .cindex "randomized host list"
25505 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25506 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25507 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25508 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25509 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25510 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25511 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25512 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25514 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25515 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25516 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25517 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25519 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25521 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25522 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25523 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25525 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25526 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25527 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25528 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25529 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25530 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25531 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25532 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25533 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25536 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
25537 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25538 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25539 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25540 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25542 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25543 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25544 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25545 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25546 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25547 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
25548 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25549 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25550 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25552 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25553 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25554 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25555 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25556 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25558 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25559 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25560 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25561 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25562 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25563 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25565 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25566 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25567 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25568 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25569 connects. If authentication fails
25571 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
25573 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
25574 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25576 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25577 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25578 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25579 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25580 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25581 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25582 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25583 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25585 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25586 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25587 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25589 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
25590 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
25591 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
25592 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
25593 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25595 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25596 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25598 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25599 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25600 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25601 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25602 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25603 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25604 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25605 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25606 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25607 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25609 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25610 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25612 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25613 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25614 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25615 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25616 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25618 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25619 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25620 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25621 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25622 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25623 for multi-recipient messages.
25624 The option can usually be left as default.
25626 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25627 .cindex "bind IP address"
25628 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
25630 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25631 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25632 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25633 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25634 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25635 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25636 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25637 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25640 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25641 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25642 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25643 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25644 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25645 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25648 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25650 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25651 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25652 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25653 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25656 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25657 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25658 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25659 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25660 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25661 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25662 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25663 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25664 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25665 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25669 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25670 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25671 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25672 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25673 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25675 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25676 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25677 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25678 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25679 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25684 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
25685 .cindex "line length" limit
25686 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
25687 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
25688 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
25690 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
25692 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
25693 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
25697 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25698 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25699 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25700 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25701 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25702 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25703 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25704 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25706 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25707 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25708 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25711 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
25712 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
25713 sent on the connection.
25716 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25717 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25718 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25719 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25720 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25721 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25722 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25723 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25725 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25726 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25728 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25729 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25730 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25733 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25734 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25738 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25739 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25740 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25741 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25743 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25744 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25745 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25746 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25747 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25749 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25750 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25751 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25752 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25753 but as of RFC 8314 it is preferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25754 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25757 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25758 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25759 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25760 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25761 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25762 addresses is not affected.
25764 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25765 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25766 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25767 Exim to use only the host name.
25768 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25771 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25772 .cindex "serializing connections"
25773 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25774 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25775 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25776 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25777 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25778 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25779 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25781 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25782 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25783 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25784 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25785 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25786 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25788 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25789 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25790 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25791 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25792 are used for ETRN serialization.
25794 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25797 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25798 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
25799 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25800 .cindex "size" "of message"
25801 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25802 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25803 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25804 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25805 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25806 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25807 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25808 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25810 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25811 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25814 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25815 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25816 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25817 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25820 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25821 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25822 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25824 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25825 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25826 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25827 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25828 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25831 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25832 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25833 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25834 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25838 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25839 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25840 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25841 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25842 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25845 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25846 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25847 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25848 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25849 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25850 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25853 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25856 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25857 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25859 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25860 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25861 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25862 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25863 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25864 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25865 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25866 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25869 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25870 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25871 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25873 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25874 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25875 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25876 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25877 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25878 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25879 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25880 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25881 ciphers is a preference order.
25885 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25886 .cindex TLS resumption
25887 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
25888 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
25893 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25894 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25896 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
25897 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25898 If this option is set
25900 and the connection is not DANE-validated
25902 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25903 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25904 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25905 certificate and private key for the session.
25907 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25909 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25915 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25916 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25917 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25918 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25919 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25920 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25921 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25922 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25923 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25924 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25928 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25929 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25930 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25931 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25932 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25933 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25934 Note that unless the host is in this list
25935 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25936 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25937 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25938 certificate verification succeeds.
25941 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25942 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25943 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25944 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25945 while verifying the server certificate,
25946 checks will be included on the host name
25947 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25948 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25949 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25951 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25954 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25955 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25956 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25958 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25959 The value of this option must be either the
25961 or the absolute path to
25962 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25963 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25965 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25966 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25967 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25970 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25971 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25973 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25975 either by file or directory
25976 are added to those given by the system default location.
25978 The values of &$host$& and
25979 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25980 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25982 For back-compatibility,
25983 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25984 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25985 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25988 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25989 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25990 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25991 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25992 certificate verification must succeed.
25993 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25994 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25995 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25997 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
25998 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25999 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26000 If built with internationalization support,
26001 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26003 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26004 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26005 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26006 set this option to an empty string.
26007 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26012 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26014 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26015 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26016 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26017 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26018 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26021 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26022 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26023 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26024 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26027 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26028 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26029 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26031 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26032 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26033 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26034 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26035 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26037 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26038 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26039 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26040 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26041 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26042 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26043 see below for an exception).
26045 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26046 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26047 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26048 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26049 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26051 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26052 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26053 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26054 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26055 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26056 reached their retry times.
26058 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26059 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26060 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26061 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26062 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26063 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26064 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26065 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26066 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26067 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26070 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26071 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26072 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26073 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26074 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26075 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26077 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26078 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26079 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26080 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26081 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26082 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26088 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26089 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26091 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26092 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26093 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26094 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26095 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26096 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26098 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26099 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26100 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26101 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26102 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26103 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26104 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26106 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26107 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26108 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26109 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26112 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26113 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26114 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26115 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26117 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26118 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26119 facility; you do not have to use it.
26121 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26122 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26123 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26124 address to which it applies.
26126 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26127 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26128 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26129 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26130 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26131 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26134 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26135 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26136 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26137 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26140 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26141 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26142 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26143 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26144 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26147 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26148 illustrated by these examples:
26151 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26152 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26153 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26154 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26156 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26157 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26162 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26163 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26164 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26165 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26166 message's processing.
26168 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26169 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26170 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26171 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26172 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26173 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26174 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26175 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26176 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26178 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26179 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26180 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26181 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26182 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26183 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26184 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26185 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26186 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26187 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26189 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26190 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26191 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26192 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26193 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26194 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26196 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26197 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26198 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26200 .cindex "envelope from"
26201 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26202 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26203 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26204 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26205 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26206 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26207 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26208 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26209 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26211 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26212 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26218 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26219 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26220 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26221 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26222 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26223 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
26224 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26225 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26226 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26227 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26229 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26231 might produce the output
26233 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26234 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26235 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26236 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26237 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26238 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26239 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26240 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26242 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26243 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26244 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26245 set for a particular transport.
26248 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26249 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26250 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26253 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26255 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26256 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26257 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26258 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26260 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26261 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26262 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26263 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26266 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26267 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26268 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26270 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26271 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26272 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26273 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26274 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26275 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26276 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26278 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26279 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26280 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26281 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26282 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26286 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26287 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26290 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26291 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26292 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26293 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26294 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26295 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26296 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26297 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26298 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26300 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26301 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26302 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26304 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26305 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26306 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26307 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26308 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26309 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26310 of pattern they are set as follows:
26313 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26314 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26315 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26318 *queen@*.fict.example
26320 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26322 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26326 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26327 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26330 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26331 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26332 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26333 rewriting rule of the form
26335 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26337 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26343 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26344 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26345 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26346 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26347 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26351 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26352 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26353 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26354 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26355 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26357 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26359 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26362 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26363 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26364 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26365 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26366 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26367 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26368 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26369 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26370 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26371 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26372 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26373 entry written to the panic log.
26377 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
26378 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26381 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26384 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26386 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26389 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26390 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26394 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26396 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
26397 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26398 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26399 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26400 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26401 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26403 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26404 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26405 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26406 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26407 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26408 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26409 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26410 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26411 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26412 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26414 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26415 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26416 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26418 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26419 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26422 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
26423 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
26424 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
26425 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
26426 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26427 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26428 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26429 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26430 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26432 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26433 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26434 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26435 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26436 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26437 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26438 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26439 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26442 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
26443 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26444 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26445 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26448 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26449 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26450 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26452 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26453 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26454 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26455 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26457 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26458 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26459 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26461 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26462 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26463 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26464 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26466 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26470 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26473 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26474 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26475 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26476 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26477 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26478 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26479 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26480 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26482 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26483 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26487 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26488 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26490 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26491 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26492 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26494 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26495 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26496 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26497 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26498 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26499 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26500 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26501 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26503 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26504 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26506 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26508 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26509 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26511 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26512 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26513 messages that originate outside the local host:
26515 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26516 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26518 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26521 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26522 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26523 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26524 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26525 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26526 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26527 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26528 components. For example, the rule
26530 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26532 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26533 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26534 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26535 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26536 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26537 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26538 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26548 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26549 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26550 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26551 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26552 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26553 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26554 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26555 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26556 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26557 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26558 address, domain and error.
26560 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26561 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26562 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26563 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26564 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26565 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26566 log selector is set, the message
26567 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26568 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26569 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26570 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26572 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26573 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26574 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26575 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26576 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26577 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26578 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26579 domain are maintained independently.
26581 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26582 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26583 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26584 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26585 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26586 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26587 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26588 the local address is reached.
26590 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26591 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26592 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26593 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26594 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26596 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26597 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26598 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26599 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26600 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26601 messages that it should now be retaining.
26605 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26606 .cindex "retry" "rules"
26607 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26608 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26609 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26610 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26611 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26612 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26613 message's sender, respectively.
26616 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26617 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26618 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26619 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26620 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26621 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26624 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26626 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26629 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26631 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26632 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26635 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26636 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26637 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26638 expressions work in address lists.
26640 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26641 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26645 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26646 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26647 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26648 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26649 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26650 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26651 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26652 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26653 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26655 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26656 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26657 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26658 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26661 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26662 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26663 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26664 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26665 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26666 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26667 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26668 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26669 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26670 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26675 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26677 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26678 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26679 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26680 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26681 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26682 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26684 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26688 and the retry rules are
26690 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26691 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26693 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26694 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26695 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26696 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26697 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26698 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26700 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26701 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26702 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26703 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26705 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26706 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26707 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26709 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26711 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26712 textual form of the IP address.
26714 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26715 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26716 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26717 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26720 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
26721 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26722 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26724 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
26725 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26726 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26728 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26729 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26731 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26732 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26735 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26736 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26737 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26738 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26739 retry rule of this form:
26741 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26743 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26744 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26747 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26748 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26749 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26750 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26753 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26754 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26755 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26756 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26757 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26759 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26760 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26762 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26763 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26766 A connection was refused.
26768 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26769 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26771 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26772 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26774 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26775 A connection attempt timed out.
26777 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26778 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26779 obtained from an MX record.
26781 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26782 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26783 obtained from an MX record.
26786 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26788 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26789 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26790 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26791 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26794 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26797 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26798 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26799 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26800 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26801 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26802 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26806 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26807 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26808 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26809 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26810 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26814 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26815 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26816 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26818 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26819 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26820 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26821 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26822 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26823 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26824 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26826 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26827 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26830 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26831 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26832 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26837 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26838 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26839 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26840 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26841 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26844 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26846 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26848 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26850 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26851 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26854 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26856 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26857 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26858 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26859 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26860 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26862 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26863 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26865 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26867 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26868 list is never matched.
26874 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26875 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26876 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26877 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26879 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26881 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26882 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26883 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26884 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26885 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26887 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26888 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26889 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26890 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26891 The available algorithms are:
26894 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26897 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26898 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26899 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26901 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26902 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26903 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26904 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26905 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26906 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26907 queue processing times.
26910 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26911 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26912 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26913 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26914 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26915 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26916 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26917 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26918 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26919 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26920 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26921 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26923 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26924 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26925 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26926 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26927 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26928 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26931 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26932 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26933 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26934 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26935 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26936 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26937 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26938 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26939 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26940 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26941 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26942 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26944 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26945 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26946 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26947 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26948 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26949 deliveries that have been deferred.
26952 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26953 Here are some example retry rules:
26955 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26956 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26957 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26958 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26959 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26960 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26962 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26963 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26964 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26965 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26966 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26967 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26968 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26971 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26972 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26973 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26974 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26975 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26977 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26978 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26979 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26980 were not obtained from an MX record.
26982 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26983 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26984 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26985 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26986 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26990 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26991 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26992 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26993 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26994 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26995 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26996 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26997 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26998 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26999 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27000 failing for the first time.
27002 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27003 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27004 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27005 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27007 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27008 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27009 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27014 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27015 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27016 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27017 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27018 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27019 default retry rule:
27021 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27023 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27024 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27025 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27027 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27028 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27029 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27030 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27031 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27033 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27034 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27035 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27037 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27038 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27039 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27040 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27041 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27042 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27043 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27044 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27045 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27046 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27047 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27049 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27050 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27051 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27052 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27053 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27056 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27057 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27058 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27059 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27060 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27061 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27062 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27063 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27064 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27067 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27068 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27069 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27070 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27071 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27072 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27073 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27074 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27077 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27078 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27079 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27080 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27081 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27082 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27083 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27084 time out the address.
27086 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27087 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27088 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27089 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27090 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27091 considered immediately.
27092 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27093 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27100 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27103 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27104 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27105 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27106 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27107 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27108 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27109 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27110 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27111 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27114 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27115 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27116 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27119 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27120 the client's EHLO command.
27122 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27123 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27125 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27126 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27127 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27128 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27129 with the AUTH command.
27131 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27133 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27134 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27135 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27138 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27139 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27140 unauthenticated connection.
27143 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27144 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27145 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27146 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27148 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27149 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27150 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27151 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27152 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27153 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27154 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27155 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27160 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27161 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27162 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27163 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27164 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27165 included by setting
27168 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27172 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27177 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27178 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
27179 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27180 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27181 work via a socket interface.
27182 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27183 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
27184 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27185 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27186 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27187 supporting setting a server keytab.
27188 The seventh can be configured to support
27189 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27190 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27191 The eighth authenticator
27192 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27193 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27194 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27196 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27197 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27198 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27199 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27200 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27201 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27202 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27204 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27205 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27206 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27207 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27208 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27209 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27213 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27214 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27216 client_secret = secret2
27218 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27219 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27221 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27222 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27223 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27226 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27227 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27228 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27229 authenticating data.
27231 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27232 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27233 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27234 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27235 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27236 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27237 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27238 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27239 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27240 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27243 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27244 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27245 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27246 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27250 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27251 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27252 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27254 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27255 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27256 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27257 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27258 encrypted by a setting such as:
27260 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27264 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27265 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27266 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27267 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27270 .option driver authenticators string unset
27271 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27272 authenticators is to be used.
27275 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27276 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27277 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27278 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
27279 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27280 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27283 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27284 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27285 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27286 mechanism is not advertised.
27287 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27288 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27289 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27292 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27293 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27294 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27297 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27298 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27300 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27301 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27302 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27303 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27304 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27305 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27306 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27307 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27308 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27312 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27313 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27314 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27315 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27316 out the values of variables.
27317 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27318 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27321 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27322 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27323 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27324 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27325 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27326 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27327 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27328 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27329 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27330 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27331 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27332 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27335 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27336 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27337 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27338 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27339 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27340 remembered for later use.
27341 How it is used is described in the following section.
27347 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27348 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27349 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27350 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27351 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27355 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27356 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27358 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27360 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27361 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27362 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27363 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27364 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27365 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27366 given for the MAIL command.
27368 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27369 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27372 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27373 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27374 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27375 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27376 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27377 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27378 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27383 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27384 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27385 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27386 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27388 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27389 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27390 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27391 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27392 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27397 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27398 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27399 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27400 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27404 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27406 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27407 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27410 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27411 the mechanisms are advertised.
27413 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27414 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27415 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27416 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27417 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27418 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27419 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27421 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27423 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27425 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27426 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27427 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27430 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27432 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27433 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27434 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27436 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27437 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27438 command. This is the case if
27441 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27443 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27445 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27446 server authenticators.
27450 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27451 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27452 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27454 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27455 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27456 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27457 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27458 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27459 rejected with a 504 error.
27461 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27462 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27463 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27464 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27465 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27466 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27467 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27468 no successful authentication.
27470 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27471 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27472 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27477 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27478 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27479 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27480 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27481 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27482 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27483 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27487 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27489 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27490 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27491 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27492 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27493 command line to run this script on such data might be
27495 encode '\0user\0password'
27497 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27498 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27499 whose code value is zero.
27501 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27502 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27503 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27504 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27506 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27507 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27508 example, a command such as
27510 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27512 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27514 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
27515 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27517 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27519 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27520 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27521 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27522 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27526 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27527 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27528 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27529 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27530 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27531 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27534 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27535 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27536 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27537 of the authenticator.
27540 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27541 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27542 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27543 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27544 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27545 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27546 delivery to be deferred.
27548 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27549 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27550 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27553 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27554 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27555 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27556 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27557 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27558 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27559 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27560 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27561 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27564 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27565 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27566 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27567 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27568 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27569 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27570 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27571 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27573 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27575 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27576 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27577 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27578 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27579 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27580 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27581 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27582 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27583 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27584 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27585 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27586 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
27587 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
27594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27595 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27597 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27598 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27599 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27600 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27601 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27602 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27603 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27604 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27605 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27606 connections as you do for login accounts.
27608 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27609 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27610 TLS is not being used:
27612 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27613 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27616 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27617 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27618 (including their names) have been properly verified.
27620 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27621 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27622 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27624 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27625 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27626 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27628 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27629 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27630 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27633 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27634 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27635 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27636 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27637 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27638 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27639 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27641 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27642 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27643 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27644 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27645 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27646 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27647 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27649 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27650 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27651 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27652 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27654 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27655 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27656 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27658 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27659 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27660 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27661 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27662 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27663 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27664 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27665 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27666 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27667 string as the error text.
27669 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27670 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27671 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27675 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27676 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27677 .cindex authentication PLAIN
27678 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27679 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27680 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27681 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27682 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27684 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27685 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27686 configured as follows:
27690 public_name = PLAIN
27692 server_condition = \
27693 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27694 server_set_id = $auth2
27696 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27697 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27698 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27699 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27701 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27702 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27703 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27704 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27708 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27710 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27712 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27713 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27717 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27718 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27720 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27721 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27722 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27723 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27724 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27726 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27727 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27728 authenticating clients it could make sense.
27730 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27731 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27732 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27733 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27734 This is an incorrect example:
27736 server_condition = \
27737 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27739 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27740 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27741 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27742 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27743 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27744 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27745 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27747 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27748 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27750 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27751 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27752 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27753 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27754 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27757 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27758 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27759 .cindex authentication LOGIN
27760 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27761 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27762 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27763 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27767 public_name = LOGIN
27768 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27769 server_condition = \
27770 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27771 server_set_id = $auth1
27773 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27774 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27775 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27776 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27778 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27779 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27780 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27781 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27782 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27786 public_name = LOGIN
27787 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27788 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27791 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27792 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27793 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27794 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27796 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27797 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27798 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27799 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27800 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27801 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27802 uninterpreted string.
27805 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27806 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27807 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27808 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27809 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27815 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27816 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27817 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27819 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27820 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27821 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27822 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27825 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27826 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27827 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27828 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27829 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27830 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27831 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27832 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27833 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27834 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27835 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27836 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27838 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27839 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27841 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27842 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27843 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27844 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27847 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27848 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27852 public_name = PLAIN
27853 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27855 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27856 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
27858 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
27859 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
27864 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27868 public_name = LOGIN
27869 client_send = : username : mysecret
27871 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27872 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27874 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27875 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27883 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27884 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27885 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27886 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27887 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
27888 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27889 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27890 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27891 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27892 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27893 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27894 available in plain text at either end.
27897 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27898 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27899 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27900 authenticator as a server:
27902 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27903 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27904 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27905 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27906 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27907 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27908 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27909 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27910 returned to the client.
27912 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27913 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27914 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27915 numeric variables for other things.
27917 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27918 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27919 user name, authentication fails.
27923 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27924 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27925 server_set_id = $auth1
27927 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27928 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27929 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27930 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27934 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27935 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27937 server_set_id = $auth1
27939 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27940 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27942 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27943 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27944 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27949 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27950 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27951 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27952 server_set_id = $auth1
27955 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27956 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27957 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27961 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27962 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27963 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27966 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27967 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27968 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27972 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27973 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27974 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27975 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27976 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27977 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27978 send the message to the current server.
27980 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27985 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27987 client_secret = secret
27989 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27990 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27997 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27998 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27999 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28000 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28002 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28003 at A L Digital Ltd.
28005 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28006 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28007 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28008 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28009 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28011 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28012 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28013 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28014 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28016 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28017 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28018 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28019 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28020 depending on the driver you are using.
28022 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28023 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28024 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28025 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28026 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28029 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28030 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28031 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28032 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28033 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28034 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28035 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28036 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28039 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28040 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28041 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28042 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28043 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28044 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28048 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28049 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28050 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28051 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28054 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28055 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28056 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28057 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28061 driver = cyrus_sasl
28062 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28063 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28064 server_set_id = $auth1
28067 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28068 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28071 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28072 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28075 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28076 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28077 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28078 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28081 driver = cyrus_sasl
28082 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28083 server_set_id = $auth1
28086 driver = cyrus_sasl
28087 public_name = PLAIN
28088 server_set_id = $auth2
28090 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28091 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28092 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28093 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28094 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28099 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28100 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28101 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28102 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28103 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28104 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28105 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28106 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28107 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28108 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28109 authenticator only. There is only one option:
28111 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28113 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28114 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28115 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28116 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28120 public_name = PLAIN
28121 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28122 server_set_id = $auth1
28127 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28128 server_set_id = $auth1
28130 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28131 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28132 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28133 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28134 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28135 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28137 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28140 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28145 unix_listener auth-client {
28152 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28154 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28157 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28158 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28163 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28164 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28165 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28166 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28167 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28168 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28169 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28170 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28171 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28172 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28173 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28174 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28175 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28176 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28177 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28178 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28179 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28180 without code changes in Exim.
28182 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28183 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28184 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28188 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28189 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28190 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28194 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28195 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28196 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28197 by &%client_username%& option.
28198 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28199 which is the common case.
28201 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28202 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28204 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28205 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28206 the password to be used, in clear.
28208 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28209 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28210 the account name to be used.
28213 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28215 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28216 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28219 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28220 and correctly sized
28221 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28222 The value after expansion should be
28223 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28224 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28226 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28227 supplied by the server.
28228 The option is expanded before use.
28230 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28231 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28232 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28234 The intent of this option
28235 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28236 to save on recalculation costs.
28237 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28238 (eg. an empty string)
28239 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28241 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28242 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28243 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28244 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28245 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28249 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28250 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28251 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28252 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28253 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28256 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28257 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28258 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28261 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28262 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28263 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28265 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28266 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28267 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28269 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28270 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28271 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28274 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28275 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28276 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28277 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28281 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28282 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28283 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28284 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28287 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28288 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28289 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28290 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28295 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28296 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28297 server_set_id = $auth1
28301 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28302 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28303 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28304 the password itself.
28306 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28307 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28308 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28309 if available, else the empty string.
28310 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28311 else the empty string.
28313 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28315 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28316 option to be simply "true".
28319 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28320 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28321 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28324 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28325 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28326 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28327 when this option is expanded.
28329 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28330 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28331 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28332 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28333 either the iteration count or the salt).
28334 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28335 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28337 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28338 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28339 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28340 when this option is expanded.
28341 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28342 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28343 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28344 protocol conversation.
28347 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28348 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28349 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28350 to provide stored information related to a password,
28351 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28353 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28354 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28356 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28357 When this is so, the macros
28358 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28359 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28362 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28364 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28365 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28366 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28367 &%server_password%& option.
28368 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28370 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28371 to generate these values.
28374 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28375 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28376 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28379 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28380 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28381 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28382 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28384 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28385 meanings for these variables:
28388 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28389 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28391 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28392 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28394 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28395 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28398 On a per-mechanism basis:
28401 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28402 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28403 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28405 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28406 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28407 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28409 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28410 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28411 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28412 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28415 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28416 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28417 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28420 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28421 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28423 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28425 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28426 server_realm = imap.example.org
28427 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28428 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28429 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28430 server_condition = yes
28434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28437 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28438 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28439 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28440 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28441 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28442 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28443 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28446 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28447 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28448 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28449 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28451 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28452 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28453 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28454 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28456 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28457 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28458 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28462 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28463 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28464 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28465 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28467 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28468 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28469 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28470 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28472 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28474 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28475 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28477 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28478 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28479 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28484 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28485 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28487 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28488 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28489 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28490 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28491 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28492 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28493 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28494 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28495 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28496 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28497 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28498 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28499 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28503 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28504 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28506 The server sends back a challenge.
28508 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28509 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28512 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28516 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28517 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28518 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28520 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28521 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28522 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28523 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28524 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28525 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28526 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28527 for other things. For example:
28532 server_password = \
28533 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28535 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28536 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28542 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28543 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28544 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28548 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28549 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28552 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28553 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28556 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28557 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28558 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28564 client_username = msn/msn_username
28565 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28566 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28568 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28569 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
28575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28578 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28579 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28580 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28581 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28582 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28583 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28584 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28585 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28586 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28587 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28588 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28589 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28590 by the server configuration.
28592 The client presents an identity in-clear.
28593 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28594 and for clients to only attempt,
28595 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28597 One possible use, compatible with the
28598 K-9 Mail Android client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28599 is for using X509 client certificates.
28601 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28602 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28603 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28604 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28605 client certificates only.
28607 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28608 client-certificate authentication is being done.
28610 The client must present a certificate,
28611 for which it must have been requested via the
28612 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28613 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28614 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28615 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28617 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28618 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28619 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28621 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28622 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28623 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28624 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28625 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28626 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28627 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28629 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28631 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28632 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28633 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28634 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28635 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28636 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28638 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28639 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28640 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28641 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28642 an identity for authentication and
28643 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28645 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28646 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28647 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28648 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28650 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28651 Once an identity has been received,
28652 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28653 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28654 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28655 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28656 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28657 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28658 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28659 string as the error text.
28663 ext_ccert_san_mail:
28665 public_name = EXTERNAL
28667 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28668 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28669 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28670 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28671 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28672 server_set_id = $auth1
28674 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28675 of your configured trust-anchors
28676 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28677 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28679 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28680 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28681 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28685 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28686 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28687 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28689 .option client_send external string&!! unset
28690 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28691 identity being asserted.
28697 public_name = EXTERNAL
28699 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28700 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28704 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
28705 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
28711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28714 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28715 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28716 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28717 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28718 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28719 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28720 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28721 authentication based on client certificates.
28723 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28724 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28725 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28726 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28727 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28728 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28730 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28731 for which it must have been requested via the
28732 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28733 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28735 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28736 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28737 and can authenticate the connection.
28738 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28740 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28743 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28744 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28746 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28747 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28748 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28749 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28750 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28751 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28753 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28754 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28755 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28757 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28764 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28765 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28766 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28769 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28770 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28771 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28773 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28775 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28776 of your configured trust-anchors
28777 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28778 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28780 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28781 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28782 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28784 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28786 . An alternative might use
28788 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28790 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28791 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28792 . This would help for per-device use.
28794 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28795 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28797 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28798 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28801 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28802 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28803 a connect- or helo-ACL.
28807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28810 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28811 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28812 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28813 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28814 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28817 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28818 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28819 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28820 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28821 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28822 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28823 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28824 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28825 certificates are used.
28827 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28828 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28829 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28830 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28831 between them is encrypted.
28833 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28834 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28835 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28836 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28839 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28840 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28841 in order to get TLS to work.
28845 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28847 .cindex "submissions protocol"
28848 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28849 .cindex "smtps protocol"
28850 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28851 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28852 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28853 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28854 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28855 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28856 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28857 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28859 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28860 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28861 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28863 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28864 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28865 reassigned for other use.
28866 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28868 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28869 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28870 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28872 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28873 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28874 the most common use is expected to be:
28876 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28878 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28879 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28880 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28881 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28882 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28885 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28886 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28893 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28894 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28895 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28896 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28902 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28908 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28909 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28911 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28914 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28915 cannot be the path of a directory
28916 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28917 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28919 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28921 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28922 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28923 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28924 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28925 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28927 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28928 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28929 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28930 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28931 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28932 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28933 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28936 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28937 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28939 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28940 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28941 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28942 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28944 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28945 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28947 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28948 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28949 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28950 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28953 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
28955 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
28960 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28961 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28962 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28963 but not the chosen filename.
28964 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28965 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28967 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28968 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28969 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28970 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28972 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28973 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28974 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28975 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28976 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28977 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28978 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28980 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28981 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28982 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28983 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28984 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28986 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28987 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28988 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28989 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28990 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28991 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28993 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28994 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28995 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28997 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28998 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28999 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29000 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29003 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29006 # chown exim:exim new-params
29007 # chmod 0600 new-params
29008 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29009 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29010 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29011 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29012 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29013 # chmod 0400 new-params
29014 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29016 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29017 stalling is removed.
29019 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29020 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29021 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29022 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29023 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29024 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29025 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29026 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29027 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29028 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29029 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29031 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29032 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29033 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29034 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29036 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29037 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29038 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29039 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29040 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29043 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29044 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29045 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29046 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29047 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29048 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29049 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29050 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29051 directly to this function call.
29052 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29053 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29054 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29055 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29058 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29060 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29061 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29062 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29065 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29066 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29067 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29071 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29074 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29075 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29078 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29079 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29081 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29082 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29085 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29086 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29087 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29088 not be moved to the end of the list.
29091 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29094 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29095 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29098 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29099 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29100 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29101 choice of clients used:
29103 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29104 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29109 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29111 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29114 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29115 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29116 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29117 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29119 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29121 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29125 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29127 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29128 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29129 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29130 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29131 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29132 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29133 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29134 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29135 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29136 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29138 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29139 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29141 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29142 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29143 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29144 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29145 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29146 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29148 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29149 "Priority strings". This is online as
29150 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29151 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29152 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29153 then the example code
29154 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29155 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29159 # Disable older versions of protocols
29160 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29163 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29164 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29165 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29167 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29168 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29169 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29170 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29174 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29180 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29181 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29182 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29183 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29184 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29185 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29186 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29187 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29189 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29190 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29192 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29193 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29194 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29197 554 Security failure
29199 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29200 rejected with a 554 error code.
29202 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29203 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29205 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29206 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29207 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29208 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29210 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29212 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29214 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29215 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29217 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29218 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29219 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29220 that goes with it. These files need to be
29221 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29222 always be given as full path names.
29223 The key must not be password-protected.
29224 They can be the same file if both the
29225 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29226 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29227 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29228 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29229 the server's certificate.
29231 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29232 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29233 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29234 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29235 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29236 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29238 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29239 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29240 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29242 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29243 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29244 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29247 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29248 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29249 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29251 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29253 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29254 with the parameters contained in the file.
29255 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29260 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29261 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29262 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29263 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29269 for a way of generating file data.
29271 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29272 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29273 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29274 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29275 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29277 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29278 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29279 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29280 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29281 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29282 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29283 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29284 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29285 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29287 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29288 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29289 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29290 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29291 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29292 documentation for more details.
29294 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29295 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29298 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
29299 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29300 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29301 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29302 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29303 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29304 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29305 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29306 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29307 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29308 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29309 an explicit file or,
29310 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29311 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29313 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29316 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29317 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29318 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29320 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29322 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29324 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29325 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29327 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29328 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29329 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29330 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29331 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29332 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29333 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29334 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29335 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29336 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29338 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29339 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29340 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29341 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29343 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29344 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29345 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29346 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29347 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29348 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29351 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
29352 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
29353 .cindex "revocation list"
29354 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
29355 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
29356 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
29357 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
29358 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
29359 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
29360 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
29362 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
29363 file from every certificate authority they know of.
29365 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
29366 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
29367 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
29368 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
29369 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
29370 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
29372 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
29373 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
29374 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
29375 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
29377 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
29378 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
29379 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
29380 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
29381 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
29382 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
29383 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
29384 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
29386 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
29387 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
29388 support for OCSP stapling is included.
29390 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
29391 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
29392 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
29393 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
29394 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
29396 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
29397 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
29398 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
29399 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
29400 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
29403 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
29404 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
29407 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
29408 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
29409 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
29410 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
29411 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
29412 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
29414 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
29415 not any of the chain from CA to it.
29417 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
29420 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
29421 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
29422 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
29424 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
29425 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
29426 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
29431 .section "Caching of static server configuration items" "SECTserverTLScache"
29432 .cindex certificate caching
29433 .cindex privatekey caching
29434 .cindex crl caching
29435 .cindex ocsp caching
29436 .cindex ciphers caching
29437 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29438 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29439 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29440 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29441 .cindex tls_crl caching
29442 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
29443 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29444 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29445 .cindex caching certificate
29446 .cindex caching privatekey
29447 .cindex caching crl
29448 .cindex caching ocsp
29449 .cindex caching ciphers
29450 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29451 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
29452 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
29453 expandable elements,
29454 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
29455 It is made available
29456 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
29458 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
29460 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
29461 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
29462 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29464 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29465 containing files specified by these options.
29467 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29468 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29469 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29470 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
29471 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29472 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29473 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29474 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29476 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29477 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executavble.
29479 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29480 save siginificant time and processing on every TLS connection
29487 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29488 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29489 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29490 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29491 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29492 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29493 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29494 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29495 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29497 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29498 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29499 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29500 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29501 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29502 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29504 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29505 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29506 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29507 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29508 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29511 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29512 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29513 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29514 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29515 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29516 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29517 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29518 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29519 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29520 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29523 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29524 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29526 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
29528 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29529 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29531 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29532 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29533 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29534 in failed connections.
29536 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29537 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29539 the system default set (depending on library version),
29541 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29542 The client verifies the server's certificate
29543 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29544 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29545 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29546 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29548 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29549 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29550 or need not succeed respectively.
29552 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29553 name checks are made on the server certificate.
29555 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
29556 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
29557 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
29558 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
29559 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
29561 The option defaults to always checking.
29563 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29564 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29565 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29567 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29568 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29569 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29572 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29573 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29574 for OCSP to be relevant.
29577 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29578 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29579 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29580 alternative hosts, if any.
29583 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29584 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29585 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29589 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29590 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29591 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29592 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29593 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29595 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29596 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29597 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29598 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29599 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29600 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29601 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29602 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29603 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29604 outgoing connection.
29609 .section "Caching of static client configuration items" "SECTclientTLScache"
29610 .cindex certificate caching
29611 .cindex privatekey caching
29612 .cindex crl caching
29613 .cindex ciphers caching
29614 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29615 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29616 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29617 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29618 .cindex tls_crl caching
29619 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29620 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29621 .cindex caching certificate
29622 .cindex caching privatekey
29623 .cindex caching crl
29624 .cindex caching ciphers
29625 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29626 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
29627 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
29628 expandable elements,
29629 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
29630 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
29631 command-line specified message delivery.
29632 It is made available
29633 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
29635 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
29637 If caching is not possible, the load
29638 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29640 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
29641 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29642 containing files specified by these options.
29644 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29645 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29646 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29647 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
29648 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29649 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29650 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29651 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29653 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29654 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executavble.
29656 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29657 save siginificant time and processing on every TLS connection
29664 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29665 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29668 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29669 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29670 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29671 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29672 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29673 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29674 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29675 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29678 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29679 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29682 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29683 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29684 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29685 be of limited use in that environment.
29687 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29688 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29689 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29690 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29691 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29693 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29694 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29695 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29696 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29697 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29700 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
29701 is forced to the domain part of the recipient address.
29704 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29705 received from a client.
29706 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29708 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29709 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29710 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29713 &%tls_certificate%&
29719 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29724 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29725 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29726 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29727 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29728 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29729 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29730 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29732 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29735 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29736 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29737 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29738 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29740 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
29741 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29742 built, then you have SNI support).
29746 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
29748 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
29749 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
29750 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
29751 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
29752 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
29753 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
29754 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
29755 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
29756 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
29757 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
29759 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
29760 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
29761 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
29762 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
29763 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
29764 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
29765 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
29767 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
29768 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
29769 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
29770 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
29771 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
29772 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
29773 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
29774 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
29775 and delay other deliveries to that host.
29777 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
29778 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
29779 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
29780 information is recorded.
29782 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
29783 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
29784 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
29789 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
29790 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
29791 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29792 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29793 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29794 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29796 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29797 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29798 document is currently at
29800 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29802 and their FAQ is at
29804 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29807 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
29808 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29810 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29811 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29812 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29813 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29816 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
29817 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29818 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29819 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29820 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29821 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29822 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29823 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29824 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29825 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29826 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29827 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29828 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29830 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29831 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29832 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29833 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29837 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
29838 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29839 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29840 with OpenSSL, like this:
29841 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29842 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29844 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29847 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29848 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29849 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29850 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29851 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29852 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29853 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29855 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29856 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29857 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29858 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29859 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29860 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29862 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29863 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29864 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29865 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29866 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29867 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29868 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29869 be a sensible resolution).
29871 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29872 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29873 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29875 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29876 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29877 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29878 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29879 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29880 signed with that self-signed certificate.
29882 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29883 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29884 Open-source PKI book, available online at
29885 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29886 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
29887 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
29891 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
29892 .cindex TLS resumption
29893 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
29894 in RFC 5077 for 1.2). The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1
29897 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
29898 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
29899 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
29900 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
29901 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
29904 Operational cost/benefit:
29906 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
29907 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
29909 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
29910 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
29911 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
29912 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
29913 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
29914 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
29917 .cindex "hints database" tls
29918 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
29919 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
29924 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
29925 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
29926 all connections using the resumed session.
29927 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
29928 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
29929 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
29930 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
29931 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
29933 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
29934 used for session negotiation.
29939 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
29942 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
29943 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
29944 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
29945 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
29946 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
29951 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
29952 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
29953 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
29954 Commonly this can be done like this:
29956 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
29958 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
29959 is offered and/or accepted.
29961 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
29962 equivalent function for operation as a client.
29963 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
29964 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
29965 stored (if supplied by the peer).
29971 In a resumed session:
29973 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
29974 to the original (under GnuTLS).
29976 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
29977 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
29978 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
29985 .section DANE "SECDANE"
29987 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
29988 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
29989 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
29990 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
29991 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
29992 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
29994 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29995 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29996 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29998 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29999 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30001 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30002 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30003 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30005 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30006 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30007 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30009 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30010 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30012 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30013 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30014 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30015 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30017 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30018 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30019 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30020 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30022 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30023 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30024 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30025 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30026 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30027 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30029 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30030 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30031 does require careful arrangement.
30032 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30033 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30034 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30035 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30036 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30038 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30039 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30041 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30042 "MTA-STS", described below.
30044 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30045 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30046 connections to you.
30047 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30048 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30049 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30050 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30051 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30052 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30054 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30055 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30056 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30057 random serial numbers.
30058 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30059 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30060 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30061 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30063 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30064 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30066 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30069 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30070 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30075 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30077 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30080 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30083 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30084 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30087 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30089 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30090 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30091 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30092 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30094 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30095 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30097 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30098 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30099 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30102 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30103 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30107 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30108 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30109 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30110 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30111 control the OCSP request.
30113 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30114 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30117 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30118 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30119 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30120 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30121 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30123 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30125 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30126 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30127 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30128 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30130 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30131 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30132 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30133 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30134 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30135 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30136 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30138 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30142 tls_try_verify_hosts
30143 tls_verify_certificates
30145 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30149 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30150 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30152 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30153 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30155 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30157 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30158 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30159 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30160 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30162 .cindex DANE reporting
30163 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30164 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30165 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30166 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30167 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30168 Section 4.3 of that document.
30170 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30172 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
30173 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30174 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
30175 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
30176 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
30177 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30178 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30179 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30182 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30183 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30184 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30186 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30187 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30188 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30189 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30190 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30191 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30192 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30196 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30197 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30199 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30200 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30201 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30202 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30203 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30204 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30205 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30206 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30207 one very small ACL:
30211 accept hosts = one.host.only
30213 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30214 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30216 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30217 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30218 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30219 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30220 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30221 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30222 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30223 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30226 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30227 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30228 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30231 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30232 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30233 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30234 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30235 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30236 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30237 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30238 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30239 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30240 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30241 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30242 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30243 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30244 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30245 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30246 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30247 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30248 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30249 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30250 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30253 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30254 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30255 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30256 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30257 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30258 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30259 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30260 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30261 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30262 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30263 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30264 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
30265 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
30266 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
30267 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
30268 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
30269 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
30270 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
30271 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
30272 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
30275 For example, if you set
30277 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
30279 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
30280 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
30281 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
30282 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
30283 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
30284 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
30285 testing as possible at RCPT time.
30288 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
30289 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30290 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
30291 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
30292 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
30293 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
30294 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
30295 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
30296 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
30297 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
30298 in any of these ACLs.
30300 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
30301 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
30302 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
30303 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
30304 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
30305 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
30306 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
30307 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
30309 control = suppress_local_fixups
30311 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
30312 run, it is too late.
30314 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30315 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30317 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
30318 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
30319 temporary error for these kinds of message.
30322 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
30323 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30324 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
30325 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
30326 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
30327 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
30328 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
30329 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
30330 &%smtp_banner%& option.
30333 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
30334 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30335 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30336 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
30337 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
30338 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
30339 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
30340 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
30341 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
30343 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
30344 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
30345 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
30347 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
30348 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
30349 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
30350 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
30354 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
30355 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30356 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
30357 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
30358 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
30359 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
30360 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
30361 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
30362 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
30363 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
30365 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
30366 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
30367 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
30368 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
30369 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
30370 associated with the DATA command.
30372 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
30373 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
30374 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
30375 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
30376 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
30377 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
30378 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
30379 the data specified is received.
30381 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
30382 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
30383 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
30384 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
30385 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
30388 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
30389 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
30390 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
30391 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
30393 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
30394 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
30395 enabled (which is the default).
30397 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
30398 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
30399 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
30401 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30403 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30406 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
30407 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30408 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30410 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30413 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
30414 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30415 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
30416 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30417 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
30418 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
30419 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
30422 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
30423 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
30424 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
30425 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
30426 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
30427 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
30428 for some or all recipients.
30430 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
30431 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
30432 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
30433 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
30434 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
30436 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
30437 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
30438 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
30440 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
30441 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
30443 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30444 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
30445 the feature was not requested by the client.
30447 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
30448 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30449 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
30450 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
30451 does not in fact control any access.
30452 For this reason, it may only accept
30453 or warn as its final result.
30455 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
30456 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
30457 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
30458 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
30460 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
30461 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
30463 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
30464 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
30467 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
30468 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
30469 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
30470 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
30471 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
30474 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
30475 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
30476 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
30477 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
30478 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
30479 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
30480 situation even worse.
30482 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
30483 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
30484 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
30487 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
30488 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
30489 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
30490 connection. The possible values are:
30492 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
30493 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
30494 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
30495 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
30496 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
30497 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
30498 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
30499 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
30500 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
30501 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
30503 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
30504 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
30505 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
30506 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
30507 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
30511 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
30512 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
30513 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
30514 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
30516 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
30517 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
30519 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
30520 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
30521 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
30522 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
30523 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
30525 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
30526 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
30527 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
30530 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
30531 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
30532 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
30533 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
30534 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
30535 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
30537 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
30538 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
30539 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
30541 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
30542 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
30543 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
30544 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
30546 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
30547 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
30548 matches the string.
30550 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
30551 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
30552 want to have something like
30554 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
30556 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
30557 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
30563 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
30564 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
30565 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
30566 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
30567 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
30568 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
30569 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
30570 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
30571 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
30573 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
30574 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
30575 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
30578 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
30579 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
30580 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
30581 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
30583 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
30584 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
30585 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
30586 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
30587 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
30588 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
30589 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
30591 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
30592 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
30595 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
30596 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
30597 recipients; it may create new recipients.
30601 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
30602 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
30603 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
30604 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
30605 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
30606 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
30608 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
30609 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
30610 used to accept or reject anything.
30612 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
30613 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
30614 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
30615 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
30617 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
30618 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
30619 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
30620 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
30621 configuration file.
30626 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
30627 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
30629 .vindex &$local_part$&
30630 .vindex &$sender_address$&
30631 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
30632 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30633 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
30634 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
30635 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
30636 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
30637 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
30638 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30640 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
30641 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
30642 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
30645 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
30646 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
30647 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
30648 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
30649 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
30652 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
30653 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
30654 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
30655 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
30656 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
30657 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
30658 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
30659 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
30665 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
30666 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
30667 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
30668 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30669 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
30670 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
30671 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30672 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
30673 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
30674 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
30675 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
30676 unencrypted connections.
30679 accept encrypted = *
30680 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
30682 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
30684 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
30685 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
30686 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
30687 option to do this.)
30691 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
30692 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
30693 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
30694 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
30695 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
30696 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
30697 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
30699 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
30700 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
30701 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
30704 deny dnslists = list1.example
30705 dnslists = list2.example
30707 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
30708 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
30709 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
30710 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
30711 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
30714 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
30715 The ACL verbs are as follows:
30718 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
30719 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
30720 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
30721 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
30722 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
30723 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
30724 check a RCPT command:
30726 accept domains = +local_domains
30730 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
30731 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
30732 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
30733 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
30736 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
30737 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
30738 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
30741 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
30742 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
30743 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
30744 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
30745 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
30746 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
30748 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
30749 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
30751 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
30752 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
30753 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
30755 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
30756 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
30757 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
30762 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
30763 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
30764 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
30765 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
30766 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
30767 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
30768 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
30772 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
30773 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
30774 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
30777 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30779 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
30783 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
30784 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
30785 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
30786 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
30787 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
30788 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
30789 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
30790 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
30791 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
30793 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
30794 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
30795 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
30799 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
30800 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
30801 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
30803 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
30804 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
30806 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
30807 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
30810 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
30811 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
30812 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
30813 example, when checking a RCPT command,
30815 require message = Sender did not verify
30818 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
30819 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
30820 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
30821 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
30824 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30825 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
30826 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
30827 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
30828 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
30829 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
30830 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
30832 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
30833 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
30834 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
30835 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
30836 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30838 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
30839 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
30840 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
30841 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
30842 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
30843 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
30847 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30848 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
30849 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
30850 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
30852 warn !verify = sender
30853 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
30857 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
30859 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
30860 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
30861 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
30862 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
30863 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
30867 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
30868 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
30869 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
30870 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
30871 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
30872 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
30873 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
30874 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
30875 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
30876 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
30878 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
30879 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
30880 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
30881 on the same SMTP connection.
30883 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
30884 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
30885 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
30888 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
30889 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
30890 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
30892 accept hosts = whatever
30893 set acl_m4 = some value
30894 accept authenticated = *
30895 set acl_c_auth = yes
30897 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
30898 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
30899 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
30901 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
30902 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
30903 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
30904 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
30905 error is generated.
30907 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
30908 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
30911 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
30912 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
30913 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
30914 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
30916 deny domains = *.dom.example
30917 !verify = recipient
30919 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
30920 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
30921 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
30922 two statements are equivalent:
30924 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
30925 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
30927 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
30928 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
30930 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
30931 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
30932 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
30934 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30935 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
30936 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30937 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
30939 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
30940 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
30941 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
30942 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
30943 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
30944 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
30945 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
30947 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
30948 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
30949 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
30950 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
30951 message is handled.
30953 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
30954 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
30955 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
30956 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
30958 require message = Can't verify sender
30960 message = Can't verify recipient
30962 message = This message cannot be used
30964 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
30965 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
30966 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
30967 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
30968 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
30969 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
30971 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
30972 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
30973 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
30974 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
30977 !senders = *@my.domain.example
30978 message = Invalid sender from client host
30980 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
30981 by which time Exim has set up the message.
30985 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
30986 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
30987 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
30990 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30991 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
30992 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
30993 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30995 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30996 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30997 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30998 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30999 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31000 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31001 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31002 write rather ugly lines like this:
31004 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31006 Instead, all you need is
31008 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31011 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31012 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31013 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31014 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31015 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31016 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31017 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31018 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31020 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31021 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31022 in several different ways. For example:
31024 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31025 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31026 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31030 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31032 accept ...some conditions
31035 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31036 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31039 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31041 accept ...some conditions...
31043 ...some more conditions...
31045 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31046 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31047 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31051 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31052 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31055 warn ...some conditions...
31059 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31060 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31064 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31065 &%require%& verb. For example:
31067 require control = no_multiline_responses
31071 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31072 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31074 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31075 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31076 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31077 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31078 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31079 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31081 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31084 deny ...some conditions...
31087 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31088 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31091 ...some conditions...
31093 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31094 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31096 warn ...some conditions...
31102 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31103 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31104 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31105 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31106 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31107 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31108 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31112 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31113 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31114 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31115 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31116 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31117 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31118 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31121 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31122 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31123 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31124 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31126 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31127 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31129 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31132 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31133 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31135 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31136 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31137 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31140 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31141 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31142 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31143 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31144 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31145 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31148 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31149 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31150 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31153 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31154 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31155 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31156 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31157 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31158 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31160 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31161 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31162 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31163 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31164 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31165 logging rejections.
31168 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31169 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31170 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31171 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31172 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31173 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31174 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31175 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31177 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31178 &` log_reject_target =`&
31180 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31181 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31185 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31186 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31187 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
31188 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
31189 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
31190 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
31191 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
31194 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
31195 &` control = freeze`&
31196 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
31198 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
31199 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
31200 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
31203 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
31204 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
31208 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31209 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
31210 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
31211 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
31212 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
31213 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
31214 &%accept%& for details.)
31216 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
31217 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
31218 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
31219 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
31220 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
31222 require message = Host not recognized
31225 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
31228 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
31229 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
31230 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
31231 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
31232 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
31233 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
31234 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
31235 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
31236 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
31239 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
31240 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
31241 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
31243 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
31244 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
31246 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
31247 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
31248 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
31251 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
31252 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
31254 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
31255 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
31256 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
31259 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31260 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
31261 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
31263 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
31264 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
31265 However, the original message is available in the variable
31266 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
31267 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
31268 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
31269 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
31271 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
31272 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
31273 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
31274 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
31275 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
31276 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
31280 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31281 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
31282 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
31283 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
31285 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
31287 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
31288 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
31289 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
31290 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
31293 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31294 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
31295 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
31296 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
31299 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
31300 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
31301 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
31302 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
31305 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
31306 .cindex "UDP communications"
31307 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
31308 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
31309 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
31310 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
31311 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
31312 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
31313 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
31316 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
31317 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
31324 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
31325 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31326 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
31329 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
31330 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
31331 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
31332 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
31333 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
31334 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
31335 not work without it. For example:
31337 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
31338 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
31340 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
31341 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
31342 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
31343 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
31344 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
31347 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
31348 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
31349 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
31350 .cindex "case of local parts"
31351 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31352 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
31353 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
31354 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
31355 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
31356 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
31359 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
31360 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
31361 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
31362 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
31363 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
31365 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
31366 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
31369 warn control = caseful_local_part
31370 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
31372 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
31374 control = caselower_local_part
31376 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
31377 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
31380 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
31381 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
31382 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
31383 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
31385 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
31386 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
31387 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
31388 is used for all recipients of the message,
31389 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
31390 and data is copied from one to the other.
31392 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
31393 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
31394 If a recipient-verify callout
31396 connection is subsequently
31397 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
31398 any subsequent recipients and the data,
31399 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
31401 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
31402 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
31403 Note also that headers cannot be
31404 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
31405 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
31406 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
31407 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
31408 this will affect the timestamp.
31410 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
31411 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
31412 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
31413 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
31416 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
31417 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
31418 before the entire message has been received from the source.
31419 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
31423 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
31424 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
31425 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
31426 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
31427 before the acceptance "<=" line.
31429 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
31431 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
31432 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
31433 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
31434 and does not queue the message.
31435 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
31437 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
31439 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
31442 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
31443 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
31444 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
31445 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
31446 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
31447 by default called &'debuglog'&.
31448 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
31449 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
31450 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
31452 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
31453 with the &'kill'& option.
31454 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
31458 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
31459 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
31460 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
31461 control = debug/kill
31465 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
31466 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
31467 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
31468 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
31469 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31472 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
31473 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
31474 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
31475 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
31476 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
31479 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
31480 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
31481 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
31482 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
31483 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
31484 strings or to numeric value.
31485 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
31486 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
31487 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
31489 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
31490 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
31491 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
31492 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
31493 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
31496 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
31497 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
31498 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
31499 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
31500 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
31501 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
31502 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
31503 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
31505 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
31506 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
31507 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
31508 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
31509 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
31510 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
31514 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
31515 .cindex "fake defer"
31516 .cindex "defer, fake"
31517 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
31518 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
31519 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
31520 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
31521 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
31523 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
31524 .cindex "fake rejection"
31525 .cindex "rejection, fake"
31526 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
31527 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
31528 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
31529 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
31530 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31531 the same SMTP connection.
31533 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
31534 message is supplied, the following is used:
31536 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
31537 550-kept for evaluation.
31538 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
31539 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
31541 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
31543 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
31544 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
31545 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31546 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31547 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
31548 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
31551 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
31552 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
31553 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
31554 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
31556 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
31557 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
31558 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
31559 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31560 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
31561 disables such output flushing.
31563 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
31564 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31565 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
31566 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31567 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
31568 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
31570 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
31571 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
31572 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
31573 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
31574 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
31575 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
31576 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31577 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
31578 to be useful in production.
31580 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
31581 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
31582 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
31583 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
31584 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
31586 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
31587 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
31588 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
31589 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
31590 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
31591 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
31594 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
31595 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
31596 verification failed"&) is sent.
31598 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
31602 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
31603 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
31605 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
31606 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
31607 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
31608 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
31609 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
31610 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
31611 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
31612 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
31614 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
31615 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
31616 .oindex "&%queue%&"
31617 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
31618 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
31619 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
31620 .cindex "first pass routing"
31621 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31622 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31623 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
31625 If used with no options set,
31626 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
31627 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
31629 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
31630 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
31631 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
31632 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
31633 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
31634 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
31636 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
31637 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31639 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
31640 .cindex "message" "submission"
31641 .cindex "submission mode"
31642 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
31643 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
31644 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
31645 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
31646 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
31647 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
31648 late (the message has already been created).
31650 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
31651 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
31652 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
31653 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
31654 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31656 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
31657 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
31658 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
31659 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
31660 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
31663 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
31664 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
31666 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
31668 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
31671 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
31672 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
31673 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31674 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
31677 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
31678 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
31680 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
31681 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
31683 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
31687 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
31688 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
31691 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
31693 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
31694 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
31696 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
31698 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
31703 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
31704 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
31705 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
31706 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
31707 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
31708 to an incoming message, as in this example:
31710 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31711 dialup.mail-abuse.org
31712 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
31714 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31715 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31716 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31717 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
31718 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
31721 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
31722 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31724 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
31725 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
31726 contains one or more newlines that
31727 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
31728 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
31729 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
31731 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31732 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31733 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
31734 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
31735 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
31736 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
31737 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
31738 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
31739 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
31740 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
31741 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
31743 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
31744 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
31746 until they are added to the
31747 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
31748 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
31749 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
31750 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
31751 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
31752 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
31753 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31755 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
31757 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31758 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31760 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31761 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
31763 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31764 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31766 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
31767 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
31768 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
31769 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
31772 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31773 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
31774 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
31775 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
31776 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
31777 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
31778 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
31781 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
31782 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
31783 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
31784 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
31785 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
31787 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
31788 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
31789 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
31790 to be a header name first.) For example:
31792 warn add_header = \
31793 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
31795 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
31796 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
31797 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
31798 up in reverse order.
31800 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31801 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
31802 system filter or in a router or transport.
31806 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
31807 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
31808 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
31809 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
31810 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
31811 from an incoming message, as in this example:
31813 warn message = Remove internal headers
31814 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31816 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31817 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31818 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31819 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
31820 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
31821 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
31823 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
31824 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31826 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
31827 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
31828 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
31829 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
31830 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
31832 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
31833 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31834 warn message = Remove internal headers
31835 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
31837 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31838 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31839 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
31840 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
31841 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
31842 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
31843 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
31844 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
31845 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
31846 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
31847 would have been removed.
31849 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
31850 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
31851 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
31852 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
31853 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
31854 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
31855 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
31856 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
31857 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31859 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31860 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31862 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
31863 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
31865 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31866 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
31868 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
31869 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
31870 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
31871 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
31874 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31875 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
31876 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
31881 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
31882 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
31883 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
31884 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
31885 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
31886 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31888 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
31889 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
31890 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
31891 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
31892 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
31893 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
31894 The conditions are as follows:
31898 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
31899 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
31900 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
31901 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
31902 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
31903 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
31904 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
31905 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
31906 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
31907 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
31908 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
31909 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
31911 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
31912 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
31913 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
31914 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
31915 The name and values are expanded separately.
31916 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
31917 will act as argument separators.
31919 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
31920 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
31921 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
31922 conditions are tested.
31924 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
31925 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
31926 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
31927 for different local users or different local domains.
31929 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31930 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
31931 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
31932 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
31933 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
31934 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
31935 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
31940 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
31941 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
31942 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
31943 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
31944 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
31945 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
31946 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
31947 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
31948 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
31949 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
31950 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
31951 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
31954 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
31955 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
31956 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31957 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31958 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
31959 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
31960 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
31961 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31963 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
31964 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
31965 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31966 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31967 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31968 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
31969 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
31970 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
31971 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
31972 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
31974 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31975 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
31976 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
31977 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
31978 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
31979 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
31980 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
31981 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
31982 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
31985 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
31986 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
31989 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31990 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
31991 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
31992 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
31993 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
31994 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
31995 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32001 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32002 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32003 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32004 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32005 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32006 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32007 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32009 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32011 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32012 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32013 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32015 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32016 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32017 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32018 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32019 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32020 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32022 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32023 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32025 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32026 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32028 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32029 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32030 statement can then check the IP address.
32032 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32033 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32034 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32035 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32037 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32038 message = $host_data
32040 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32042 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32043 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32044 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32045 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32046 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32047 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
32048 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32049 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32050 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32051 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32053 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32054 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32055 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32056 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32057 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32058 content-scanning extension
32059 and only after a DATA command.
32060 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32061 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32063 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32064 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32065 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32066 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32067 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32068 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32069 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32072 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32073 .cindex "rate limiting"
32074 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32075 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32077 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32078 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32079 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32080 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32081 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
32082 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32084 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32085 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32086 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32087 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32088 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32089 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32090 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32092 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32093 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32094 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32095 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32096 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32097 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32098 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32099 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32100 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32101 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32102 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
32103 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
32104 influence the sender checking.
32106 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32107 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32109 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32110 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
32111 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32112 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
32113 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
32114 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
32118 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32119 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32121 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
32122 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
32123 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
32124 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32125 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
32126 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32128 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
32129 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32130 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
32131 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
32132 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
32133 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
32134 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
32135 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
32136 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
32137 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
32139 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
32140 .cindex "CSA verification"
32141 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
32142 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
32143 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
32145 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
32146 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32147 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32148 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32149 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
32150 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32152 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32153 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
32154 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
32155 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
32157 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
32158 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
32159 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
32161 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
32162 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32163 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
32164 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
32165 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
32166 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
32167 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32168 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32169 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
32170 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
32171 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
32172 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
32173 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
32174 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
32175 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
32177 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
32178 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
32179 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
32180 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
32183 !verify = header_sender
32184 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
32187 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
32188 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32189 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
32190 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
32191 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
32192 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32193 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32194 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
32195 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
32196 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
32197 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
32198 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
32199 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
32202 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
32203 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
32207 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
32208 common as they used to be.
32210 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
32211 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32212 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
32213 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
32214 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
32215 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
32216 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
32217 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
32218 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
32219 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
32220 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
32221 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
32222 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
32224 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
32225 option), this condition is always true.
32228 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
32229 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
32230 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
32231 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
32232 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
32233 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
32234 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
32235 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
32236 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
32238 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
32239 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
32241 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
32242 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
32245 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
32246 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32247 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
32248 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
32249 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
32250 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32251 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
32252 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
32253 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
32254 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
32255 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
32256 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
32257 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
32258 value for the child address.
32260 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
32261 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32262 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
32263 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
32264 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
32265 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
32266 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
32267 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
32268 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
32269 original IP address.
32271 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
32272 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
32274 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
32275 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
32277 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
32278 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32279 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
32280 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
32281 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
32282 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
32283 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
32284 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
32285 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
32287 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32288 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
32289 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
32290 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
32291 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
32292 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
32293 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
32295 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
32296 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
32297 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
32299 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
32300 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32301 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
32302 verified as a sender.
32304 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
32305 (eg. is generated from the received message)
32306 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
32308 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
32314 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
32315 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32316 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32317 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32318 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
32319 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
32320 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
32321 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
32322 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
32323 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
32325 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
32326 dialups.mail-abuse.org
32328 the following records are looked up:
32330 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32331 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
32333 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
32334 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
32335 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
32336 use two separate conditions:
32338 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32339 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32341 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
32342 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
32343 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
32346 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
32347 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
32348 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
32349 following special items in the list:
32351 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
32352 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
32353 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
32355 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
32356 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
32357 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
32358 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
32360 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
32362 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
32363 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
32365 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32366 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32367 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
32369 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
32371 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
32372 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
32373 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
32374 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
32375 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
32376 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
32378 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
32379 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
32380 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
32384 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
32385 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
32386 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
32387 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
32388 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
32390 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
32392 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
32393 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
32394 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
32395 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
32400 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
32401 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
32402 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
32403 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
32404 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
32405 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
32406 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
32408 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32409 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
32411 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
32412 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
32413 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
32414 up by this example is
32416 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
32418 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
32419 addresses. For example:
32421 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32422 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32424 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
32425 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
32430 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
32431 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
32432 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
32433 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
32434 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
32435 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
32436 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
32437 either to double the separators like this:
32439 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
32441 or to change the separator character, like this:
32443 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
32445 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
32446 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
32447 occurs. Consider this condition:
32449 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
32451 The DNS lookups that occur are:
32453 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
32454 a.domain.black.list.tld
32456 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
32457 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
32458 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
32459 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
32460 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
32461 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
32462 error for a previous item.
32464 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
32465 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
32467 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
32468 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
32470 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
32471 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
32473 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
32474 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
32475 $sender_address_domain} }} }
32476 message = The mail servers for the domain \
32477 $sender_address_domain \
32478 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
32481 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
32482 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
32483 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
32484 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
32486 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
32488 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
32489 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
32491 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
32492 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
32497 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
32498 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
32499 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
32500 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
32501 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
32502 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
32506 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
32508 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
32509 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
32510 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
32512 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
32513 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
32514 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
32517 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
32518 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
32519 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
32520 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
32524 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
32525 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
32526 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
32527 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
32528 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
32529 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
32530 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
32531 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
32532 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
32533 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
32534 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
32535 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
32536 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
32537 cases, for example:
32539 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
32541 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
32542 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
32543 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
32544 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
32546 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
32548 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
32549 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
32551 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
32552 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
32553 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
32554 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
32555 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
32558 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
32559 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
32560 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
32562 deny hosts = !+local_networks
32563 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
32565 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
32570 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
32571 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
32572 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
32573 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
32576 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
32578 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
32579 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
32580 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
32581 describes how multiple records are handled.
32583 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
32584 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
32585 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
32587 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32589 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
32590 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
32591 first. For example:
32593 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
32594 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
32597 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
32598 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
32599 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
32600 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
32601 tested. For example:
32603 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
32605 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
32606 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
32607 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
32609 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32611 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
32616 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
32617 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
32620 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32622 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32623 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
32625 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32627 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32628 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
32629 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
32630 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
32632 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
32633 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
32635 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
32636 previous example is precisely equivalent to
32638 deny dnslists = a.b.c
32639 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32641 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
32642 Consider this example:
32644 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32646 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
32649 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
32651 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32653 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
32654 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
32655 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
32657 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
32659 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
32660 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
32661 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
32664 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
32670 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
32671 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
32672 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
32673 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
32674 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
32675 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
32677 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
32679 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
32680 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
32681 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
32682 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
32683 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
32684 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
32687 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
32688 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
32689 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32691 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
32692 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
32695 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
32697 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32698 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
32700 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
32702 for the condition to be true.
32705 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
32706 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
32708 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
32709 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
32711 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
32713 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32714 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32716 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
32717 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
32719 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
32721 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32722 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
32724 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32726 for the condition to be false.
32728 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
32729 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
32734 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
32735 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
32736 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
32737 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
32738 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
32739 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
32740 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
32741 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
32742 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
32745 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
32746 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
32747 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
32748 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
32749 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
32750 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
32751 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
32754 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
32755 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32757 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
32758 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
32760 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
32761 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
32762 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
32763 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
32764 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
32765 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
32767 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
32768 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
32769 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
32772 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
32773 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
32774 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
32775 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32777 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
32778 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
32779 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
32783 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
32784 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
32785 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
32786 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
32787 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
32788 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
32790 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
32791 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32793 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
32794 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
32795 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
32797 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
32799 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
32800 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
32802 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
32803 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
32805 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
32806 dnslists = some.list.example
32809 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
32810 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
32811 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
32813 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
32816 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
32817 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
32818 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
32819 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
32820 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
32821 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
32822 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
32823 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
32824 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
32825 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
32827 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
32829 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
32830 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
32832 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
32833 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
32834 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
32837 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
32838 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
32839 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
32840 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
32841 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
32842 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
32843 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
32844 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
32845 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
32847 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
32848 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
32849 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
32850 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
32852 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
32853 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
32854 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
32855 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
32856 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
32857 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
32858 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
32859 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
32860 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
32861 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
32863 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
32864 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
32865 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
32868 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
32869 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
32870 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
32871 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
32872 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
32873 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
32875 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
32876 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
32877 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
32878 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
32879 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
32880 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
32881 the &%count=%& option.
32884 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
32885 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
32886 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
32887 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
32888 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
32890 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
32891 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
32892 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
32893 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32895 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
32896 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
32897 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
32898 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
32899 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
32900 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
32901 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
32903 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
32904 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32905 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
32906 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
32907 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
32908 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
32909 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
32911 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
32912 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
32913 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
32914 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
32917 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
32918 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
32919 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
32920 multiple different commands.
32922 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
32923 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
32924 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
32925 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
32926 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
32928 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
32931 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
32932 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
32933 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
32934 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
32935 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
32937 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
32938 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
32940 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
32941 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
32942 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
32943 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
32947 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
32948 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32949 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32952 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
32953 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32954 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32957 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
32958 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
32959 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
32960 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
32961 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
32962 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
32965 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
32966 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
32967 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
32968 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
32969 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
32972 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
32973 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
32974 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
32975 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
32976 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
32977 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
32980 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
32981 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
32982 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
32983 up to the given limit.
32984 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
32985 consists of refusing the message, and
32986 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
32987 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
32988 likely not what is wanted.
32990 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
32991 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
32992 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
32993 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
32994 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
32995 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
32996 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
32997 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
32999 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33003 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
33004 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33005 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33006 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33007 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33008 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33009 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33010 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33011 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33013 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33014 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33015 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33016 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33017 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33018 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33020 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33021 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33024 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33025 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33026 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33027 required increases with larger limits.
33029 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
33030 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
33031 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
33032 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
33033 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
33034 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
33035 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
33036 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
33037 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
33041 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
33042 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
33043 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
33044 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
33045 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
33046 message. For example:
33048 # Log all senders' rates
33049 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
33050 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
33052 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
33053 # at the decimal point.
33054 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
33055 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
33056 $sender_rate_limit }s
33058 # Keep authenticated users under control
33059 deny authenticated = *
33060 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
33062 # System-wide rate limit
33063 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
33064 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
33066 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
33067 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
33068 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
33069 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
33070 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
33071 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
33072 messages per $sender_rate_period
33074 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
33075 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
33076 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
33077 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
33078 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
33079 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
33080 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
33084 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
33085 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
33086 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
33087 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
33088 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
33089 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
33090 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
33091 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
33092 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
33094 verify = sender/callout
33095 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
33097 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
33098 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
33099 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
33100 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
33101 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
33102 The available options are as follows:
33105 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
33106 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
33107 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
33109 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
33110 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
33111 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
33112 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
33114 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
33115 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
33117 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
33118 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
33119 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
33120 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
33123 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
33124 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
33125 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
33126 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
33127 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
33128 not already exceeded (otherwise).
33132 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
33133 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
33134 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
33135 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
33136 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
33137 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
33140 warn !verify = sender
33141 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
33143 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
33144 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
33145 verification failure.
33147 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
33148 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
33151 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
33152 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
33154 &%route%&: Routing failed.
33156 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
33157 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
33158 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
33160 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
33162 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
33165 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
33168 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
33169 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
33171 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
33172 address verification to:
33175 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
33181 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
33182 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
33183 .cindex "callout" "verification"
33184 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
33185 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
33186 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
33187 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
33188 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
33189 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
33190 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
33191 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
33192 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
33195 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
33196 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
33197 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
33198 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
33199 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
33200 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
33202 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
33203 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
33204 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
33205 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
33206 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
33208 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
33209 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
33210 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
33211 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
33212 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
33213 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
33214 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
33215 supplies a host list.
33216 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
33218 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
33219 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
33220 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
33221 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
33222 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
33223 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
33224 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
33226 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
33227 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
33228 following SMTP commands are sent:
33230 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
33232 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
33235 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
33238 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
33241 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
33242 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
33243 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
33244 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
33245 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
33246 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
33248 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
33249 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
33250 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
33251 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
33252 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
33254 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
33255 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
33256 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
33257 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
33258 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
33263 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
33264 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
33265 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
33266 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
33268 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
33270 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
33271 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
33272 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
33276 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
33277 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
33278 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
33281 verify = sender/callout=5s
33283 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
33284 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
33285 the &%connect%& parameter.
33288 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33289 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
33290 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
33291 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
33293 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
33295 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
33297 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
33298 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
33299 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
33300 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
33301 updated in this circumstance.
33303 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
33304 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
33305 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
33306 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
33307 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
33308 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
33311 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33312 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
33313 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
33314 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
33315 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
33316 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
33317 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
33318 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
33319 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
33320 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
33322 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
33324 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
33327 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33328 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
33329 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
33332 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
33334 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
33335 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
33336 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
33337 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
33338 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
33341 .vitem &*no_cache*&
33342 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
33343 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
33344 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
33346 .vitem &*postmaster*&
33347 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
33348 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
33349 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
33350 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
33351 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
33352 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
33353 made, until the cache record expires.
33355 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33356 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
33357 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
33360 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
33362 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
33363 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
33365 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
33367 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
33368 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
33369 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
33370 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
33374 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
33375 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
33376 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
33377 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
33378 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
33380 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
33382 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
33383 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
33384 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
33385 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
33386 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
33388 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
33389 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
33390 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33392 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
33394 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33395 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
33396 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
33397 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
33398 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
33400 .vitem &*use_sender*&
33401 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33403 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
33405 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
33406 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
33407 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
33408 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
33409 usefulness of callout caching.
33412 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33414 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
33416 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
33417 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
33418 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
33419 when that is used for the connections.
33420 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
33421 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
33422 if the use_sender option is used,
33423 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
33424 and if no other callouts intervene.
33427 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
33428 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
33429 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
33430 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
33431 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
33432 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
33433 these circumstances.
33435 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
33436 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
33437 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
33438 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
33439 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
33440 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
33441 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
33443 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
33444 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
33445 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
33446 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
33451 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
33452 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
33453 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
33454 .cindex "caching" "callout"
33455 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
33456 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
33457 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
33458 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
33459 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
33460 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
33462 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
33463 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
33466 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
33467 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
33468 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
33470 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
33471 commands up to and including
33475 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
33476 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
33477 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
33478 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
33479 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
33480 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
33481 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
33483 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
33484 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
33485 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
33486 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
33487 will eventually be noticed.
33489 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
33490 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
33491 behaviour will be the same.
33496 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
33497 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
33498 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
33499 .cindex "caching" "quota"
33500 Exim caches the results of quota verification
33501 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
33502 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
33504 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
33505 and one hour for a negative result.
33506 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
33507 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
33510 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
33512 Possible parameters are:
33514 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33515 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
33516 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
33517 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
33519 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33520 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
33521 As above, for a negative entry.
33523 .vitem &*no_cache*&
33524 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
33527 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
33528 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
33529 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
33530 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
33531 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
33532 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
33535 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
33537 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
33538 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
33539 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
33540 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
33541 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
33542 550 Sender verification failed
33544 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
33545 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
33546 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
33547 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
33550 verify = sender/no_details
33553 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
33554 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
33555 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
33556 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
33557 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
33558 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
33559 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
33562 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
33563 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
33564 verification also fails.
33566 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
33567 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
33570 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
33571 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
33572 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
33575 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
33577 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
33578 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
33579 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
33580 verification to succeed.
33582 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
33583 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
33584 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
33585 option. For example:
33587 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
33589 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
33590 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
33592 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
33593 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
33594 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
33595 address and a report is output for each of them.
33599 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
33600 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
33601 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
33602 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
33603 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
33604 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
33605 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
33609 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
33610 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
33611 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
33612 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
33613 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
33614 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
33616 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
33617 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
33618 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
33619 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
33622 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
33624 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
33626 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
33627 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
33629 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
33630 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
33633 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
33634 use for the DNS query. The default is:
33636 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
33638 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
33639 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
33640 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
33641 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
33644 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
33646 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
33647 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
33648 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
33650 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
33651 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
33652 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
33653 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
33654 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
33655 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
33656 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
33657 of legitimate HELO domains.
33659 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
33660 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
33661 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
33662 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
33665 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
33667 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
33668 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
33669 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
33674 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
33675 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
33676 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
33677 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
33678 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
33679 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
33680 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
33681 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
33683 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
33684 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
33685 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
33686 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
33687 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
33688 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
33689 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
33690 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
33692 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
33693 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
33696 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
33697 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
33700 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
33701 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
33704 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
33706 recipients = +batv_senders
33707 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
33709 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
33711 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
33712 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
33713 !condition = $prvscheck_result
33714 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
33716 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
33717 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
33718 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
33719 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
33720 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
33722 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
33723 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
33724 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
33725 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
33726 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
33727 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
33728 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
33730 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
33731 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
33732 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
33733 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
33737 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
33739 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
33740 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
33741 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
33744 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
33747 external_smtp_batv:
33749 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
33750 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
33751 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
33752 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
33755 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
33759 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
33760 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
33761 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
33762 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
33763 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
33764 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
33765 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
33766 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
33767 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
33768 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
33770 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
33771 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
33772 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
33773 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
33774 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
33775 same host is fulfilling both functions,
33777 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
33779 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
33780 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
33781 system to arbitrary domains.
33784 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
33785 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
33786 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
33787 example, suppose you want to do the following:
33790 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
33791 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
33792 &'my.dom2.example'&.
33794 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
33795 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
33797 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
33798 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
33802 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
33804 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
33805 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
33806 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
33808 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
33812 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
33813 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
33815 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
33816 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
33817 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
33818 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
33819 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
33820 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
33821 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
33825 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
33826 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
33827 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
33828 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
33829 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
33834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33837 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
33838 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
33839 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
33840 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
33841 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
33842 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
33845 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
33846 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
33847 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
33848 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
33849 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
33851 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
33852 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
33853 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
33856 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
33857 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
33859 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
33860 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
33861 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
33863 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
33864 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
33866 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
33869 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
33872 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
33873 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
33874 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
33875 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
33876 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
33877 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
33879 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
33880 temporarily created in a file called:
33882 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
33884 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
33885 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
33886 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
33887 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
33888 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
33890 control = no_mbox_unspool
33892 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
33893 same directory by default.
33897 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
33898 .cindex "virus scanning"
33899 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
33900 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
33901 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
33902 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
33903 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
33904 in memory and thus are much faster.
33906 Since message data needs to have arrived,
33907 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
33909 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
33910 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
33913 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
33914 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
33916 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
33917 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
33918 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
33919 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
33921 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
33923 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
33925 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
33927 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
33929 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
33930 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
33931 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
33935 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
33936 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
33937 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
33938 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
33939 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
33940 This scanner type takes one option,
33941 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33942 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33943 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33944 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33945 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
33946 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
33947 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
33949 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
33950 If &`pass_unscanned`&
33951 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
33952 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
33957 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33958 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33959 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
33961 If you omit the argument, the default path
33962 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
33964 If you use a remote host,
33965 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
33966 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
33967 For information about available commands and their options you may use
33969 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
33975 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
33976 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
33977 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
33979 .vitem &%aveserver%&
33980 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33981 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
33982 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
33983 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
33986 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
33991 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
33992 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
33993 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
33994 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
33995 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
33997 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
33998 a UNIX socket specification,
33999 a TCP socket specification,
34000 or a (global) option.
34002 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34003 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34004 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34005 and the second a port number,
34006 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34007 These per-server options are supported:
34009 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34012 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34013 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34015 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34019 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34020 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34021 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34022 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34023 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
34025 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
34027 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
34028 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
34029 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
34030 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
34032 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
34033 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
34034 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
34035 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
34036 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
34037 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
34038 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
34039 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
34040 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
34042 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
34043 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
34044 (Connection refused)
34047 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
34048 contributing the code for this scanner.
34051 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
34052 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
34053 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
34054 type takes 3 mandatory options:
34057 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
34058 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
34061 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
34062 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
34063 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
34064 the &"trigger"& expression.
34067 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
34068 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
34069 &"name"& expression.
34072 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
34074 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
34076 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
34077 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
34078 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
34079 configuration setting:
34081 av_scanner = cmdline:\
34082 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
34083 found in file:'(.+)'
34086 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
34087 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
34089 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34090 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34091 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34092 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34095 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
34096 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
34098 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
34099 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
34102 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
34103 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
34104 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
34108 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
34110 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
34112 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
34113 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
34114 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
34115 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
34118 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
34120 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
34123 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
34124 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
34125 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
34127 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
34129 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
34130 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
34132 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
34133 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34134 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
34135 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
34136 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
34139 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
34141 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
34144 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
34145 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
34146 though some documentation was available in English.
34147 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
34148 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
34149 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
34151 The only option for this scanner type is
34152 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
34153 provided that mksd has
34154 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
34156 av_scanner = mksd:2
34158 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
34161 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
34162 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
34163 running on the local machine.
34164 There are four options:
34165 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
34166 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
34167 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
34168 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
34169 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
34172 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
34174 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
34175 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
34176 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
34177 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
34178 specify an empty element to get this.
34181 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
34182 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
34183 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
34184 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
34185 client communication. For example:
34187 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
34189 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
34193 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
34194 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
34197 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
34198 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
34199 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
34200 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
34201 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
34202 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
34205 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
34206 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
34207 The first element can then be one of
34210 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
34211 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
34214 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
34215 the condition fails immediately.
34217 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
34218 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
34219 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
34220 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
34221 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
34224 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
34225 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
34226 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
34228 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
34229 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
34232 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
34234 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
34236 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34237 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34238 is set to record the actual address used.
34240 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
34241 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
34242 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
34243 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
34246 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
34247 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
34249 Here is a very simple scanning example:
34252 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34254 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
34256 deny malware = */defer_ok
34257 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34259 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
34260 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
34262 av_scanner = $acl_m0
34264 in the main Exim configuration.
34266 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
34268 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34270 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
34272 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34276 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
34277 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
34278 .cindex "spam scanning"
34279 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
34281 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
34282 score and a report for the message.
34283 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
34285 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
34286 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
34287 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
34289 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
34291 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
34293 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
34294 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
34297 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
34298 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
34299 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
34300 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
34301 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
34302 configuration as follows (example):
34304 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
34306 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
34307 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
34308 iptables firewall, consider setting
34309 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
34310 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
34311 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
34312 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
34316 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
34318 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
34320 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
34323 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
34324 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
34325 filename instead of an address/port pair:
34327 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
34329 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
34330 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
34331 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
34332 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
34334 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
34335 192.168.2.11 783 : \
34338 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
34339 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
34340 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
34343 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
34344 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
34345 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
34346 take care to not double the separator.
34348 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
34349 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
34350 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
34351 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
34353 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
34355 The supported options are:
34357 pri=<priority> Selection priority
34358 weight=<value> Selection bias
34359 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
34360 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34361 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
34362 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
34365 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
34366 higher values being tried first.
34367 The default priority is 1.
34369 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
34370 Within a priority set
34371 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
34372 The default value for selection bias is 1.
34374 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
34375 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
34376 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
34377 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
34379 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
34380 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
34382 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
34383 The default value is two minutes.
34385 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34386 a failed connect is made.
34387 The default is to not retry.
34389 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
34390 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
34391 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
34394 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34395 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34396 is set to record the actual address used.
34398 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
34399 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
34402 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34404 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
34405 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
34406 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
34407 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
34408 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
34411 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
34412 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
34413 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
34414 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
34415 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
34417 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
34418 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
34420 or the use of PRDR,
34421 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
34422 are needed to use this feature.
34424 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
34425 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
34426 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
34429 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
34430 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
34431 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
34434 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
34436 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34439 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
34440 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
34441 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
34442 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
34444 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
34445 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
34447 Except for &$spam_report$&,
34448 these variables are saved with the received message so are
34449 available for use at delivery time.
34452 .vitem &$spam_score$&
34453 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
34454 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
34456 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
34457 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
34458 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
34459 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
34460 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
34462 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
34463 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
34464 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
34465 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
34466 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
34467 spam bar is 50 characters.
34469 .vitem &$spam_report$&
34470 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
34471 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
34472 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
34473 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
34474 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
34475 unencoded in headers.
34477 .vitem &$spam_action$&
34478 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
34479 spam score versus threshold.
34480 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
34484 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
34485 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
34486 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
34488 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
34489 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
34490 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
34491 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
34492 spam condition, like this:
34494 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
34495 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34497 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
34499 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
34502 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
34503 warn spam = nobody:true
34504 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
34505 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
34507 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
34508 # is over threshold
34510 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
34512 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
34513 deny spam = nobody:true
34514 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
34515 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
34520 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
34521 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
34522 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
34523 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
34524 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
34525 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
34526 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
34527 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
34528 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
34529 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
34532 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
34533 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
34534 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
34535 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
34536 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
34537 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
34538 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
34540 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
34541 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
34542 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
34543 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
34544 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
34546 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
34547 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
34548 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
34549 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
34550 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
34553 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
34555 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
34559 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
34561 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
34562 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
34563 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
34564 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
34566 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
34567 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
34568 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
34569 the full path and filename.
34571 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
34572 filename, and the default path is then used.
34574 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
34575 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
34576 a file with its original, proposed filename using
34578 decode = $mime_filename
34580 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
34581 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
34582 automatically unlinked.
34584 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
34585 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
34586 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
34587 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
34588 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
34590 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
34591 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
34592 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
34594 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
34595 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
34596 available in the MIME ACL:
34599 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
34600 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
34601 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
34602 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
34603 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
34604 the detected issue.
34606 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
34607 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
34608 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
34609 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
34610 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
34611 contains the empty string.
34613 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
34614 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
34615 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
34616 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
34622 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
34623 case-insensitively.
34625 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
34626 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
34627 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
34628 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
34629 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
34630 only used for display purposes.
34632 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
34633 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
34634 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
34635 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
34637 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
34638 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
34639 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
34640 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
34642 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
34643 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
34644 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34645 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
34646 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
34647 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
34649 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34650 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34651 This variable contains the normalized content of the
34652 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
34653 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
34655 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
34656 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
34657 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
34658 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
34659 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
34663 application/octet-stream
34667 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
34670 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34671 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34672 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34673 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
34674 containing the decoded data.
34679 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
34680 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
34681 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
34682 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
34683 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
34686 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
34688 found, this variable contains the empty string.
34690 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34691 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34692 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
34693 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
34694 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
34696 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
34697 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
34701 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
34704 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
34705 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
34708 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
34709 and the rest are attachments.
34712 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
34715 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
34716 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
34717 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
34719 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
34720 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
34721 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
34722 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
34725 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
34726 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
34727 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
34728 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
34729 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
34730 want to carry out specific actions on them.
34732 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34733 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34734 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
34735 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
34736 decoding is fully recursive.
34738 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
34739 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
34740 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
34741 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
34742 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
34743 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
34744 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
34745 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
34750 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
34751 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
34752 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
34753 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
34754 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
34756 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
34757 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
34758 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
34759 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
34760 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
34762 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
34763 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
34764 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
34765 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
34766 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
34767 32K characters are checked.
34769 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
34770 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
34771 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
34772 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
34773 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
34775 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
34776 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
34778 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
34779 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
34780 matching regular expression.
34781 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
34782 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
34784 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
34792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34795 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
34796 "Local scan function"
34797 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
34798 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
34799 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
34800 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
34801 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
34803 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
34804 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
34805 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
34806 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
34807 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
34809 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
34810 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
34811 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
34812 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
34814 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
34815 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
34816 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
34817 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
34819 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
34820 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
34821 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
34822 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
34823 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
34824 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
34825 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
34826 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
34827 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
34831 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
34832 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
34833 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
34834 function is before building Exim, by setting
34835 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
34836 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
34837 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
34838 directory, so you might set
34840 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
34841 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
34843 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
34844 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
34845 and then #include "local_scan.h".
34847 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
34848 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
34849 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
34850 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
34851 _src/local_scan.c_.
34853 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
34854 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
34856 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34858 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
34863 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
34864 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
34865 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
34866 You must include this line near the start of your code:
34869 #include "local_scan.h"
34871 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
34872 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
34873 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
34874 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
34875 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
34876 strings and pointers to character strings:
34878 #define CS (char *)
34879 #define CCS (const char *)
34880 #define CSS (char **)
34881 #define US (unsigned char *)
34882 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
34883 #define USS (unsigned char **)
34885 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
34887 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
34889 The arguments are as follows:
34892 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
34893 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
34894 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
34896 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
34897 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
34898 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
34899 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
34900 case this changes in some future version.
34902 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
34903 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
34906 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
34909 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
34910 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
34911 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
34912 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
34913 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
34914 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
34916 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
34917 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34918 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
34920 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
34921 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34922 queued without immediate delivery.
34924 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
34925 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
34926 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
34927 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
34928 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
34931 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
34932 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
34933 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
34936 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34937 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
34938 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
34939 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
34940 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
34941 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
34942 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34944 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34945 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
34946 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34949 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
34950 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
34951 &%-oe%& command line options.
34955 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
34956 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
34957 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
34958 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
34959 want to do this, you must have the line
34961 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34963 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
34964 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
34965 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
34968 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
34969 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
34970 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
34971 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
34972 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
34973 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
34975 static int my_integer_option = 42;
34976 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
34978 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
34979 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
34980 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
34983 int local_scan_options_count =
34984 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
34986 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
34987 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
34991 my_string = some string of text...
34993 The available types of option data are as follows:
34996 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
34997 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
34998 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
34999 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35000 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35001 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35004 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35005 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35006 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35007 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35010 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35011 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35014 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35015 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35016 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35017 printed with the suffix K or M.
35019 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35020 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35021 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35022 always output in octal.
35024 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
35025 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
35026 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
35028 .vitem &*opt_time*&
35029 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
35030 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
35033 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
35034 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
35038 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
35039 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
35040 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
35041 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
35042 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
35043 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
35044 C variables are as follows:
35047 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
35048 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
35049 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
35051 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
35052 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
35053 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
35055 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
35056 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
35057 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
35058 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
35061 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
35062 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
35063 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
35066 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
35067 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
35071 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
35072 selected, you should use code like this:
35074 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35075 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35077 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
35078 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
35079 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
35081 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
35082 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
35085 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
35086 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
35088 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
35089 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
35091 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
35092 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
35093 &%-bh%& command line option.
35095 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
35096 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
35097 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
35099 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
35100 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
35101 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
35102 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
35104 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
35105 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
35106 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
35108 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
35109 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35111 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
35112 The number of accepted recipients.
35114 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
35115 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
35116 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
35117 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
35118 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
35119 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
35120 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
35121 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
35122 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
35123 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
35124 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
35125 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
35127 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
35128 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
35130 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
35131 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
35132 locally-submitted messages.
35134 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
35135 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
35136 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
35138 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
35139 The name of the sending host, if known.
35141 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
35142 The port on the sending host.
35144 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
35145 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
35147 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
35148 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
35150 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
35151 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
35152 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
35156 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
35157 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
35158 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
35159 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
35164 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
35165 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
35167 .vitem &*int&~type*&
35168 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
35169 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
35170 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
35171 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
35172 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
35173 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
35175 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
35176 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
35179 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
35180 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
35181 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
35186 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
35187 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
35190 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
35191 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
35193 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
35194 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
35195 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
35196 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
35198 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
35199 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
35200 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
35201 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
35202 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
35203 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
35204 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
35205 is NULL for all recipients.
35210 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
35211 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
35212 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
35213 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
35217 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
35218 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
35220 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
35221 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
35222 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
35223 for the process in &%newumask%&.
35225 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
35226 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
35227 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
35228 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
35229 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
35231 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
35233 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
35234 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
35235 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
35236 return value is as follows:
35241 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
35247 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
35253 The process timed out.
35257 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
35260 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
35261 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
35262 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
35263 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
35264 forks a subprocess that is running
35266 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
35268 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
35269 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
35270 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
35271 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
35273 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
35274 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
35275 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
35276 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
35279 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
35280 *sender_authentication)*&
35281 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
35284 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
35286 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
35289 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
35290 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
35291 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
35292 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
35293 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
35295 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35296 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35299 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
35300 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
35301 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
35302 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
35303 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
35304 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
35305 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
35306 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
35308 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
35309 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
35310 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
35311 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
35312 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
35313 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
35315 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35316 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
35317 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
35318 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
35320 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
35321 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
35322 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
35323 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
35324 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
35325 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
35326 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
35327 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
35328 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
35329 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
35331 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
35332 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
35334 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
35335 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
35338 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
35339 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
35340 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
35341 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
35342 match the specification, the function does nothing.
35345 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35346 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
35347 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
35348 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
35349 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
35350 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
35352 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
35354 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
35355 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
35356 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
35357 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
35358 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
35361 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
35362 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
35363 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
35364 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
35365 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
35366 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
35367 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
35368 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
35370 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
35371 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
35372 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
35374 &`OK `& match succeeded
35375 &`FAIL `& match failed
35376 &`DEFER `& match deferred
35378 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
35379 inability to contact a database.
35381 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
35383 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
35384 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
35385 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
35387 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
35389 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
35390 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
35391 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
35393 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
35395 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
35398 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
35400 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
35401 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
35402 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
35403 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
35404 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
35405 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
35408 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
35410 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
35411 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
35412 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
35413 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
35414 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
35415 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
35418 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
35419 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
35420 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
35421 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
35423 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
35424 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
35425 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
35426 value afterwards. For example:
35428 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
35429 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
35430 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
35433 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
35434 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
35435 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
35436 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
35443 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
35444 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
35445 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
35446 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
35447 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
35448 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
35449 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
35450 binary string is returned with an error message.
35452 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
35453 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
35454 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
35456 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
35457 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
35458 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
35459 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
35460 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
35462 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
35463 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
35464 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
35466 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
35467 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
35468 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
35469 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
35473 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
35474 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
35477 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
35478 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
35479 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
35480 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
35481 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
35482 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
35483 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
35484 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
35487 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
35488 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
35490 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
35491 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
35492 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
35493 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
35495 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
35496 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
35497 ABI version number was incremented.
35499 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
35500 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
35501 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
35502 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
35503 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
35504 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
35505 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
35507 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
35508 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
35510 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
35511 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
35512 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
35513 multiple output lines.
35515 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
35517 guarantee a flush of
35518 pending output, and therefore does not test
35519 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
35520 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
35521 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
35522 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
35523 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
35526 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
35527 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
35528 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
35529 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
35530 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
35531 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
35532 Exim bombs out if it ever
35533 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
35535 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
35536 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
35537 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
35539 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
35542 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
35545 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
35546 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
35547 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
35548 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
35549 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
35550 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
35556 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
35557 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
35558 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
35559 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
35560 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
35561 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
35562 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
35565 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
35566 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
35567 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
35568 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
35570 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
35571 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
35573 store_pool = POOL_PERM
35575 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
35576 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
35577 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
35578 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
35580 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
35581 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
35582 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
35583 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
35590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35593 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
35594 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
35595 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
35596 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
35597 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
35598 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
35599 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
35600 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
35602 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
35603 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
35604 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
35605 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
35606 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
35608 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
35609 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
35610 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
35611 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
35612 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
35613 prevent it happening on retries.
35615 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35616 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35617 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
35618 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
35619 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
35620 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
35621 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
35622 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
35625 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
35626 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
35627 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
35628 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
35629 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
35630 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
35631 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
35633 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
35634 system_filter_user = exim
35636 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
35637 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
35638 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
35639 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
35640 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
35641 by the &%reply%& command.
35644 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
35645 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
35646 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
35647 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
35649 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
35650 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
35654 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
35655 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
35656 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
35657 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
35658 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
35659 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
35662 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
35663 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
35664 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
35665 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
35666 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
35667 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
35668 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
35670 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
35671 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
35672 succeed, it will not be tried again.
35673 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
35674 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
35676 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
35677 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
35678 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
35679 to which users' filter files can refer.
35683 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
35684 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
35685 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
35686 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
35687 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
35691 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
35692 .cindex "freezing messages"
35693 .cindex "message" "freezing"
35694 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
35695 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
35696 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
35697 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
35698 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
35699 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
35700 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
35701 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
35702 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
35704 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
35706 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
35708 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
35709 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
35710 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
35711 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
35712 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
35715 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
35716 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
35717 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
35718 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
35720 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
35721 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
35722 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
35723 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
35724 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
35725 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
35726 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
35727 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
35728 message. For example:
35730 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
35731 because it contains attachments that we are \
35732 not prepared to receive."
35735 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
35736 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
35737 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
35738 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
35739 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
35740 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
35743 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
35744 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
35746 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
35747 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
35748 generated by the filter.
35750 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
35752 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
35753 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
35759 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
35760 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
35765 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
35766 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
35767 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
35768 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
35769 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
35771 headers add <string>
35772 headers remove <string>
35774 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
35775 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
35776 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
35777 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
35778 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
35780 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
35781 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
35782 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
35785 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
35786 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
35789 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
35790 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
35791 space after input continuations is ignored.
35793 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
35794 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
35795 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
35796 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
35797 header with the same name, they are all removed.
35799 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
35800 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
35801 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
35802 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
35803 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
35804 used for all recipients of the message.
35806 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
35807 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
35808 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
35809 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
35810 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
35811 until the message is actually being written (see section
35812 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
35814 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
35815 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
35816 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
35817 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
35818 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
35819 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
35820 modified more than once.
35822 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
35823 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
35826 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
35827 headers remove "Subject"
35828 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
35829 headers remove "Old-Subject"
35834 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
35835 .cindex "envelope from"
35836 .cindex "envelope sender"
35837 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
35839 errors_to <some address>
35841 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
35842 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
35843 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
35846 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
35848 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
35849 address if its delivery failed.
35853 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
35854 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
35855 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
35856 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
35857 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
35858 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
35859 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
35860 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
35861 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
35866 domains = +local_domains
35867 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
35872 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
35873 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
35874 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
35875 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
35877 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
35878 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
35879 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
35880 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
35882 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
35883 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
35884 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
35891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35894 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
35895 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
35896 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
35897 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
35898 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
35899 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
35900 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
35901 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
35903 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
35904 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
35905 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
35906 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
35907 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
35909 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
35910 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
35911 loopback interface specially in any way.
35913 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
35914 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
35919 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
35920 .cindex "message" "submission"
35921 .cindex "submission mode"
35922 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
35923 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
35924 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
35925 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
35927 control = submission
35929 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
35930 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
35931 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
35932 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
35933 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
35934 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
35936 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
35937 control = submission
35939 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
35940 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
35941 is used to separate options. For example:
35943 control = submission/sender_retain
35945 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
35946 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
35947 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
35948 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
35949 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
35950 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
35951 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
35953 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
35954 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
35957 control = submission/domain=some.domain
35959 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
35960 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
35961 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
35962 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
35964 accept authenticated = *
35965 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
35966 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
35967 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
35969 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
35970 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
35971 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
35973 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
35975 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
35978 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
35980 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
35981 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
35982 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
35983 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
35985 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
35986 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
35987 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
35988 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
35989 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
35990 spoof another's address.
35992 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
35993 .cindex "line endings"
35994 .cindex "carriage return"
35996 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
35997 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
35998 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
35999 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36000 use CRLF or just CR.
36002 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36003 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36004 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36005 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36006 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36007 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36008 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36009 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36013 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
36015 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36018 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36019 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36022 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
36023 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
36024 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
36025 people trying to play silly games.
36027 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
36028 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
36036 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
36037 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
36038 .cindex "address" "qualification"
36039 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
36040 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
36041 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
36042 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
36043 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
36045 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
36046 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
36047 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
36048 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
36049 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
36051 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
36052 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
36053 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
36054 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
36055 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
36056 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
36057 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
36058 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
36063 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
36064 .cindex "&""From""& line"
36065 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
36066 .cindex "sender" "address"
36067 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
36068 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
36069 .cindex "envelope from"
36070 .cindex "envelope sender"
36071 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36072 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
36073 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
36074 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
36076 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
36077 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
36079 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
36080 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
36081 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
36082 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
36083 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
36084 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
36085 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
36086 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
36087 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
36089 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
36090 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
36091 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
36092 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
36093 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
36094 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
36095 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
36097 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
36098 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
36099 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
36101 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
36102 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
36103 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
36104 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
36108 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
36110 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
36111 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
36112 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
36113 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
36114 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
36117 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
36118 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
36121 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
36122 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
36126 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
36127 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
36129 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
36130 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
36131 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
36133 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
36136 For a locally-submitted message,
36137 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
36138 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
36139 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
36140 included in log lines in this case.
36142 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
36143 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
36149 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
36150 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
36151 includes the header line:
36153 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
36156 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
36157 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
36158 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
36159 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
36160 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
36161 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
36164 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
36166 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
36167 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
36168 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
36170 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
36171 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
36172 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
36173 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
36174 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
36175 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
36176 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
36177 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
36181 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
36182 .chindex Envelope-to:
36183 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
36184 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
36185 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
36186 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
36187 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
36188 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
36192 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
36194 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36195 .cindex "message" "submission"
36196 .cindex "submission mode"
36197 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
36198 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
36201 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
36202 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
36204 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36205 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
36207 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36208 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36209 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36211 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
36212 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36214 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36215 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36219 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
36221 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
36222 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
36223 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
36224 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36225 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
36226 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
36227 &%qualify_domain%&.
36229 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
36230 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
36231 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
36232 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36235 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
36236 .chindex Message-ID:
36237 .cindex "message" "submission"
36238 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
36239 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
36240 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
36241 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
36242 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
36243 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
36244 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
36245 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
36246 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
36247 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
36250 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
36252 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
36253 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
36254 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
36256 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
36257 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
36258 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
36259 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
36261 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
36262 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
36263 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
36266 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
36267 .chindex References:
36268 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
36269 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
36270 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
36271 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
36272 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
36273 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
36274 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
36275 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
36276 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
36280 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
36281 .chindex Return-path:
36282 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
36283 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
36284 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
36285 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
36286 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
36287 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
36291 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
36292 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
36293 .cindex "message" "submission"
36295 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
36296 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
36297 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
36298 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36301 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
36302 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36303 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
36304 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
36305 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
36306 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
36307 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
36308 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
36309 line is added to the message.
36311 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
36312 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
36313 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
36314 options true at the same time.
36316 .cindex "submission mode"
36317 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
36318 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
36319 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
36320 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
36322 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36323 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
36324 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
36325 created as follows:
36328 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36329 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36330 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36332 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
36333 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36335 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36336 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36339 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
36340 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
36341 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
36342 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
36344 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
36345 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
36346 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
36347 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
36351 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
36352 "SECTheadersaddrem"
36353 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
36354 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
36355 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
36356 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
36357 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
36358 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
36359 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
36361 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
36362 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
36363 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
36364 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
36365 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
36366 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
36368 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
36369 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
36370 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
36372 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
36373 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
36374 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
36376 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
36377 X-added-second: another added header line
36379 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
36381 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
36382 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
36383 Each header-line is separately expanded.
36385 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
36386 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
36387 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
36388 not part of the names. For example:
36390 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
36393 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
36394 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
36395 Each item is separately expanded.
36396 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
36397 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
36398 will act as list separators.
36400 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
36401 items are expanded at routing time,
36402 and then associated with all addresses that are
36403 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
36404 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
36405 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
36407 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
36408 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
36409 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
36410 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
36412 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
36413 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
36414 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
36417 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
36418 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
36419 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
36420 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
36421 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
36422 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
36423 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
36425 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
36426 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
36427 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
36428 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
36430 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
36431 the following consequences:
36434 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
36435 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
36436 to it, at all times.
36438 Header lines that are added by a router's
36439 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
36440 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
36442 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
36443 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
36445 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
36446 a later router or by a transport.
36448 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
36449 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
36451 headers_remove = subject
36452 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
36456 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
36457 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
36463 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
36464 .cindex "address" "constructed"
36465 .cindex "constructed address"
36466 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
36469 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
36473 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
36475 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
36476 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
36477 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
36478 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
36479 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
36480 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
36481 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
36482 there is no password file entry.
36485 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
36486 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
36487 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
36488 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
36489 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
36490 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
36491 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
36492 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
36496 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
36497 .cindex "case of local parts"
36498 .cindex "local part" "case of"
36499 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
36500 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
36501 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
36502 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
36503 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
36504 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
36507 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
36508 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
36509 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
36510 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
36511 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
36515 domains = +local_domains
36516 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
36517 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
36520 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
36521 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
36522 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
36523 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
36524 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
36528 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
36529 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
36530 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
36531 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
36532 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
36533 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
36534 empty components for compatibility.
36538 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
36539 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
36540 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
36541 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
36542 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
36543 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
36545 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
36546 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
36547 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
36548 example, a header such as
36552 might get rewritten as
36554 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
36556 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
36557 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
36560 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
36561 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
36562 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
36563 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
36564 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
36565 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
36566 .ecindex IIDmesproc
36570 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36571 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36573 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
36574 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
36575 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
36576 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
36577 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
36578 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
36579 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
36582 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
36584 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
36586 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
36589 For mail delivery, the following are available:
36592 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
36594 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
36597 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
36600 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
36601 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
36604 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
36605 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
36606 used to contain the envelope information.
36610 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
36611 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
36612 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
36613 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
36614 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
36617 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
36618 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
36619 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
36620 processing is the same in both cases.
36622 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
36623 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
36624 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
36625 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
36626 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
36627 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
36628 .cindex "transport" "filter"
36629 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
36630 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
36633 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
36634 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
36635 required for the transaction.
36637 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
36638 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
36639 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
36640 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
36641 is called for verification.
36643 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
36644 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
36645 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
36647 .cindex "carriage return"
36649 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36650 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
36651 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36654 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
36655 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
36656 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
36657 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
36658 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
36659 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
36660 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
36661 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
36662 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
36664 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
36665 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
36666 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
36667 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
36669 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
36670 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
36671 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
36672 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
36674 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36675 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
36676 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
36677 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
36678 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
36679 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
36680 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
36681 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
36682 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
36683 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
36685 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
36686 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
36688 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36689 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
36690 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
36691 square bracket of the IP address.
36696 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
36697 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
36698 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
36699 .cindex "host" "error"
36700 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
36701 message errors, and recipient errors.
36704 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
36705 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
36706 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
36709 Connection refused or timed out,
36711 Any error response code on connection,
36713 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
36715 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
36717 I/O errors at any time,
36719 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
36720 the &"."& at the end of the data.
36723 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
36724 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
36725 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
36726 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
36727 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
36728 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
36729 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
36730 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
36732 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
36733 .cindex "message" "error"
36734 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
36735 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
36736 message errors are:
36739 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
36742 Timeout after MAIL,
36744 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
36745 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
36746 connection at any other time.
36749 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
36750 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
36751 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
36752 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
36753 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
36754 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
36755 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
36756 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
36757 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
36758 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
36760 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
36761 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
36762 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
36765 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
36766 .cindex "recipient" "error"
36767 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
36768 recipient errors are:
36771 Any error response to RCPT,
36773 Timeout after RCPT.
36776 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
36777 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
36778 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
36779 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
36780 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
36781 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
36782 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
36783 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
36784 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
36785 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
36786 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
36787 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
36788 the retry clock is reset.
36790 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
36791 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
36792 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
36793 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
36794 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
36795 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
36796 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
36797 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
36798 recipient's retry time.
36801 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
36802 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
36803 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
36804 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
36805 until the next delivery attempt.
36807 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
36808 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
36809 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
36810 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
36811 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
36814 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
36815 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
36816 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
36817 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
36818 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
36819 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
36820 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
36822 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
36823 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
36824 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
36825 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
36826 then to be treated as a host error.
36828 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
36829 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
36830 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
36831 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
36832 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
36837 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
36838 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
36839 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
36842 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
36843 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
36844 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
36846 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
36848 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
36849 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
36850 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
36851 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
36852 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
36853 stream and exits with an error code.
36855 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
36856 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
36857 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
36858 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
36860 .cindex "carriage return"
36862 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36863 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
36864 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36866 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
36867 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
36868 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
36870 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
36871 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
36872 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
36873 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
36874 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
36875 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
36876 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
36877 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
36879 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
36880 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
36881 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
36882 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
36883 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
36884 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
36885 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
36886 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
36887 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
36889 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
36890 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
36891 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
36893 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
36894 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
36895 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
36896 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
36897 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
36899 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
36900 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
36901 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
36902 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
36903 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
36904 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
36905 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
36907 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
36908 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
36909 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
36910 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
36911 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
36913 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
36914 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
36915 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
36916 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
36917 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
36918 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
36919 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
36920 a delivery process.
36922 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
36923 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
36924 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
36925 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
36926 however, available with &'inetd'&.
36928 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
36929 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
36930 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
36931 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
36933 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
36934 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
36935 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
36939 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
36940 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
36941 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
36942 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
36943 the error response to the last command. The default value for
36944 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
36945 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
36946 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
36949 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
36950 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
36951 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
36952 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
36953 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
36954 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
36955 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
36956 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
36957 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
36958 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
36959 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
36963 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
36964 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
36965 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
36966 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
36967 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
36968 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
36969 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
36970 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
36972 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
36973 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
36974 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
36975 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
36976 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
36979 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
36980 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
36981 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
36983 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
36984 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
36985 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
36986 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
36987 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
36992 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
36993 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
36994 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
36995 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
36997 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
36998 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
36999 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37000 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37001 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37002 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37003 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37004 SMTP response codes.
37006 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
37007 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
37008 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
37009 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
37010 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
37011 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
37012 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
37013 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
37018 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
37019 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
37020 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
37021 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
37022 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
37023 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
37024 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
37025 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
37027 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
37028 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
37029 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
37030 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
37031 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
37032 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
37033 argument. For example,
37041 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
37042 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
37043 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
37044 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
37045 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
37047 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
37048 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
37049 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
37050 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
37051 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
37052 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
37053 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
37054 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
37056 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
37057 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
37058 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
37059 whatever the form of its argument. For
37062 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
37063 $sender_host_address
37065 .vindex "&$domain$&"
37066 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
37067 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
37068 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
37069 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
37070 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
37071 for it to change them before running the command.
37075 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
37076 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
37077 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
37078 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
37079 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
37080 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
37081 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
37082 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
37083 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
37084 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
37085 runs for RCPT commands:
37089 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
37093 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
37094 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
37095 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
37096 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
37097 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
37098 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
37099 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
37100 envelope along with the message.
37102 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
37103 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
37104 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
37105 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
37106 can be used to specify it.
37108 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
37109 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
37110 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
37111 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
37112 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
37115 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
37116 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
37117 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
37122 driver = manualroute
37123 transport = smtp_appendfile
37124 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
37128 driver = appendfile
37129 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
37134 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
37135 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
37136 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
37140 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
37141 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
37142 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
37143 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
37144 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
37145 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
37146 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
37147 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
37148 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
37149 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
37151 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
37152 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
37154 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
37155 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
37156 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
37157 make some use of automatically, for example:
37159 554 Unexpected end of file
37160 Transaction started in line 10
37161 Error detected in line 14
37163 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
37166 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
37167 The error message was:
37169 501 '>' missing at end of address
37171 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
37172 The error was detected in line 12.
37173 The SMTP command at fault was:
37175 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
37177 1 previous message was successfully processed.
37178 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
37180 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
37181 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
37183 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
37184 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
37188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37191 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
37192 "Customizing messages"
37193 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
37194 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
37195 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
37196 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
37197 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
37199 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
37200 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
37201 option. Exim also adds the line
37203 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
37205 to all warning and bounce messages,
37208 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
37209 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
37210 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
37211 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
37212 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
37213 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
37214 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
37216 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
37217 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
37218 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
37219 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
37220 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
37223 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
37224 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
37225 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
37226 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
37227 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
37228 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
37229 option, rounded to a whole number.
37231 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
37234 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37235 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37237 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
37238 failing addresses with their error messages.
37240 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
37241 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
37243 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
37244 The fields exist for back-compatibility
37247 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
37248 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
37249 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
37251 Subject: Mail delivery failed
37252 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37253 {: returning message to sender}}
37255 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37257 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37258 {that you sent }{sent by
37262 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
37263 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
37265 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
37267 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
37270 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
37272 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
37275 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
37276 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
37277 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
37278 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
37279 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
37283 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37284 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37286 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
37287 the delayed addresses.
37289 The third item then ends the message.
37292 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
37293 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
37295 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
37296 $warn_message_delay
37298 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37300 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
37301 {that you sent }{sent by
37305 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
37306 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
37308 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
37309 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
37310 The date of the message is: $h_date
37312 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
37314 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
37315 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
37316 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
37317 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
37318 the message will be returned to you.
37320 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
37321 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
37322 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
37323 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
37324 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
37325 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
37326 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
37327 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
37333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37336 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
37337 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
37338 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
37342 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
37343 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
37344 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
37345 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
37346 routing explicitly:
37348 send_to_smart_host:
37349 driver = manualroute
37350 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
37351 transport = remote_smtp
37353 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
37354 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
37355 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
37356 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
37357 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
37362 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
37363 .cindex "mailing lists"
37364 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
37365 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
37366 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
37368 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
37369 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
37370 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
37371 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
37375 domains = lists.example
37376 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
37379 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
37382 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
37383 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
37384 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
37385 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
37387 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
37388 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
37391 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
37392 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
37393 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
37394 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
37395 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
37397 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
37398 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
37399 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
37400 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
37401 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
37402 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
37403 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
37404 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
37405 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
37409 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
37410 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
37411 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
37412 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
37413 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
37414 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
37415 addresses are not rigorously checked.
37417 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
37418 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
37419 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
37420 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
37421 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
37425 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
37426 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
37427 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
37428 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
37429 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
37430 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
37431 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
37432 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
37433 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
37434 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
37436 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
37437 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
37438 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
37439 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
37440 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
37441 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
37442 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
37443 pre-existing messages.
37445 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
37446 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
37447 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
37448 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
37449 one level of expansion anyway.
37453 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
37454 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
37455 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
37456 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
37457 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
37458 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
37460 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
37461 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
37465 domains = lists.example
37466 local_part_suffix = -request
37467 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
37468 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
37473 domains = lists.example
37474 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
37475 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
37476 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
37479 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
37484 domains = lists.example
37486 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
37488 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
37489 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
37490 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
37493 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
37494 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
37495 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
37496 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
37497 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
37498 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
37499 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
37500 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
37501 &"unrouteable address"& error.
37503 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
37504 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
37505 the address, giving a suitable error message.
37510 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
37512 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
37513 .cindex "envelope from"
37514 .cindex "envelope sender"
37515 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
37516 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
37517 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
37518 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
37519 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
37520 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
37522 .oindex &%errors_to%&
37523 .oindex &%return_path%&
37524 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
37525 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
37526 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
37527 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
37528 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
37529 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
37530 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
37536 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
37537 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
37539 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
37540 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
37541 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
37542 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
37543 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
37544 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
37545 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
37548 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
37550 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
37551 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
37552 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
37553 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
37554 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
37555 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
37557 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
37558 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
37559 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
37560 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
37564 domains = ! +local_domains
37566 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
37567 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
37570 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
37571 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
37572 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
37573 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
37576 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
37577 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
37578 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
37579 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
37580 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
37584 domains = ! +local_domains
37585 transport = remote_smtp
37587 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
37588 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
37591 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
37592 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
37593 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
37594 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
37597 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
37598 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
37599 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
37600 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
37601 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
37602 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
37610 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
37611 .cindex "virtual domains"
37612 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
37613 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
37617 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
37618 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
37619 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
37621 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
37622 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
37623 have login accounts on that host.
37626 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
37627 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
37628 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
37629 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
37630 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
37631 to a router of this form:
37635 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
37636 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
37639 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
37640 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
37641 domain that is being processed.
37642 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
37643 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
37645 When the router runs, it looks up the local
37646 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
37647 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
37648 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
37650 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
37651 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
37652 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
37653 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
37655 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
37656 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
37657 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
37661 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
37662 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
37663 transport = my_mailboxes
37665 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
37666 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
37667 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
37668 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
37669 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
37673 driver = appendfile
37674 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
37677 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
37678 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
37680 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
37681 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
37682 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
37683 information about the domains.
37687 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
37688 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
37689 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
37690 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
37691 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
37692 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
37693 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
37694 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
37695 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
37696 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
37697 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
37698 example, consider this router:
37703 file = $home/.forward
37704 local_part_suffix = -*
37705 local_part_suffix_optional
37708 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
37709 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
37710 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
37711 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
37713 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
37714 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
37717 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
37718 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
37719 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
37720 control over which suffixes are valid.
37722 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
37723 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
37729 local_part_suffix = -*
37730 local_part_suffix_optional
37731 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
37734 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
37735 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
37736 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
37737 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
37738 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
37742 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
37743 .cindex "vacation processing"
37744 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
37745 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
37746 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
37747 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
37748 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
37751 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
37752 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
37753 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
37754 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
37756 spqr, vacation-spqr
37759 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
37760 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
37761 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
37762 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
37763 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
37767 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
37768 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
37772 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
37773 .cindex "message" "copying every"
37774 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
37775 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
37776 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
37777 each day's messages.
37779 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
37780 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
37781 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
37782 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
37786 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
37787 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
37788 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
37789 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
37790 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
37791 permanently connected.
37793 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
37794 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
37795 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
37798 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
37799 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
37800 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
37801 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
37802 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
37803 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
37804 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
37805 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
37807 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
37808 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
37809 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
37810 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
37811 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
37812 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
37815 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
37816 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
37817 intermittent host. For example:
37819 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
37821 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
37822 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
37823 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
37824 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
37825 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
37826 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
37829 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
37830 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
37831 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
37832 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
37833 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
37834 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
37835 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
37839 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
37840 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
37841 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
37842 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
37843 delivered immediately.
37845 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37846 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
37847 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
37848 .cindex "first pass routing"
37849 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
37850 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
37851 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
37852 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
37853 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
37854 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
37855 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
37856 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
37857 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
37858 single SMTP connection.
37862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37865 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
37866 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
37867 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
37868 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
37869 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
37870 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
37871 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
37872 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
37873 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
37874 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
37877 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
37878 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
37879 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
37880 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
37881 email is not desirable.
37883 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
37884 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
37885 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
37886 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
37887 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
37888 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
37889 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
37891 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
37892 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
37893 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
37894 before sending a message to the smart host.
37896 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
37897 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
37898 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
37900 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
37901 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
37902 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
37903 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
37904 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
37905 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
37906 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
37908 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
37912 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
37913 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
37915 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
37916 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
37917 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
37918 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
37919 successful, a zero return code is given.
37921 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
37922 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
37923 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
37924 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
37925 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
37928 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
37929 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
37930 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
37932 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
37933 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
37934 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
37935 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
37936 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
37938 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
37939 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
37940 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
37942 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
37943 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
37944 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
37945 are ever generated.
37947 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
37949 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
37950 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
37951 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
37954 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
37955 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
37956 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
37957 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
37958 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
37959 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
37964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37967 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
37968 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
37969 .cindex "log" "types of"
37970 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
37975 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
37976 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
37977 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
37978 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
37979 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
37980 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
37981 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
37982 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
37984 .cindex "reject log"
37985 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
37986 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
37987 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
37988 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
37989 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
37990 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
37991 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
37992 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
37993 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
37996 .cindex "panic log"
37997 .cindex "system log"
37998 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
37999 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
38000 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
38001 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
38002 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
38003 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
38004 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
38005 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
38006 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
38009 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
38010 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
38011 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
38013 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
38016 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
38017 ways of changing this:
38020 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
38025 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
38027 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
38030 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
38034 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38035 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38036 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
38037 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
38038 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
38039 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
38044 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
38045 .cindex "log" "destination"
38046 .cindex "log" "to file"
38047 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
38049 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
38050 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
38051 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
38052 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
38053 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
38054 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
38055 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
38057 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
38058 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
38059 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
38060 references to the host name:
38062 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
38064 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
38065 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
38066 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
38067 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
38068 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
38071 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
38072 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
38073 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
38074 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
38075 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
38076 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
38077 implying the use of a default path.
38079 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
38080 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
38081 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
38082 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
38083 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
38084 equivalent to the setting:
38086 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
38088 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
38089 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
38090 that is where the logs are written.
38092 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
38093 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
38095 Here are some examples of possible settings:
38097 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
38098 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
38099 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
38100 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
38102 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
38107 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
38108 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38109 .cindex "cycling logs"
38110 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38111 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
38112 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
38113 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
38114 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
38115 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
38116 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
38118 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
38119 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
38120 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
38121 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
38122 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
38123 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
38124 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
38125 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
38126 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
38127 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
38128 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
38133 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
38134 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
38135 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
38136 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
38137 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
38138 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
38139 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
38140 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
38142 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
38143 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
38144 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
38145 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
38147 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
38148 examples of names generated by the above examples:
38150 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
38151 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
38152 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
38153 /var/log/exim/main.200212
38155 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
38156 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
38157 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
38158 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
38160 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
38161 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
38162 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
38163 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
38164 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
38165 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
38168 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38169 /var/log/exim-panic.log
38170 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38171 /var/log/exim/panic
38175 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
38176 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
38177 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
38178 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
38179 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
38180 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
38181 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
38182 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
38183 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
38184 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
38185 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
38186 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
38187 the time and host name to each line.
38188 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
38191 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
38193 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
38195 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
38198 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
38199 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
38200 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
38201 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
38203 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
38204 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
38205 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
38206 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
38207 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
38208 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
38209 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
38210 RFC 3164, you should set
38212 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
38214 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
38215 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
38217 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
38218 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
38219 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
38220 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
38221 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
38222 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
38223 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
38224 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
38225 name, and pid as added by syslog:
38227 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
38228 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
38229 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
38230 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
38233 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
38236 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
38237 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
38238 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
38239 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
38241 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
38242 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
38243 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
38244 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
38245 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
38246 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
38248 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
38249 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
38250 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
38253 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
38255 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
38256 without modification.
38258 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
38259 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
38260 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
38265 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
38266 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
38267 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
38268 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
38269 timestamp. The flags are:
38271 &`<=`& message arrival
38272 &`(=`& message fakereject
38273 &`=>`& normal message delivery
38274 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
38275 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
38276 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
38277 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
38278 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
38282 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
38283 .cindex "log" "reception line"
38284 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38285 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
38286 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
38288 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
38289 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
38290 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
38292 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
38293 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
38294 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
38298 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
38302 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
38303 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
38304 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
38305 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
38306 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
38307 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
38308 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
38309 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
38310 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
38311 name in parentheses.
38313 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
38314 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
38315 the log containing text like these examples:
38317 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
38318 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
38320 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
38323 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
38324 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
38327 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
38328 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
38329 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
38330 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
38331 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
38332 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
38333 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
38334 suite that was used.
38336 .cindex log protocol
38337 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
38338 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
38339 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
38340 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
38341 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
38342 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
38343 authenticator name.
38345 .cindex "size" "of message"
38346 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
38347 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
38348 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
38349 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
38352 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
38353 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
38357 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
38358 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
38359 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38360 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
38361 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
38362 to fit it on the page:
38364 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
38365 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
38366 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
38367 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
38368 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
38370 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
38371 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
38372 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
38373 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
38374 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
38376 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
38377 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
38378 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
38379 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
38380 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
38382 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
38383 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
38385 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
38387 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
38388 parentheses afterwards.
38390 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
38391 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
38392 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
38393 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
38394 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
38396 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
38398 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
38399 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
38400 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
38401 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
38402 TLS cipher information is still available.
38404 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
38405 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
38406 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
38407 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
38408 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
38410 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
38411 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
38413 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
38414 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
38417 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
38418 .cindex "discarded messages"
38419 .cindex "message" "discarded"
38420 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
38421 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
38422 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
38424 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
38425 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
38427 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
38428 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
38430 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
38431 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
38435 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
38436 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
38438 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
38439 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
38441 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
38442 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
38443 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
38445 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
38446 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
38448 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
38449 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
38450 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
38454 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
38455 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
38456 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
38457 following form is logged:
38459 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
38460 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
38462 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
38463 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
38465 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
38466 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
38467 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
38468 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
38469 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
38471 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
38472 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
38473 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
38474 flagged with &`**`&.
38478 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
38479 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
38480 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
38481 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
38482 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
38486 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
38489 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
38491 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
38492 at the end of its processing.
38497 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
38498 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
38499 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
38500 the following table:
38502 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
38503 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
38504 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
38505 &`CV `& certificate verification status
38506 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
38507 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
38508 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
38509 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
38510 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
38511 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
38512 &`H `& host name and IP address
38513 &`I `& local interface used
38514 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
38515 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
38516 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
38517 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
38518 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
38519 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
38520 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
38521 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
38522 &`Q `& alternate queue name
38523 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
38524 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
38525 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
38526 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
38527 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
38528 &`S `& size of message in bytes
38529 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
38530 &`ST `& shadow transport name
38531 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
38532 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
38533 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
38534 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
38535 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
38539 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
38540 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
38541 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
38544 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
38545 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
38546 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
38547 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
38548 during the first delivery attempt.
38550 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
38551 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
38552 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
38554 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
38555 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
38556 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
38557 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
38558 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
38561 .cindex "error" "ignored"
38562 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
38565 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
38566 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
38568 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
38569 failed. The delivery was discarded.
38571 A delivery set up by a router configured with
38572 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
38573 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
38577 failed. The delivery was discarded.
38580 .cindex DKIM "log line"
38581 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
38582 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
38589 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
38590 .cindex "log" "selectors"
38591 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
38592 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
38593 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
38596 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
38598 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
38599 selection marked by asterisks:
38601 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
38602 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
38603 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
38604 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
38605 &` arguments `& command line arguments
38606 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
38607 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
38608 &` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
38609 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
38610 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
38611 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
38612 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
38613 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
38614 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
38615 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
38616 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
38617 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
38618 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
38619 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
38620 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
38621 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
38622 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
38623 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
38624 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
38625 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
38626 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
38627 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
38628 &` pid `& Exim process id
38629 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
38630 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
38631 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
38632 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
38633 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
38634 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
38635 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
38636 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
38637 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
38638 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
38639 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
38640 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
38641 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
38642 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
38643 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
38644 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
38645 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
38646 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
38647 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
38648 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
38649 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
38650 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
38651 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
38652 &` tls_resumption `& append * to cipher field
38653 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
38654 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
38656 &` all `& all of the above
38658 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
38659 section &<<SECID99>>&
38661 More details on each of these items follows:
38665 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
38666 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
38667 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
38668 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
38669 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
38670 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
38672 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
38673 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
38674 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
38675 this log selector is set.
38677 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
38678 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
38679 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
38680 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
38681 such users cannot access the log).
38683 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
38684 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
38685 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
38686 parentheses between them.
38688 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
38689 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
38690 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
38691 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
38692 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
38693 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
38694 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
38695 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
38696 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
38697 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
38698 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
38699 between the caller and Exim.
38701 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
38702 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
38703 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
38705 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
38706 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
38707 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
38708 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
38709 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
38710 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
38712 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
38713 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
38714 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
38715 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38716 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
38718 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
38719 .cindex "size" "of message"
38720 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
38721 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
38723 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
38724 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38725 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
38726 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
38728 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
38729 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38730 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
38732 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
38733 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
38734 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
38735 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
38736 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
38739 .cindex dnssec logging
38740 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
38741 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
38742 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
38743 It does not cover helo-name verification.
38744 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
38746 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
38747 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
38748 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
38749 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
38750 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
38751 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
38753 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
38754 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
38755 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
38756 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
38757 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
38759 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
38760 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
38761 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
38762 client's ident port times out.
38764 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
38765 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
38766 .cindex "log" "local interface"
38767 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
38768 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38769 .cindex "interface" "logging"
38770 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
38771 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
38772 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
38773 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
38774 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
38776 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
38778 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38780 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
38781 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
38782 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
38783 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
38784 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
38785 on a proxied connection
38786 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
38787 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
38789 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
38790 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
38791 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
38792 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
38793 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
38794 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
38795 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
38796 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
38797 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
38798 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
38799 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
38801 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
38802 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
38803 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
38805 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
38806 .cindex millisecond logging
38807 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
38808 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
38809 appended to the seconds value.
38811 .cindex "log" "message id"
38812 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
38814 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
38815 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
38816 (submission mode) without one.
38817 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
38819 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
38820 .cindex "log" "local interface"
38821 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
38822 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38823 .cindex "interface" "logging"
38824 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
38825 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
38826 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
38827 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38829 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
38830 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
38831 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
38832 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
38833 containing => tags) following the IP address.
38834 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
38835 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
38836 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
38837 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
38838 local port is a random ephemeral port.
38840 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38841 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38842 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
38843 immediately after the time and date.
38845 .cindex log pipelining
38846 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
38847 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
38848 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
38849 The field is a single "L".
38851 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
38852 the field has a minus appended.
38854 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
38855 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
38856 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
38857 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
38858 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
38861 .cindex "log" "queue run"
38862 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
38863 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
38865 .cindex "log" "queue time"
38866 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
38867 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
38868 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
38869 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
38870 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
38871 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
38872 message has been successfully received.
38873 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38874 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
38876 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
38877 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
38878 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
38879 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
38881 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
38882 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
38883 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
38884 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38885 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
38887 .cindex "log" "recipients"
38888 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
38889 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
38890 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
38891 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
38893 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
38896 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
38897 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
38898 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
38899 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
38901 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
38902 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
38903 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
38904 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
38905 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
38907 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
38908 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
38909 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
38910 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
38913 .cindex "log" "return path"
38914 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
38915 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
38916 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
38917 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
38919 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
38920 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
38921 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
38922 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
38923 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
38925 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
38926 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
38927 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
38928 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
38931 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
38932 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
38935 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
38936 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
38937 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
38938 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
38940 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
38941 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
38943 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
38944 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
38945 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
38946 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
38947 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
38948 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
38951 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
38952 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
38953 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
38954 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
38955 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
38956 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
38957 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
38958 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
38959 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
38960 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
38962 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
38963 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
38964 reset if the daemon is restarted.
38965 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
38966 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
38967 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
38968 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
38969 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
38971 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
38972 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
38973 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
38974 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
38975 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
38976 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
38978 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
38979 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
38980 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
38981 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
38982 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
38983 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
38984 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
38985 already have their own log lines.
38987 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
38988 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
38989 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
38990 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
38991 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
38992 the same logging options.
38994 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
38995 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
38999 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
39000 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
39001 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
39002 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
39003 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
39005 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
39006 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
39007 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
39008 was accepted or used.
39010 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
39011 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
39012 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
39013 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
39014 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
39015 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
39016 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
39017 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
39019 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
39020 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
39021 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
39022 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
39023 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
39024 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
39025 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
39026 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
39027 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
39029 .cindex "log" "subject"
39030 .cindex "subject, logging"
39031 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
39032 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
39033 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
39034 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
39035 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
39037 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
39039 .cindex DANE logging
39040 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
39041 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
39043 using a CA trust anchor,
39044 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
39045 and &`CV=no`& if not.
39047 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
39048 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
39049 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39050 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
39052 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
39053 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
39054 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39055 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
39056 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
39058 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
39059 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
39061 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39062 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
39063 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
39066 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
39067 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
39068 .cindex SNI logging
39069 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
39070 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
39071 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
39073 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
39074 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
39075 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
39079 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
39080 .cindex "message" "log file for"
39081 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
39082 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
39083 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
39084 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
39085 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
39086 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
39087 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
39088 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
39089 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
39090 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
39091 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
39093 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
39094 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
39095 &%message_logs%& option false.
39101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39104 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
39105 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
39106 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
39107 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
39108 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
39110 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
39111 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
39112 "list what Exim processes are doing"
39113 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
39114 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
39115 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
39116 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
39118 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
39119 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
39120 "extract statistics from the log"
39121 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
39122 "check address acceptance from given IP"
39123 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
39124 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
39125 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
39126 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
39127 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
39128 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
39131 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
39132 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
39133 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
39138 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
39139 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
39140 .cindex "process, querying"
39142 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
39143 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
39144 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
39145 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
39146 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
39147 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
39148 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
39149 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
39151 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
39152 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
39153 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
39156 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
39157 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
39158 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
39159 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
39160 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
39163 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
39164 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
39165 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
39166 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
39168 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
39170 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
39171 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
39172 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
39173 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
39174 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
39175 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
39177 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
39178 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
39182 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
39183 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
39184 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
39185 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
39189 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
39193 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
39194 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
39196 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
39197 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
39200 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
39201 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39202 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
39206 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
39207 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39208 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
39210 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
39211 Match against the size field.
39213 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39214 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
39216 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39217 Match messages that are older than the given time.
39220 Match only frozen messages.
39223 Match only non-frozen messages.
39225 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
39226 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
39229 The following options control the format of the output:
39233 Display only the count of matching messages.
39236 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
39240 Display message ids only.
39243 Brief format &-- one line per message.
39246 Display messages in reverse order.
39249 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
39252 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
39256 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
39257 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
39258 .cindex "queue" "summary"
39259 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
39260 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
39261 running a command such as
39263 exim -bp | exiqsumm
39265 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
39266 it, as in the following example:
39268 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
39270 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
39271 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
39272 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
39273 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
39275 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
39276 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
39277 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
39278 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
39279 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
39280 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
39283 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
39284 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
39285 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
39286 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
39287 level"& addresses).
39292 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
39294 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
39295 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
39296 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
39297 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
39298 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
39299 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
39300 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
39301 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
39302 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
39303 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
39305 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
39307 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
39309 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
39310 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
39311 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
39313 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
39314 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
39315 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
39316 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
39317 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
39319 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
39320 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
39321 regular expression.
39323 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
39324 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
39326 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
39327 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
39331 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
39332 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
39333 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
39334 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
39335 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
39336 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
39339 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
39340 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
39341 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
39342 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
39343 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
39346 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
39347 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
39348 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
39349 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
39350 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
39351 the &%--help%& option.
39354 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
39355 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
39356 .cindex "cycling logs"
39357 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
39358 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
39359 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
39360 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
39361 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
39362 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
39363 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
39365 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
39366 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
39368 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
39369 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
39370 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
39374 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
39375 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
39376 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
39377 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
39378 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
39379 logs are handled similarly.
39381 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
39382 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
39383 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
39384 any existing log files.
39386 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
39387 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
39388 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
39389 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
39390 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
39392 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
39394 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
39395 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
39399 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
39400 .cindex "statistics"
39401 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
39402 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
39403 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
39404 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
39405 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
39407 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
39408 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
39409 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
39410 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
39411 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
39413 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
39415 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
39416 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
39417 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
39418 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
39419 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
39420 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
39421 also produced per user.
39423 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
39424 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
39425 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
39426 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
39427 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
39429 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
39430 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
39431 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
39432 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
39433 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
39434 an entirely separate message.
39436 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
39437 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
39438 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
39439 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
39440 least one address that failed.
39442 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
39443 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
39444 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
39445 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
39446 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
39447 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
39448 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
39450 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
39451 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
39452 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
39454 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
39455 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
39456 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
39458 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
39461 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
39462 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
39463 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
39464 .cindex "checking access"
39465 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
39466 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
39467 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
39468 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
39469 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
39470 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
39472 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
39473 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
39475 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
39477 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
39478 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
39479 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
39480 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
39483 550 Relay not permitted
39485 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
39486 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
39487 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
39488 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
39491 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
39492 -f himself@there.example
39494 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
39495 mandatory arguments.
39497 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
39498 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
39499 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
39503 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
39504 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
39505 .cindex "building DBM files"
39506 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
39507 .cindex "lower casing"
39508 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
39509 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
39510 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
39511 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
39512 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
39513 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
39515 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
39516 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
39517 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
39518 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
39521 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
39522 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
39523 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
39527 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
39528 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
39529 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
39530 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
39532 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
39534 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
39535 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
39537 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
39538 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
39539 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
39540 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
39541 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
39542 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
39544 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
39545 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
39546 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
39547 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
39548 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
39549 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
39550 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
39556 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
39557 .cindex "retry" "times"
39558 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
39559 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
39560 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
39561 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
39562 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
39563 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
39564 output. For example:
39566 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
39567 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
39568 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
39569 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
39570 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
39571 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
39572 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
39573 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
39574 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
39575 past final cutoff time
39577 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
39578 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
39579 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
39580 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
39581 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
39582 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
39585 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
39586 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
39587 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
39588 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
39589 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
39590 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
39594 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
39595 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
39596 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
39597 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
39598 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
39599 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
39600 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
39603 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
39605 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
39608 &'callout'&: the callout cache
39610 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
39613 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
39616 &'misc'&: other hints data
39619 The &'misc'& database is used for
39622 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
39624 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
39625 &(smtp)& transport)
39627 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
39633 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
39634 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
39635 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
39636 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
39637 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
39639 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
39641 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
39643 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
39644 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
39646 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
39647 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
39648 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
39649 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
39650 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
39651 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
39652 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
39653 and a textual description of the error.
39655 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
39656 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
39657 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
39660 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
39661 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
39662 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
39663 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
39664 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
39665 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
39670 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
39671 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
39672 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
39673 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
39674 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
39675 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
39676 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
39677 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
39678 updated sufficiently often.
39680 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
39681 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
39682 the retry database:
39684 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
39686 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
39687 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
39688 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
39689 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
39690 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
39691 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
39692 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
39693 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
39694 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
39695 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
39696 whenever it removes information from the database.
39698 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
39699 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
39700 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
39701 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
39702 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
39704 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
39705 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
39706 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
39707 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
39708 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
39709 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
39710 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
39713 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
39714 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
39719 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
39720 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
39721 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
39722 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
39723 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
39724 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
39725 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
39728 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
39729 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
39730 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
39731 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
39732 by new data, for example:
39736 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
39737 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
39738 used as optional separators.
39743 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
39744 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
39745 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
39746 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
39747 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
39748 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
39749 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
39750 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
39751 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
39752 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
39753 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
39754 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
39755 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
39759 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
39762 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
39765 .vitem &%-interval%&
39766 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
39767 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
39769 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
39770 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
39773 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
39776 Suppress verification output.
39778 .vitem &%-retries%&
39779 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
39780 the lock (default 10).
39782 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
39783 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
39784 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
39785 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
39788 .vitem &%-timeout%&
39789 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
39790 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
39791 default), a non-blocking call is used.
39794 Generate verbose output.
39797 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
39798 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
39799 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
39800 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
39801 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
39802 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
39803 more than 30 minutes old.
39805 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
39806 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
39807 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
39808 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
39809 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
39810 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
39812 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
39813 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
39814 suppresses all output except error messages.
39818 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
39820 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
39822 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
39823 <&'some commands'&>
39826 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
39827 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
39830 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
39831 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
39833 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
39834 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
39838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39839 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39841 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
39842 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
39843 .cindex "X-windows"
39844 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
39845 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
39846 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
39847 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
39848 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
39849 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
39850 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
39851 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
39855 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
39856 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
39857 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
39858 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
39859 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
39860 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
39861 parameters are for.
39863 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
39864 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
39865 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
39867 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
39869 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
39870 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
39871 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
39872 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
39873 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
39875 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
39876 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
39878 Eximon*background: gray94
39880 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
39881 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
39882 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
39883 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
39884 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
39885 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
39886 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
39889 Eximon*highlight: gray
39892 .cindex "admin user"
39893 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
39894 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
39896 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
39897 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
39898 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
39899 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
39900 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
39902 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
39903 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
39904 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
39905 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
39906 different parts of the display.
39911 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
39912 .cindex "stripchart"
39913 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
39914 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39915 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
39916 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
39917 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
39918 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
39919 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
39920 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
39921 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39923 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
39924 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
39925 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
39926 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
39928 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
39929 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
39930 to a single partition.
39932 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
39933 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
39934 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
39935 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
39936 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
39937 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39938 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39943 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
39944 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
39945 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
39946 .cindex "window size"
39947 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
39948 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
39949 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
39950 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
39951 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
39952 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
39954 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
39955 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
39956 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
39957 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
39959 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
39960 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
39961 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
39962 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
39963 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
39964 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39966 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
39967 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
39968 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39972 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
39973 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
39974 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
39975 the main log is maintained.
39976 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
39977 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
39978 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
39979 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
39980 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
39982 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
39983 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
39984 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
39985 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
39986 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
39987 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
39988 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
39989 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
39990 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
39991 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
39992 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39994 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
39995 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
39996 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
39997 It cannot go further back up the log.
39999 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
40000 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
40001 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
40002 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
40003 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
40004 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
40006 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
40007 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
40008 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
40009 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
40010 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
40011 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
40013 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
40014 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
40015 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
40016 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
40017 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
40018 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
40019 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
40020 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
40021 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
40026 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
40027 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
40028 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
40029 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
40030 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
40031 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
40032 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
40033 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
40034 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
40035 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
40037 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
40038 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
40039 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
40040 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
40041 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
40042 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
40043 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
40045 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
40046 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
40047 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
40048 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
40049 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
40050 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
40051 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
40053 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
40054 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
40055 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
40056 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
40058 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
40059 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
40060 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
40061 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
40062 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
40063 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
40064 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
40067 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
40068 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
40070 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
40071 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
40072 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
40073 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
40074 display is updated.
40078 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
40079 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
40080 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
40081 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
40082 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
40085 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
40086 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
40087 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
40088 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
40089 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
40091 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
40093 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
40097 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
40098 in a new text window.
40100 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
40101 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
40102 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
40104 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
40105 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
40106 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
40107 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
40109 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
40110 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
40111 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
40112 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
40113 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
40115 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
40116 that the message be frozen.
40118 .cindex "thawing messages"
40119 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
40120 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
40121 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
40122 that the message be thawed.
40124 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
40125 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
40126 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
40127 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
40129 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
40130 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
40133 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
40134 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40135 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40136 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40137 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
40138 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
40139 which case no action is taken.
40141 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
40142 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40143 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40144 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40145 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
40146 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
40147 case no action is taken.
40149 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
40150 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
40152 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
40153 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
40154 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
40155 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
40156 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
40157 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
40158 the address is qualified with that domain.
40161 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
40162 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
40163 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
40164 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
40165 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
40166 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
40167 if no output is generated.
40169 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
40170 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
40171 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
40172 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
40174 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
40175 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
40176 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
40183 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40186 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
40187 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
40188 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
40189 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
40191 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
40192 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
40193 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
40194 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
40195 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
40196 its security as compared with other MTAs.
40198 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
40199 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
40200 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
40201 as soon as possible.
40204 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
40205 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
40206 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
40207 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
40208 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
40209 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
40212 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
40213 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
40214 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
40215 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
40216 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
40217 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
40219 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
40220 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
40221 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
40222 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
40225 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
40226 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
40227 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
40228 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
40229 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
40230 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
40231 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
40232 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
40233 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
40237 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
40238 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
40239 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
40240 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
40241 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
40242 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
40243 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
40245 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
40248 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
40249 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
40250 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
40251 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
40252 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
40257 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
40259 .cindex "root privilege"
40260 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
40261 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
40262 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
40263 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
40264 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
40265 is required for two things:
40268 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
40269 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
40272 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
40273 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
40277 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
40278 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
40279 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
40280 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
40281 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
40282 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
40283 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
40284 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
40286 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
40287 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
40288 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
40290 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
40291 uid and gid in the following cases:
40296 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
40297 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
40298 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
40299 the calling process.
40300 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
40301 option may not be used at all.
40302 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
40303 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
40304 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
40309 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
40310 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
40313 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
40314 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
40315 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
40316 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
40317 testing address verification
40320 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
40323 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
40324 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
40327 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
40330 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
40331 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
40332 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
40333 will be used during message reception.
40335 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
40336 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
40338 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
40339 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
40340 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
40341 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
40342 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
40343 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
40344 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
40345 generating bounce and warning messages.
40347 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
40348 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
40349 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
40350 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
40352 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
40353 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
40359 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
40360 .cindex "privilege, running without"
40361 .cindex "unprivileged running"
40362 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
40363 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
40364 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
40365 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
40366 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
40367 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
40368 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
40372 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
40373 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
40374 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
40375 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
40377 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
40378 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
40379 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
40380 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
40381 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
40383 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
40384 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
40385 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
40388 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
40389 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
40390 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
40392 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
40393 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
40394 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
40395 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
40396 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
40397 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
40398 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
40399 address this problem at this time.
40401 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
40402 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
40403 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
40404 be used in the most straightforward way.
40406 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
40407 number of restrictions on what you can do:
40410 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
40411 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
40412 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
40413 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
40414 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
40416 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
40417 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
40419 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
40420 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
40421 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
40422 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
40424 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
40425 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
40428 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
40429 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
40430 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
40432 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
40433 owned by the Exim user.
40435 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
40436 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
40437 mailboxes need to be created manually.
40442 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
40443 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
40444 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
40445 gives more security at essentially no cost.
40447 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
40448 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
40453 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
40454 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
40455 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
40459 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
40460 .cindex "security" "local commands"
40461 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
40462 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
40463 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
40464 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
40465 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
40468 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
40469 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
40470 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
40471 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
40472 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
40474 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
40475 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
40476 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
40477 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
40478 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
40479 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
40480 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
40482 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
40483 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
40484 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
40486 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
40487 taint checking might apply to their usage.
40489 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
40490 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
40491 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
40493 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
40494 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
40495 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
40497 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
40498 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
40499 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
40500 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
40506 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
40507 .cindex "security" "data sources"
40508 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
40509 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
40510 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
40511 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
40512 are some issues to be aware of:
40515 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
40517 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
40519 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
40520 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
40521 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
40522 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
40523 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
40524 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
40527 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
40528 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
40529 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
40531 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
40532 expected to yield one result.
40538 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
40539 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
40540 .cindex "IP source routing"
40541 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
40542 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
40543 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
40544 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
40548 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
40549 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
40550 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
40555 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
40556 .cindex "trusted users"
40557 .cindex "admin user"
40558 .cindex "privileged user"
40559 .cindex "user" "trusted"
40560 .cindex "user" "admin"
40561 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
40562 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
40563 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
40564 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
40565 permit a remote host to be specified.
40568 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
40569 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
40570 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
40571 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
40572 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
40573 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
40575 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
40576 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
40577 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
40578 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
40579 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
40581 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
40582 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
40583 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
40584 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
40585 includes the contents of files on the spool.
40589 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
40590 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
40591 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
40592 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
40593 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
40594 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
40596 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
40597 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
40598 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
40599 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
40600 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
40601 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
40604 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
40605 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
40606 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
40607 This affects most of the checking options,
40608 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
40611 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
40612 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
40613 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
40614 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
40615 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
40616 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
40620 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
40621 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
40622 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
40623 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
40624 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
40629 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
40630 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
40631 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
40632 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
40637 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
40638 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
40639 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
40640 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
40641 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
40645 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
40646 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
40647 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
40651 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
40652 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
40653 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
40654 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
40655 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
40656 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
40657 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
40659 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
40660 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
40665 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
40666 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
40667 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
40668 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
40672 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
40673 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
40674 enough to hold the result.
40675 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
40680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40683 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
40684 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
40685 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
40686 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
40687 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
40688 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
40689 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
40690 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
40691 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
40692 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
40693 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
40694 themselves are recoverable.
40696 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
40697 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
40698 and should not be used as such.
40700 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
40701 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
40702 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
40705 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
40706 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
40707 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
40708 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
40709 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
40711 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
40712 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
40713 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
40714 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
40716 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
40718 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
40721 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
40723 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
40724 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
40725 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
40726 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
40727 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
40728 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
40729 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
40730 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
40733 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
40734 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
40735 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
40736 relics of crashes and can be removed.
40738 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
40739 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
40740 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
40741 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
40742 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
40743 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
40744 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
40745 normally the Exim user.
40747 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
40748 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
40749 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
40750 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
40751 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
40752 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
40753 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
40754 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
40756 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
40757 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
40758 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
40759 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
40761 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
40762 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
40765 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40766 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
40767 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
40768 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
40769 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
40770 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
40771 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
40772 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
40773 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
40776 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40777 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
40778 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
40779 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40780 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40781 character. It may contain internal newlines.
40783 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40784 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
40785 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
40786 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40787 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40788 character. It may contain internal newlines.
40790 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
40791 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
40792 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
40794 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
40795 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
40796 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
40797 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
40798 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40800 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
40801 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
40802 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
40803 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
40804 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40806 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
40807 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
40808 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
40810 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
40811 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
40812 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
40814 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40815 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
40816 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
40818 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40819 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
40820 present if the number is greater than zero.
40822 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
40823 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
40824 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
40826 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
40827 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
40828 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
40830 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40831 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
40834 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40835 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
40836 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
40839 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
40840 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
40841 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
40842 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
40844 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
40845 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
40846 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
40848 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40849 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
40850 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
40851 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
40852 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
40853 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
40855 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
40856 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
40857 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
40858 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
40859 supplied by the remote host, if any.
40861 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40862 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
40863 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
40864 generated messages.
40867 The message is from a local sender.
40869 .vitem &%-localerror%&
40870 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
40872 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
40873 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
40874 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
40875 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
40877 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
40878 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
40879 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
40882 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
40883 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
40886 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
40887 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
40888 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
40890 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
40891 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
40892 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
40894 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
40895 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
40896 of &$spam_score_int$&.
40898 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
40899 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
40900 rather than Unix-format.
40901 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
40902 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
40904 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
40905 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
40906 certificate was verified by the server.
40908 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
40909 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
40910 name of the cipher suite that was used.
40912 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
40913 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
40914 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
40918 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
40919 corresponding data is untrusted.
40921 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
40922 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
40923 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
40924 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
40925 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
40926 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
40927 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
40928 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
40929 addresses are complete.
40931 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
40932 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
40933 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
40934 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
40935 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
40936 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
40938 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
40939 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
40940 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40942 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
40943 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
40944 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
40945 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
40949 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40950 darcy@austen.fict.example
40952 alice@wonderland.fict.example
40954 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
40955 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
40956 line is of the following form:
40958 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
40959 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
40961 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
40962 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
40963 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
40964 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
40965 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
40966 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
40967 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
40968 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
40971 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
40972 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
40973 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
40974 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
40975 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
40979 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
40980 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
40981 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
40982 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
40983 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
40984 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
40985 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
40986 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
40987 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
40988 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
40991 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
40992 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
40993 typical set of headers:
40995 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
40996 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40997 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
40998 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
40999 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
41000 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
41001 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
41002 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41003 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
41004 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41005 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41007 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
41008 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
41009 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
41010 .ecindex IIDforspo1
41011 .ecindex IIDforspo2
41012 .ecindex IIDforspo3
41014 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
41015 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
41016 an ASCII newline character.
41017 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
41018 can have an alternate format.
41019 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
41020 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
41021 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
41022 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
41023 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
41024 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
41026 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41027 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41029 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
41030 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
41032 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
41035 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
41036 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
41037 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
41038 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
41040 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
41041 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
41042 any original DKIM signature.
41044 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
41045 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41047 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
41049 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
41050 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
41051 (including transport filters)
41052 except cutthrough delivery.
41054 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
41055 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
41056 different signature contexts.
41059 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
41060 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
41061 Exim's standard controls.
41063 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
41064 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
41066 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
41067 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
41068 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
41069 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
41071 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
41072 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
41073 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
41074 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
41077 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
41078 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
41079 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
41080 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
41084 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
41085 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
41087 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
41088 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
41090 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41092 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41093 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41096 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
41097 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
41098 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
41099 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
41100 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
41102 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
41103 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
41105 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
41106 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
41107 After expansion, this can be a list.
41108 Each element in turn,
41110 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
41111 while expanding the remaining signing options.
41112 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
41113 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41115 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
41116 This sets the key selector string.
41117 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
41118 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
41119 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
41120 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
41121 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
41122 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41125 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
41126 this could be be used:
41128 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
41129 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
41133 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
41134 This sets the private key to use.
41135 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
41136 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
41137 The result can either
41139 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
41141 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41142 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
41144 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
41147 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
41148 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
41152 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
41154 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
41155 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
41157 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
41158 this option set to use it.
41159 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
41160 for the DNS TXT record.
41161 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
41165 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
41166 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
41169 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41171 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41172 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41175 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
41176 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
41177 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
41178 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
41179 for some transition period.
41180 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41183 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
41185 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
41186 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
41189 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
41191 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
41192 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
41195 Exim also supports an alternate format
41196 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
41197 of the standard, but not adopted.
41198 A future release will probably drop that support.
41200 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
41201 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
41203 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
41205 &`sha256`& &-- the default
41207 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
41210 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41212 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41215 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
41216 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
41217 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
41218 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
41219 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
41220 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
41222 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
41223 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
41224 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
41225 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
41226 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
41228 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
41229 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
41230 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
41231 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
41232 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
41235 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
41236 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
41237 list of header names.
41238 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
41239 in the message signature.
41240 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
41241 whether or not each header is present in the message.
41242 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
41243 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
41244 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
41246 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
41247 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
41248 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
41250 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
41251 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
41253 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
41254 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
41255 name will be appended.
41257 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
41258 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
41259 If not set, no such information will be included.
41260 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
41262 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
41263 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
41265 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
41268 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
41269 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
41271 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
41272 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
41273 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
41274 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
41275 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
41276 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
41277 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
41279 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41280 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41281 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41283 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
41284 of this section can be ignored.
41286 The results of verification are made available to the
41287 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
41288 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
41289 By default, the ACL is called once for each
41290 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
41291 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
41292 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
41293 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
41295 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
41296 a large number of expansion variables
41297 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
41298 runtime of the ACL.
41300 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
41301 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
41302 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
41303 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
41305 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
41306 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
41307 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
41308 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
41309 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
41310 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
41313 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
41315 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
41316 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
41317 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
41319 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
41321 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
41322 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
41323 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
41325 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
41328 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
41329 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
41331 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
41332 (such as the From: header)
41333 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
41334 and for the domain part if identities.
41335 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
41337 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
41338 for each matching signature.
41341 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
41342 available (from most to least important):
41346 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
41347 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
41348 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
41349 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
41351 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
41352 Within the DKIM ACL,
41353 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
41355 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
41356 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41358 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
41359 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
41361 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
41362 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
41364 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
41367 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
41368 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
41369 hash-method or key-size:
41371 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
41372 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
41373 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
41374 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
41375 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
41376 set dkim_verify_status = fail
41377 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
41380 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
41381 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
41382 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
41383 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
41385 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
41386 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
41387 "fail" or "invalid". One of
41389 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
41390 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
41392 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
41393 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
41395 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
41396 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
41397 means that the message body was modified in transit.
41399 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
41400 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
41401 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
41402 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
41405 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
41407 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
41408 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
41409 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
41410 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41412 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
41413 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
41414 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
41415 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41417 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
41418 The key record selector string.
41420 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
41421 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
41422 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41423 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
41424 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41427 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41429 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41431 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
41432 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
41435 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
41436 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
41437 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
41438 processing of such signatures.
41440 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
41441 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
41443 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
41444 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
41446 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
41447 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
41448 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
41449 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
41450 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
41451 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
41453 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
41454 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
41455 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
41456 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
41457 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
41458 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
41459 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
41460 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
41462 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
41463 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
41464 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
41466 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
41467 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
41468 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
41469 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
41470 integer size comparisons against this value.
41471 Note that Exim does not check this value.
41473 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
41474 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
41476 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
41477 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
41479 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
41480 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
41482 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
41483 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
41486 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
41487 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
41490 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
41491 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
41493 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
41494 Number of bits in the key.
41495 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
41496 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
41498 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41500 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
41501 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
41504 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
41509 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
41512 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
41513 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
41514 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
41515 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
41516 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
41519 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
41520 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
41521 dkim_signers = gmail.com
41523 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
41526 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
41527 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
41529 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
41530 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
41531 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
41532 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
41535 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
41536 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
41537 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
41538 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
41541 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
41542 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
41543 for more information of what they mean.
41549 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
41550 .cindex SPF verification
41552 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
41553 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
41554 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
41555 the &url(http://openspf.org).
41556 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
41557 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
41558 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
41561 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
41562 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
41564 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
41565 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
41566 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
41567 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
41568 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
41570 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
41571 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41572 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41573 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41576 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
41577 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
41578 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
41579 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
41580 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
41584 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
41587 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
41588 domain in the envelope-from address.
41590 .vitem &%softfail%&
41591 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
41595 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
41598 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
41599 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
41600 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
41602 .vitem &%permerror%&
41603 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
41604 You may deny messages when this occurs.
41606 .vitem &%temperror%&
41607 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
41608 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
41611 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
41612 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
41613 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
41614 short-circuit fashion.
41619 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
41620 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
41621 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
41622 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
41623 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
41624 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
41625 ip=$sender_host_address
41628 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
41629 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
41632 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
41635 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
41637 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
41638 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
41639 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
41640 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
41641 it for logging purposes.
41643 .vitem &$spf_received$&
41644 .vindex &$spf_received$&
41645 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
41646 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
41647 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
41648 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
41650 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
41651 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
41653 .vitem &$spf_result$&
41654 .vindex &$spf_result$&
41655 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
41656 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
41659 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
41660 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
41661 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
41662 and required in order to obtain a result.
41664 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41665 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41666 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
41667 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
41668 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
41669 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
41670 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
41674 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
41675 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
41676 .cindex SPF "best guess"
41677 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
41678 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
41679 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
41681 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
41682 for a description of what it means.
41683 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
41685 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
41686 of the spf one. For example:
41689 deny spf_guess = fail
41690 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
41693 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
41694 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
41695 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
41698 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
41699 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
41701 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
41702 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
41703 &%spf_guess%& option.
41704 For example, the following:
41707 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
41710 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
41713 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
41715 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
41716 address as the key and an IP address
41721 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
41724 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
41725 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
41731 .section "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
41732 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
41735 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
41736 SPF verification does not object to them.
41737 It operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
41738 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
41739 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
41740 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
41741 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
41744 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
41745 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
41746 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
41747 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
41750 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
41751 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41752 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
41754 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
41756 .cindex SRS excoding
41757 To encode an address use this expansion item:
41759 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
41760 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
41761 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
41762 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
41763 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
41764 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
41766 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
41767 encoding operation.
41768 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
41769 it arrived at this system.
41772 .cindex SRS decoding
41773 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
41775 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
41776 The first argument should be the recipient local prt as is was received.
41777 The second argument is the site secret.
41779 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
41780 return false. If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
41781 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
41787 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
41793 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
41794 domains = ! +my_domains
41795 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
41796 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
41797 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
41802 domains = +my_domains
41803 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
41804 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
41805 data = $srs_recipient
41807 inbound_srs_failure:
41810 domains = +my_domains
41811 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
41812 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
41814 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
41816 #... further routers here
41819 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
41820 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
41821 remote_forwarded_smtp:
41823 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
41825 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
41833 .section DMARC SECDMARC
41834 .cindex DMARC verification
41836 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
41837 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
41838 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
41839 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
41840 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
41842 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
41843 the libopendmarc library is used.
41845 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
41846 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
41847 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
41848 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
41849 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
41850 This description assumes
41851 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
41852 are in /usr/local/lib.
41856 There are three main-configuration options:
41857 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
41859 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
41860 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
41861 defines the location of a text file of valid
41862 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
41863 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
41864 the most current version can be downloaded
41865 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
41866 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
41867 The default for the option is unset.
41868 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
41871 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
41872 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
41873 defines the location of a file to log results
41874 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
41875 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
41876 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
41877 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
41878 directory of this file is writable by the user
41880 The default is unset.
41882 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
41883 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41884 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
41885 forensic report detailing alignment failures
41886 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
41887 and you have configured Exim to send them.
41888 If set, this is expanded and used for the
41889 From: header line; the address is extracted
41890 from it and used for the envelope from.
41891 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
41892 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
41895 . I wish we had subsections...
41897 .cindex DMARC controls
41898 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
41899 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
41900 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
41901 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
41902 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
41903 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
41905 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41907 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
41908 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
41909 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
41910 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
41911 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
41912 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
41913 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
41914 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
41915 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
41916 construction might be inadequate.
41918 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41920 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
41921 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
41922 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
41925 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
41930 DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
41931 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
41932 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
41933 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
41934 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
41935 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
41936 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
41938 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
41939 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
41940 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
41941 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
41943 &'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
41944 &'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
41945 &'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
41946 &'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
41947 &'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field
41948 &'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
41949 &'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
41950 &'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
41952 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
41953 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
41954 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
41955 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
41956 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
41957 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
41960 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
41961 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
41962 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
41964 Performing the check sets up information used by the
41965 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41967 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
41968 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
41969 expansion variables are available:
41972 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
41973 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
41974 .cindex DMARC result
41975 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
41976 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
41977 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
41978 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
41979 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
41981 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
41982 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
41983 Slightly longer, human readable status.
41985 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41986 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41987 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
41989 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41990 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41991 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
41992 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
41993 is any error, including no DMARC record.
41998 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
41999 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
42000 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
42001 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
42002 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
42003 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
42004 processing or failure delivery issues).
42006 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
42007 tools, you need to:
42009 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
42011 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
42012 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
42015 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
42017 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42019 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
42020 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
42028 warn domains = +local_domains
42029 hosts = +local_hosts
42030 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42032 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
42033 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42035 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
42036 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
42039 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
42041 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
42043 warn dmarc_status = !accept
42045 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
42047 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
42049 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
42050 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
42052 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
42053 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
42054 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
42056 deny dmarc_status = reject
42058 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
42060 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
42067 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42070 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
42072 .cindex "proxy support"
42073 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
42075 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
42076 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
42079 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
42080 .cindex proxy inbound
42081 .cindex proxy "server side"
42082 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
42083 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
42085 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
42086 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
42087 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
42090 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
42091 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
42093 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
42094 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
42095 to distribute load.
42096 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
42097 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
42098 There is no logging if a host passes or
42099 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
42100 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
42102 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
42103 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
42104 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
42105 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
42106 automatically determines which version is in use.
42108 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
42109 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
42110 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
42111 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
42112 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
42114 The following expansion variables are usable
42115 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
42118 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
42119 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
42120 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
42121 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
42122 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
42124 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
42125 there was a protocol error.
42126 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
42127 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
42129 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
42130 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
42131 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
42132 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
42133 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
42134 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
42135 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
42136 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
42137 A possible solution is:
42139 # Set max number of connections per host
42141 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
42142 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
42144 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
42145 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
42150 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
42151 .cindex proxy outbound
42152 .cindex proxy "client side"
42153 .cindex proxy SOCKS
42154 .cindex SOCKS proxy
42155 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
42156 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
42157 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
42160 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
42161 on an smtp transport.
42162 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
42163 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
42164 Each proxy specifier is a list
42165 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
42166 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
42168 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
42169 The list of options is in the following table:
42171 &'auth '& authentication method
42172 &'name '& authentication username
42173 &'pass '& authentication password
42175 &'tmo '& connection timeout
42177 &'weight '& selection bias
42180 More details on each of these options follows:
42183 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
42184 .cindex proxy authentication
42185 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
42186 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
42187 for access to the proxy.
42188 Default is &"none"&.
42190 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
42193 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
42196 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
42199 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
42202 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
42203 higher values being tried first.
42204 The default priority is 1.
42206 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
42207 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
42208 weighted by this value.
42209 The default value for selection bias is 1.
42212 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
42213 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
42214 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
42216 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
42217 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
42218 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
42219 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
42221 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42222 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42224 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
42225 "Internationalisation""
42226 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
42229 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
42231 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
42232 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
42233 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
42235 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
42236 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
42237 requirement, upon libidn2.
42239 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
42240 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
42241 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
42242 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
42243 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
42244 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
42245 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
42247 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
42248 international handling for the message is enabled and
42249 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
42251 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
42252 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
42253 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
42254 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
42256 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
42257 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
42258 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
42259 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
42261 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
42262 components expanded to a-label form,
42263 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
42266 .cindex log protocol
42267 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
42268 .cindex i18n logging
42269 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
42270 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
42272 The following expansion operators can be used:
42274 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
42275 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
42276 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
42277 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
42280 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
42281 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
42283 may use the following modifier:
42285 control = utf8_downconvert
42286 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
42288 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
42289 a-label form before smtp delivery.
42290 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
42291 but could be used for any message.
42293 If a value is appended it may be:
42295 &`1 `& mandatory downconversion
42296 &`0 `& no downconversion
42297 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
42299 If no value is given, 1 is used.
42301 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
42302 is initially set to -1.
42304 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
42305 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
42306 or an empty string.
42307 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
42308 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
42311 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
42312 Configurations supporting these should inspect
42313 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
42315 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
42316 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
42317 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
42319 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
42320 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
42324 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
42325 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
42326 the following expansion operator can be used:
42328 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
42331 The string is converted from the charset specified by
42332 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
42333 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
42335 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
42336 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
42337 (which has to be a single character)
42338 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
42339 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
42341 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
42342 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
42344 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
42345 by many other IMAP servers.
42349 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
42350 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
42351 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
42354 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
42355 must be representable in UTF-16.
42358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42361 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
42365 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
42366 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
42367 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
42368 processing actions.
42370 Most installations will never need to use Events.
42371 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
42372 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42374 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
42375 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
42376 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
42378 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
42379 An example might look like:
42380 .cindex logging custom
42382 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
42383 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
42384 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
42385 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
42386 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
42387 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
42388 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
42389 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
42390 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
42394 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
42395 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
42396 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
42398 The current list of events is:
42400 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
42401 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
42402 &`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
42403 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
42404 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
42405 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
42406 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
42407 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
42408 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
42409 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
42410 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
42411 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
42412 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
42413 &`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
42415 New event types may be added in future.
42417 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
42418 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
42419 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
42421 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
42422 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
42423 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
42425 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
42426 should define the event action.
42428 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
42429 with the event type:
42431 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
42432 &`msg:defer `& error string
42433 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
42434 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
42435 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
42436 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
42437 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
42438 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
42439 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
42440 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
42441 &`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
42444 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
42446 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
42447 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
42448 the course of its processing:
42450 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
42453 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
42454 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
42456 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
42457 a useful way of writing to the main log.
42459 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
42460 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
42461 following will be forced:
42463 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
42464 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
42465 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
42467 All other message types ignore the result string, and
42468 no other use is made of it.
42470 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
42471 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
42474 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
42475 chain element received on the connection.
42476 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
42479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42482 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
42483 "Adding drivers or lookups"
42484 .cindex "adding drivers"
42485 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
42486 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
42487 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
42488 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
42491 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
42492 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
42494 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
42496 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
42498 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
42499 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
42500 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
42502 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
42504 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
42507 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
42508 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
42510 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
42511 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
42512 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
42513 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
42514 simple form that most lookups have.
42516 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
42517 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
42518 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
42520 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
42521 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
42523 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
42526 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
42527 as for other drivers and lookups.
42530 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
42531 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
42532 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
42533 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
42534 searched using a binary chop procedure.
42536 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
42537 the interface that is expected.
42542 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42543 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42545 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42546 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
42547 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
42548 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
42550 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42555 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
42556 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
42560 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
42561 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
42562 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
42565 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42566 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////